Docs: add note on string lists
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.85"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552015
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.new
375.cindex "documentation"
376This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379capable of showing a change indicator.
380.wen
381
382This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389very wide interest.
390
391.cindex "books about Exim"
392An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395(&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404Debian-specific features in the file
405&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407information.
408
409.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411.cindex "change log"
412As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429directory are:
430
431.table2 100pt
432.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439.endtable
440
441The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447.section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448.cindex "web site"
449.cindex "FTP site"
450The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453&%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454&%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457.cindex "wiki"
458.cindex "FAQ"
459As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465.cindex Bugzilla
466An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476.table2 140pt
477.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481.endtable
482
483You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488via this web page:
489.display
490&url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491.endd
492Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493lists.
494
495.section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496.cindex "training courses"
497Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503.cindex "bug reports"
504.cindex "reporting bugs"
505Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513.cindex "FTP site"
514.cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516.display
517&*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518.endd
519This is mirrored by
520.display
521&*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522.endd
523The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531.display
532&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534.endd
535where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540.cindex "distribution" "public key"
541.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548&_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554&url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561.display
562&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564.endd
565For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573.display
574&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578.endd
579These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584.ilist
585.cindex "limitations of Exim"
586.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592.next
593.cindex "domainless addresses"
594.cindex "address" "without domain"
595Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599arrival.
600.next
601.cindex "transport" "external"
602.cindex "external transports"
603The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609.next
610Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613other means.
614.next
615Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619a number of common scanners are provided.
620.endlist
621
622
623.section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6403, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652.cindex "terminology definitions"
653.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656below) by a blank line.
657
658.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665rise to further bounce messages.
666
667The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670otherwise.
671
672The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675until a later time.
676
677The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681.cindex "envelope, definition of"
682.cindex "sender" "definition of"
683A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691.cindex "header section" "definition of"
692The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696line.
697
698.cindex "local part" "definition of"
699.cindex "domain" "definition of"
700The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711.cindex "return path" "definition of"
712&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713message's envelope.
714
715.cindex "queue" "definition of"
716The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743.cindex "incorporated code"
744.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745.cindex "PCRE"
746.cindex "OpenDMARC"
747A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749.ilist
750Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756.next
757.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762following statements:
763
764.blockquote
765Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770version.
771This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775restrictions applied to it).
776.endblockquote
777.next
778.cindex "SPA authentication"
779.cindex "Samba project"
780.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784under the Gnu GPL.
785.next
786.cindex "Cyrus"
787.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792conditions expressed therein.
793
794.blockquote
795Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799are met:
800
801.olist
802Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804.next
805Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808distribution.
809.next
810The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813details, please contact
814.display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821.endd
822.next
823Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824acknowledgment:
825
826&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836.endlist
837.endblockquote
838
839.next
840.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841.cindex "X-windows"
842.cindex "Athena"
843The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848.blockquote
849Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852All Rights Reserved
853
854Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868SOFTWARE.
869.endblockquote
870
871.next
872.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877source code.
878
879.next
880Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883.endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897.cindex "design philosophy"
898Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907.cindex "policy control" "overview"
908Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914.ilist
915.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924error code.
925.next
926An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928.next
929When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933.next
934When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939.next
940Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943.next
944After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946runs at the start of every delivery process.
947.endlist
948
949
950
951.section "User filters" "SECID12"
952.cindex "filter" "introduction"
953.cindex "Sieve filter"
954In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959of filtering are available:
960
961.ilist
962Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963by RFC 3028.
964.next
965Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967.endlist
968
969User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975.cindex "format" "of message id"
976.cindex "id of message"
977.cindex "base62"
978.cindex "base36"
979.cindex "Darwin"
980.cindex "Cygwin"
981Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988not always case-sensitive.
989
990.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996somewhat eccentric:
997
998.ilist
999The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002way of representing the date and time of day).
1003.next
1004After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005received the message.
1006.next
1007There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008.olist
1009.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014.next
1015If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017(1/100) of a second.
1018.endlist
1019.endlist
1020
1021After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029.cindex "receiving mail"
1030.cindex "message" "reception"
1031The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034there are several possibilities:
1035
1036.ilist
1037If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040.next
1041If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047.next
1048If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053.next
1054A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058.endlist
1059
1060
1061.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077(either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112affect file system performance.
1113
1114The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136.cindex "message" "life of"
1137.cindex "message" "frozen"
1138A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150to be sent.
1151
1152.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158.cindex "message" "log file for"
1159.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168systems.
1169
1170.cindex "journal file"
1171.cindex "file" "journal"
1172All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191.cindex "router" "definition of"
1192.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207the driver's features in general.
1208
1209A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213to be bounced.
1214
1215A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232configuration.
1233
1234The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242configured to fail the address.
1243
1244The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261.cindex "router" "for verification"
1262.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267&%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282.cindex "router" "running details"
1283.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284.cindex "router" "result of running"
1285As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289the following:
1290
1291.ilist
1292&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294original address ceases,
1295.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300end of routing.
1301
1302Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307.next
1308&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313.next
1314&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319.next
1320&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323.next
1324&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328.next
1329&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331.endlist
1332
1333If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347.cindex "case of local parts"
1348.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365.ilist
1366The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371of any other conditions.
1372.next
1373Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376address.
1377Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382.next
1383If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388.next
1389Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392.next
1393Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395.next
1396If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397of domains that it defines.
1398.next
1399.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409.next
1410.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412.vindex "&$home$&"
1413If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417remaining preconditions.
1418.next
1419If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423could lead to confusion.
1424.next
1425If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426set of addresses that it defines.
1427.next
1428If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429specified files is tested.
1430.next
1431.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435.endlist
1436
1437
1438Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452.ilist
1453If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458filtering'&.
1459.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468filter.
1469.next
1470Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474processed entirely independently of each other.
1475.next
1476.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485.next
1486When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493addresses to the same domain.
1494.next
1495Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503.next
1504.cindex "queue runner"
1505When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514.next
1515.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521.next
1522If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525messages to other addresses.
1526.next
1527.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530&'deferred'&.
1531.next
1532When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535.endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543.cindex "queue runner"
1544Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551passed its retry time.
1552You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572also apply.
1573
1574If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577deferred,
1578.cindex "hints database"
1579Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602automatically.
1603
1604.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639.table2 140pt
1640.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648.endtable
1649
1650Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653.table2 140pt
1654.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661.endtable
1662
1663The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674system.
1675.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683.cindex "PCRE library"
1684Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692If your operating system has no
1693PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725possibilities:
1726
1727.olist
1728A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730.next
1731.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735file name is used unmodified.
1736.next
1737.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741.next
1742If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745.next
1746To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17482.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752.next
1753.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755&url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756operates on a single file.
1757.endlist
1758
1759.cindex "USE_DB"
1760.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765.code
1766USE_DB=yes
1767.endd
1768Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780in one of these lines:
1781.code
1782DBMLIB = -ldb
1783DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784.endd
1785Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789this example:
1790.code
1791INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793.endd
1794There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825be logged.
1826
1827.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830facilities, you need to set
1831.code
1832WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833.endd
1834in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857.cindex "RFC 2047"
1858The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863(default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868&url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871.code
1872HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873.endd
1874to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881.cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888line option).
1889
1890If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892implementing SSL.
1893
1894If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895.code
1896SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898.endd
1899in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901.code
1902SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905.endd
1906.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908.code
1909SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911.endd
1912.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914.code
1915SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918.endd
1919in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920library and include files. For example:
1921.code
1922SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926.endd
1927.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929.code
1930SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933.endd
1934
1935You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956you might have
1957.code
1958USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961.endd
1962in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964.code
1965exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966.endd
1967in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973further details.
1974
1975
1976.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982library files.
1983
1984Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1989.new
1990Exim used to
1991have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1992withdrawn.
1993.wen
1994
1995
1996
1997.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1998.cindex "lookup modules"
1999.cindex "dynamic modules"
2000.cindex ".so building"
2001On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2002the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2003on demand.
2004This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2005library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2006dependencies.
2007Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2008
2009Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2010installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2011measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2012for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2013Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2014see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2015
2016Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2017&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2018For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2019on demand:
2020.code
2021LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2022LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2023LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2024.endd
2025
2026
2027.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2028.cindex "build directory"
2029Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2030created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2031operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2032For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2033&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2034.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2035Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2036
2037&*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2038building process fails if it is set.
2039
2040If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2041a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2042&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2043&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2044then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2045number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2046makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2047directory, should this ever be necessary.
2048
2049If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2050&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2051FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2052
2053
2054
2055.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2056The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2057unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2058output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2059appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2060each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2061get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2062.code
2063FULLECHO='' make -e
2064.endd
2065The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2066command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2067given in addition to the short output.
2068
2069
2070
2071.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2072.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2073The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2074consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2075values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2076more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2077convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2078order:
2079.display
2080&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2081&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2082&_Local/Makefile_&
2083&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2084&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2085&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2086&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2087.endd
2088.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2089.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2090.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2091where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2092architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2093process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2094and are often not needed.
2095
2096The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2097called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2098the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2099values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2100Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2101fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2102of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2103that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2104to find out what values are being used on your system.
2105
2106
2107&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2108therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2109needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2110file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2111default values are.
2112
2113
2114.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2115If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2116or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2117need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2118putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2119.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2120when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2121formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2122compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2123called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2124Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2125default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2126containing the lines
2127.code
2128CC=cc
2129CFLAGS=-std1
2130.endd
2131If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2132these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2133
2134Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2135files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2136the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2137
2138
2139.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2140.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2141.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2142.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2143Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2144lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2145not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2146and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2147which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2148case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2149.code
2150LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2151LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2152LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2153.endd
2154and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2155&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2156libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2157.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2158However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2159the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2160files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2161binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2162errors.
2163
2164.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2165.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2166Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2167about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2168being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2169makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2170variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2171name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2172&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2173with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2174syntax. For instance:
2175.code
2176LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2177LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2178AUTH_GSASL=yes
2179AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2180AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2181AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2182.endd
2183
2184.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2185Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2186subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2187.code
2188EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2189.endd
2190must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2191chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2192
2193.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2194The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2195operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2196with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2197monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2198The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2199.code
2200X11=/usr/X11R6
2201XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2202XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2203.endd
2204These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2205example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2206.code
2207X11=/usr/openwin
2208XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2209XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2210.endd
2211If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2212definition of all three of these variables into your
2213&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2214
2215.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2216If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2217variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2218default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2219command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2220
2221.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2222There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2223use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2224EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2225binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2226libraries.
2227
2228.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2229The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2230files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2231necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2232&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2233
2234
2235.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2236.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2237.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2238The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2239&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2240normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2241recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2242are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2243
2244
2245
2246.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2247.cindex "building Eximon"
2248A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2249where the files that are involved are
2250.display
2251&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2252&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2253&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2254&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2255&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2256&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2257.endd
2258.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2259As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2260&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2261&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2262variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2263EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2264LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2265.ecindex IIDbuex
2266
2267
2268.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2269.cindex "installing Exim"
2270.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2271The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2272arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2273whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2274.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2275The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2276going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2277&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2278install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2279some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2280it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2281chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2282
2283.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2284Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2285in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2286exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2287by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2288is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2289alternative files, no default is installed.
2290
2291.cindex "system aliases file"
2292.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2293One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2294default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2295The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2296SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2297If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2298and outputs a comment to the user.
2299
2300The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2301aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2302kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2303&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2304Exim's configuration if necessary.
2305
2306The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2307and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2308running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2309directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2310other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2311over SMTP.
2312
2313It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2314distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2315command such as
2316.code
2317make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2318.endd
2319This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2320paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2321configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2322For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2323but this usage is deprecated.
2324
2325.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2326Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2327&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2328upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2329directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2330INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2331
2332For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2333to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2334installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2335for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2336called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2337of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2338from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2339
2340.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2341If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2342real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2343command:
2344.code
2345make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2346.endd
2347The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2348script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2349the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2350directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2351command:
2352.code
2353(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2354.endd
2355.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2356There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2357
2358.ilist
2359&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2360to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2361.next
2362&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2363installed binary.
2364.endlist
2365
2366INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2367.code
2368make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2369.endd
2370The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2371to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2372without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2373.code
2374make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2375.endd
2376
2377
2378
2379.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2380.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2381Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2382reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2383distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2384&<<SECTavail>>&).
2385
2386If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2387source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2388install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2389
2390
2391
2392.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2393.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2394When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2395exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2396directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2397necessary.
2398
2399
2400
2401
2402.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2403.cindex "testing" "installation"
2404Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2405syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2406Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2407.code
2408exim -bV
2409.endd
2410If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2411Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2412the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2413other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2414Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2415example,
2416.display
2417&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2418.endd
2419should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2420.display
2421&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2422.endd
2423a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2424This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2425user agent. For example:
2426.code
2427exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2428From: user@your.domain.example
2429To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2430Subject: Testing Exim
2431
2432This is a test message.
2433^D
2434.endd
2435The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2436In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2437arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2438
2439.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2440If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2441&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2442of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2443&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2444with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2445.display
2446&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2447.endd
2448You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2449produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2450For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2451relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2452&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2453
2454.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2455.cindex "lock files"
2456One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2457local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2458&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2459writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2460is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2461directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2462that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2463&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2464approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2465&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2466agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2467see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2468
2469One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2470the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2471&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2472port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2473&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2474incoming SMTP mail.
2475
2476Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2477be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2478within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2479that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2480production version.
2481
2482
2483.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2484.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2485Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2486general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2487is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2488operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2489binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2490normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2491or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2492.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2493a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2494privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2495and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2496
2497.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2498.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2499Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2500example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2501&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2502described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2503as follows:
2504.code
2505sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2506send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2507mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2508newaliases /usr/bin/true
2509.endd
2510Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2511your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2512favourite user agent.
2513
2514You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2515have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2516various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2517command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2518use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2519&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2520
2521
2522
2523.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2524.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2525If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2526version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2527call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2528to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2529new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2530version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2531configuration file.
2532
2533
2534
2535
2536.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2537.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2538The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2539.code
2540/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2541.endd
2542If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2543fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2544for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2545(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2546solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2547.code
2548pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2549.endd
2550to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2551
2552Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2553still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2554(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2555
2556
2557
2558
2559. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2560. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2561
2562.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2563.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2564.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2565Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2566each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2567options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2568some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2569combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2570The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2571
2572
2573.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2574.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2575If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2576were present before any other options.
2577The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2578standard output.
2579This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2580that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2581&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2582
2583.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2584If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2585were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2586&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2587format.
2588
2589.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2590If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2591&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2592Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2593
2594.cindex "&'runq'&"
2595.cindex "queue runner"
2596If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2597were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2598option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2599
2600.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2601.cindex "alias file" "building"
2602.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2603If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2604&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2605This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2606the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2607command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2608
2609
2610.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2611Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2612available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2613user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2614EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2615&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2616
2617.ilist
2618.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2619.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2620The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2621&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2622supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2623configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2624
2625.cindex '&"From"& line'
2626.cindex "envelope sender"
2627Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2628&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2629Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2630See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2631users to set envelope senders.
2632
2633.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2634.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2635For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2636header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2637&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2638
2639Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2640protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2641locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2642have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2643users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2644that are available to trusted users.
2645.next
2646.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2647.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2648The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2649Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2650The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2651
2652Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2653operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2654necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2655the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2656
2657By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2658Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2659However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2660option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2661
2662Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2663is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2664false.
2665.endlist
2666
2667
2668&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2669edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2670getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2671&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2672
2673
2674
2675
2676.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2677Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2678of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2679a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2680format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2681on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2682with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2683outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2684
2685. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2686. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2687. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2688. creates a man page for the options.
2689. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2690
2691.literal xml
2692<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2693.literal off
2694
2695
2696.vlist
2697.vitem &%--%&
2698.oindex "--"
2699.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2700This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2701therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2702rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2703
2704.vitem &%--help%&
2705.oindex "&%--help%&"
2706This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2707The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2708no arguments.
2709
2710.vitem &%--version%&
2711.oindex "&%--version%&"
2712This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2713displayed.
2714
2715.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2716 &%-Am%&
2717.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2718.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2719These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2720ignored by Exim.
2721
2722.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2723.oindex "&%-B%&"
2724.cindex "8-bit characters"
2725.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2726This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2727clean; it ignores this option.
2728
2729.vitem &%-bd%&
2730.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2731.cindex "daemon"
2732.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2733.cindex "queue runner"
2734This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2735the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2736that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2737
2738The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2739(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2740disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2741stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2742
2743By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2744all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2745ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2746&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2747
2748When a listening daemon
2749.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2750.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2751is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2752configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2753in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2754PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2755running as root.
2756
2757When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2758process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2759used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2760
2761The SIGHUP signal
2762.cindex "SIGHUP"
2763.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2764can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2765whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2766means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2767of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2768referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2769because these are reread each time they are used.
2770
2771.vitem &%-bdf%&
2772.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2773This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2774from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2775
2776.vitem &%-be%&
2777.oindex "&%-be%&"
2778.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2779.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2780Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2781prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2782files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2783of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2784
2785If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2786to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2787used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2788function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2789test data. A line history is supported.
2790
2791Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2792continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2793continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2794string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2795configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2796message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2797is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2798
2799&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2800files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2801the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2802of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2803
2804.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2805.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2806.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2807.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2808This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2809of a file. For example:
2810.code
2811exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2812.endd
2813The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2814message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2815variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2816no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2817recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2818&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2819line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2820&%-be%&).
2821
2822.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2823.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2824.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2825.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2826This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2827tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2828system filters are recognized.
2829
2830.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2831.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2832.cindex "filter" "testing"
2833.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2834.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2835.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2836.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2837This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2838to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2839there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2840supplied.
2841
2842If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2843can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2844filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2845.code
2846exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2847.endd
2848This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2849variables that are used by the user filter.
2850
2851If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2852.code
2853# Exim filter
2854# Sieve filter
2855.endd
2856it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2857that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2858&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2859redirection lists.
2860
2861The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2862detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2863with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2864separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2865
2866When testing a filter file,
2867.cindex "&""From""& line"
2868.cindex "envelope sender"
2869.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2870the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2871or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2872that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2873can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2874options).
2875
2876.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2877.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2878.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2879This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2880tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2881&$qualify_domain$&.
2882
2883.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2884.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2885This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2886tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2887process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2888suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2889actually being delivered.
2890
2891.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2892.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2893This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2894file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2895prefix.
2896
2897.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2898.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2899This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2900file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2901suffix.
2902
2903.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2904.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2905.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2906.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2907.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2908.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2909.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2910.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2911This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2912standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2913after a full stop. For example:
2914.code
2915exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2916exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2917.endd
2918When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2919of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2920conversion to the canonical form is
2921&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2922
2923Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2924include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2925This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2926messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2927test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2928
2929&*Warning 1*&:
2930.cindex "RFC 1413"
2931You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2932information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2933an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2934connection.
2935
2936&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2937are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2938occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2939
2940Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2941written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2942lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2943can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2944and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2945session were authenticated.
2946
2947The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2948output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2949acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2950
2951Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2952plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2953specialized SMTP test program such as
2954&url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2955
2956.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2957.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2958This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2959verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2960updating the callout cache database.
2961
2962.vitem &%-bi%&
2963.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2964.cindex "alias file" "building"
2965.cindex "building alias file"
2966.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2967Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2968Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2969this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2970tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2971recognized.
2972
2973If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2974configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2975the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2976The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2977use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2978if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2979&%-bi%& is a no-op.
2980
2981. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2982.vitem &%-bI:help%&
2983.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2984.cindex "querying exim information"
2985We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2986information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2987consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2988synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2989options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2990
2991.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2992.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2993.cindex "DSCP" "values"
2994This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2995recognised DSCP names.
2996
2997.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2998.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2999.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3000This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3001Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3002useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3003&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3004compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3005way to guarantee a correct response.
3006
3007.vitem &%-bm%&
3008.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3009.cindex "local message reception"
3010This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3011locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3012command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3013argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3014default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3015if no other conflicting option is present.
3016
3017If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3018qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3019options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3020suppressing this for special cases.
3021
3022Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3023the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3024
3025.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3026The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3027action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3028
3029The format
3030.cindex "message" "format"
3031.cindex "format" "message"
3032.cindex "&""From""& line"
3033.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3034.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3035of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3036compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3037.code
3038From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3039From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3040.endd
3041(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3042is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3043authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3044matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3045option, which can be changed if necessary.
3046
3047.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3048The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3049&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3050preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3051trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3052
3053.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3054.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3055.cindex "testing", "malware"
3056.cindex "malware scan test"
3057This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3058using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3059this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3060the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3061not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3062will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3063
3064Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3065using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3066user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3067This option requires admin privileges.
3068
3069The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3070there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3071administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3072
3073.vitem &%-bnq%&
3074.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3075.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3076By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3077without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3078is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3079envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3080&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3081defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3082
3083Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3084being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3085content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3086header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3087syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3088
3089The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3090messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3091addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3092unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3093
3094
3095.vitem &%-bP%&
3096.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3097.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3098.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3099If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3100main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3101of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3102arguments, for example:
3103.code
3104exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3105.endd
3106.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3107.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3108.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3109However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3110configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3111users, the output is as in this example:
3112.code
3113mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3114.endd
3115If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3116configuration file is output.
3117If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3118is the name of the file that was actually used.
3119
3120.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3121If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3122name will not be output.
3123
3124.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3125.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3126If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3127directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3128respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3129sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3130written directly into the spool directory.
3131
3132If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3133.code
3134exim -bP +local_domains
3135.endd
3136it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3137local part) and outputs what it finds.
3138
3139.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3140.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3141.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3142If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3143followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3144that driver are output. For example:
3145.code
3146exim -bP transport local_delivery
3147.endd
3148The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3149options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3150using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3151&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3152settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3153&%authenticators%&.
3154
3155.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3156If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3157are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3158for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3159The output format is one item per line.
3160
3161.vitem &%-bp%&
3162.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3163.cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3164.cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3165This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3166standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3167just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3168admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3169to allow any user to see the queue.
3170
3171Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3172.code
317325m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3174 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3175 <other addresses>
3176.endd
3177.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3178.cindex "size" "of message"
3179The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3180(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3181identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3182envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3183&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3184the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3185before the sender address.
3186
3187.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3188If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3189&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3190
3191The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3192displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3193been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3194expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3195displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3196complete.
3197
3198
3199.vitem &%-bpa%&
3200.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3201This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3202that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3203alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3204of just &"D"&.
3205
3206
3207.vitem &%-bpc%&
3208.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3209.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3210This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3211to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3212&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3213
3214
3215.vitem &%-bpr%&
3216.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3217This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3218chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3219lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3220going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3221
3222.vitem &%-bpra%&
3223.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3224This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3225
3226.vitem &%-bpru%&
3227.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3228This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3229
3230
3231.vitem &%-bpu%&
3232.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3233This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3234addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3235forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3236router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3237
3238
3239.vitem &%-brt%&
3240.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3241.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3242.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3243This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3244arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3245and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3246.code
3247exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3248Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3249.endd
3250See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3251argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3252&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3253contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3254retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3255with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3256rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3257sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3258used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3259.code
3260exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3261Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3262.endd
3263
3264.vitem &%-brw%&
3265.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3266.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3267.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3268This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3269a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3270complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3271would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3272&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3273
3274.vitem &%-bS%&
3275.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3276.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3277.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3278This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3279for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3280submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3281input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3282input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3283&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3284believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3285
3286The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3287dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3288provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3289
3290As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3291messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3292Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3293&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3294
3295Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3296as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3297QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3298
3299.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3300If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3301error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3302was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3303was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3304
3305More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3306&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3307
3308.vitem &%-bs%&
3309.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3310.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3311.cindex "local SMTP input"
3312This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3313on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3314policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3315Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3316messages to the MTA.
3317
3318In
3319.cindex "sender" "source of"
3320this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3321set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3322Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3323the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3324&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3325&%-bnq%& option is used.
3326
3327.cindex "inetd"
3328The
3329&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3330using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3331whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3332&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3333above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3334Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3335the listening daemon.
3336
3337.vitem &%-bt%&
3338.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3339.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3340.cindex "address" "testing"
3341This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3342as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3343written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3344user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3345sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3346
3347If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3348right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3349
3350Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3351&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3352security issues.
3353
3354Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3355(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3356written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3357&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3358genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3359program.
3360
3361.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3362The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3363failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3364code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3365
3366.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3367&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3368addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3369This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3370always shown.
3371
3372&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3373routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3374message,
3375.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3376you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3377&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3378default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3379whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3380those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3381doing such tests.
3382
3383.vitem &%-bV%&
3384.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3385.cindex "version number of Exim"
3386This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3387number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3388It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3389specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3390name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3391
3392As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3393configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3394values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3395detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3396alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3397realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3398dynamic testing facilities.
3399
3400.vitem &%-bv%&
3401.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3402.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3403.cindex "address" "verification"
3404This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3405taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3406not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3407happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3408(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3409including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3410
3411If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3412failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3413usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3414
3415If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3416right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3417
3418Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3419&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3420security issues.
3421
3422Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3423that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3424router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3425verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3426address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3427
3428If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3429address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3430latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3431causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3432addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3433and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3434to succeed.
3435
3436When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3437and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3438considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3439
3440The
3441.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3442return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3443failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3444code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3445
3446If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3447address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3448sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3449calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3450
3451.vitem &%-bvs%&
3452.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3453This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3454than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3455might happen.
3456
3457.vitem &%-bw%&
3458.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3459.cindex "daemon"
3460.cindex "inetd"
3461.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3462This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3463similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3464and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3465
3466In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3467listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3468inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3469each port only when the first connection is received.
3470
3471If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3472which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3473
3474.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3475.oindex "&%-C%&"
3476.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3477.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3478.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3479This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3480list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3481compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3482name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3483file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3484proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3485
3486When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3487from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3488runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3489However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3490file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3491which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3492listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3493CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3494not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3495
3496Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3497configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3498even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3499running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3500delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3501test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3502on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3503
3504If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3505prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3506must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3507However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3508CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3509usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3510unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3511
3512ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3513to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3514broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3515configuration file.
3516
3517The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3518syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3519caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3520require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3521specified by this option.
3522
3523
3524.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3525.oindex "&%-D%&"
3526.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3527This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3528(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3529unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3530If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3531completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3532
3533If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3534colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3535supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3536not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3537the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3538to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3539regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3540
3541The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3542command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3543string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3544synonymous:
3545.code
3546exim -DABC ...
3547exim -DABC= ...
3548.endd
3549To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3550quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3551example:
3552.code
3553exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3554.endd
3555&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3556
3557
3558.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3559.oindex "&%-d%&"
3560.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3561.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3562This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3563error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3564database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3565filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3566writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3567return code.
3568
3569When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3570standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3571some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3572made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3573of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3574debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3575no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3576are:
3577.display
3578&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3579&`auth `& authenticators
3580&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3581&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3582&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3583&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3584&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3585&`filter `& filter handling
3586&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3587&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3588&`ident `& ident lookup
3589&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3590&`lists `& matching things in lists
3591&`load `& system load checks
3592&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3593 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3594&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3595&`memory `& memory handling
3596&`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3597&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3598&`queue_run `& queue runs
3599&`receive `& general message reception logic
3600&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3601&`retry `& retry handling
3602&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3603&`route `& address routing
3604&`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3605&`tls `& TLS logic
3606&`transport `& transports
3607&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3608&`verify `& address verification logic
3609&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3610.endd
3611The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3612for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3613tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3614is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3615generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3616turn everything off.
3617
3618.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3619.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3620The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3621with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3622unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3623rather than stderr.
3624
3625The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3626&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3627However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3628daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3629automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3630run in parallel.
3631
3632The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3633of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3634in processing.
3635
3636If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3637any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3638
3639.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3640.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3641This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3642starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3643subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3644behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3645
3646.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3647.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3648This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3649handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3650described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3651
3652.vitem &%-E%&
3653.oindex "&%-E%&"
3654.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3655This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3656failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3657and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3658generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3659could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3660follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3661new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3662
3663.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3664.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3665There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3666called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3667example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3668form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3669
3670.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3671.oindex "&%-F%&"
3672.cindex "sender" "name"
3673.cindex "name" "of sender"
3674This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3675message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3676entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3677their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3678between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3679
3680.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3681.oindex "&%-f%&"
3682.cindex "sender" "address"
3683.cindex "address" "sender"
3684.cindex "trusted users"
3685.cindex "envelope sender"
3686.cindex "user" "trusted"
3687This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3688message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3689by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3690users to use it.
3691
3692Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3693trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3694options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3695of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3696domain.
3697
3698There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3699can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3700never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3701string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3702examples of shell commands:
3703.code
3704exim -f '<>' user@domain
3705exim -f "" user@domain
3706.endd
3707In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3708with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3709&%-bv%& options.
3710
3711Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3712it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3713refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3714though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3715
3716White
3717.cindex "&""From""& line"
3718space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3719given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3720locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3721&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3722if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3723
3724.vitem &%-G%&
3725.oindex "&%-G%&"
3726.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3727This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3728.code
3729control = suppress_local_fixups
3730.endd
3731for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3732bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3733in future.
3734
3735As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3736this option.
3737
3738.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3739.oindex "&%-h%&"
3740.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3741This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3742Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3743headers.)
3744
3745.vitem &%-i%&
3746.oindex "&%-i%&"
3747.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3748.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3749This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3750line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3751no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3752command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3753
3754.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3755.oindex "&%-L%&"
3756.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3757This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3758file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3759Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3760read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3761effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3762
3763The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3764
3765.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3766.oindex "&%-M%&"
3767.cindex "forcing delivery"
3768.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3769.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3770This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3771any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3772delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3773and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3774
3775Retry
3776.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3777hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3778the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3779to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3780which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3781for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3782
3783The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3784not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3785produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3786use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3787
3788.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3789.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3790.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3791.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3792This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3793message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3794id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3795active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3796can be used only by an admin user.
3797
3798.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3799 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3800.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3801.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3802.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3803.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3804This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3805by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3806an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3807given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3808must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3809
3810.vitem &%-MCA%&
3811.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3812This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3813by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3814connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3815
3816.new
3817.vitem &%-MCD%&
3818.oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3819This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3820by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3821remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3822.wen
3823
3824.vitem &%-MCP%&
3825.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3826This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3827by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3828which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3829
3830.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3831.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3832This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3833by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3834started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3835together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3836signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3837messages through the same SMTP connection.
3838
3839.vitem &%-MCS%&
3840.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3841This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3842by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3843SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3844connection.
3845
3846.vitem &%-MCT%&
3847.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3848This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3849by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3850host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3851
3852.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3853.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3854.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3855.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3856This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3857but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3858that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3859provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3860order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3861However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3862respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3863overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3864If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3865&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3866and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3867
3868.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3869.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3870.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3871.cindex "sender" "changing"
3872This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3873given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3874&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3875be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3876is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3877This option can be used only by an admin user.
3878
3879.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3880.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3881.cindex "freezing messages"
3882.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3883This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3884prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3885either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3886However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3887attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3888user.
3889
3890.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3891.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3892.cindex "giving up on messages"
3893.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3894.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3895This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3896including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3897their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3898is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3899Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3900user.
3901
3902.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3903.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3904.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3905This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3906as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3907message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3908altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3909
3910.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3911.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3912.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3913.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3914.cindex "removing recipients"
3915This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3916(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3917the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3918addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3919(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3920can be used only by an admin user.
3921
3922.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3923.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3924.cindex "removing messages"
3925.cindex "abandoning mail"
3926.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3927This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3928bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3929the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3930only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3931placed on the queue.
3932
3933.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3934.oindex "&%-Mset%&
3935.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3936.cindex "expansion" "testing"
3937This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3938string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3939the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3940&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3941available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3942make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3943user. See also &%-bem%&.
3944
3945.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3946.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3947.cindex "thawing messages"
3948.cindex "unfreezing messages"
3949.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3950.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3951This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3952&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3953messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3954by an admin user.
3955
3956.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3957.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3958.cindex "listing" "message body"
3959.cindex "message" "listing body of"
3960This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3961written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3962
3963.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3964.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3965.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3966.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3967This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3968be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3969only by an admin user.
3970
3971.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3972.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3973.cindex "listing" "message headers"
3974.cindex "header lines" "listing"
3975.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3976This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3977written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3978
3979.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3980.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3981.cindex "listing" "message log"
3982.cindex "message" "listing message log"
3983This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3984the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3985
3986.vitem &%-m%&
3987.oindex "&%-m%&"
3988This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3989treats it that way too.
3990
3991.vitem &%-N%&
3992.oindex "&%-N%&"
3993.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3994.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3995This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3996level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3997it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3998had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3999database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4000than &"=>"&.
4001
4002Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4003user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4004words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4005which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4006address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4007routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4008the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4009for that message.
4010
4011.vitem &%-n%&
4012.oindex "&%-n%&"
4013This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4014For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4015When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4016
4017.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4018.oindex "&%-O%&"
4019This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4020Exim.
4021
4022.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4023.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4024.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4025This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4026alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4027description above.
4028
4029.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4030.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4031.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4032.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4033.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4034This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4035be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4036transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4037
4038.vitem &%-odb%&
4039.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4040.cindex "background delivery"
4041.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4042This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4043including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4044messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4045delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4046processes to finish.
4047
4048When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4049leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4050and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4051This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4052
4053If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4054(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4055overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4056setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4057
4058.vitem &%-odf%&
4059.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4060.cindex "foreground delivery"
4061.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4062This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4063accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4064&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4065and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4066
4067The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4068process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4069during deliveries.
4070
4071However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4072false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4073
4074If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4075message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4076process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4077restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4078
4079
4080.vitem &%-odi%&
4081.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4082This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4083Sendmail.
4084
4085.vitem &%-odq%&
4086.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4087.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4088.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4089.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4090This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4091including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4092not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4093are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4094process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4095&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4096conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4097forces queueing.
4098
4099.vitem &%-odqs%&
4100.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4101.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4102This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4103However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4104&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4105configuration file is in effect.
4106
4107When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4108message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4109also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4110in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4111done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4112runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4113messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4114host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4115configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4116&%-qq%& option.
4117
4118.vitem &%-oee%&
4119.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4120.cindex "error" "reporting"
4121If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4122example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4123message.
4124
4125.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4126Provided
4127this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4128exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4129is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4130This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4131
4132.vitem &%-oem%&
4133.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4134.cindex "error" "reporting"
4135.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4136This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4137return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4138This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4139
4140.vitem &%-oep%&
4141.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4142.cindex "error" "reporting"
4143If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4144error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4145.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4146The return code is 1 for all errors.
4147
4148.vitem &%-oeq%&
4149.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4150.cindex "error" "reporting"
4151This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4152effect as &%-oep%&.
4153
4154.vitem &%-oew%&
4155.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4156.cindex "error" "reporting"
4157This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4158effect as &%-oem%&.
4159
4160.vitem &%-oi%&
4161.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4162.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4163This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4164line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4165single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4166lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4167&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4168
4169.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4170.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4171This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4172
4173.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4174.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4175.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4176A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4177with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4178over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4179&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4180other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4181
4182The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4183number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4184.code
4185exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4186.endd
4187An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4188followed by a colon and the port number:
4189.code
4190exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4191.endd
4192The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4193port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4194are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4195whichever one is last.
4196
4197.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4198.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4199.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4200See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4201option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4202name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4203This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4204authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4205
4206.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4207.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4208.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4209See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4210option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4211This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4212where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4213&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4214
4215.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4216.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4217.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4218See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4219option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4220overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4221messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4222default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4223specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4224&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4225
4226.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4227.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4228.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4229See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4230option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4231using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4232&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4233
4234.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4235.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4236.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4237See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4238option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4239delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4240messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4241abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4242running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4243
4244The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4245The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4246is sending the bounce.
4247
4248.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4249.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4250.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4251.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4252See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4253option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4254&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4255or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4256SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4257&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4258one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4259be set by &%-oMr%&.
4260
4261.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4262.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4263.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4264See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4265option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4266present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4267uses the name it is given.
4268
4269.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4270.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4271.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4272See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4273option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4274local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4275used, when there is no default.
4276
4277.vitem &%-om%&
4278.oindex "&%-om%&"
4279.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4280In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4281message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4282expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4283
4284.vitem &%-oo%&
4285.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4286.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4287This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4288whatever that means.
4289
4290.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4291.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4292.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4293.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4294This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4295value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4296written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4297without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4298because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4299
4300.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4301.oindex "&%-or%&"
4302.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4303This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4304set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4305by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4306described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4307
4308.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4309.oindex "&%-os%&"
4310.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4311.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4312This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4313applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4314the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4315for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4316
4317.vitem &%-ov%&
4318.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4319This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4320
4321.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4322.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4323.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4324.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4325.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4326This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4327is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4328of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4329in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4330file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4331
4332.vitem &%-pd%&
4333.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4334.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4335This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4336chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4337option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4338needed.
4339
4340.vitem &%-ps%&
4341.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4342.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4343This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4344chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4345option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4346started.
4347
4348.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4349.oindex "&%-p%&"
4350For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4351.display
4352&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4353.endd
4354It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4355host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4356Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4357to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4358or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4359
4360.vitem &%-q%&
4361.oindex "&%-q%&"
4362.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4363This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4364configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4365relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4366and &%-S%& options).
4367
4368.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4369The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4370waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4371for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4372process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4373have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4374
4375If
4376.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4377.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4378.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4379the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4380passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4381proceeding.
4382
4383When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4384process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4385mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4386this to be repeated periodically.
4387
4388Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4389random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4390If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4391MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4392
4393It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4394order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4395&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4396
4397.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4398The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4399behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4400appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4401
4402.vitem &%-qq...%&
4403.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4404.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4405.cindex "queue" "routing"
4406.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4407An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4408stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4409every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4410transports are run.
4411
4412.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4413The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4414is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4415complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4416place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4417delivered down a single SMTP
4418.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4419.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4420.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4421connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4422This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4423intermittently.
4424
4425.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4426.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4427.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4428If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4429those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4430delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4431&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4432
4433.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4434.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4435.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4436.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4437If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4438message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4439their retry times are tried.
4440
4441.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4442.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4443.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4444If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4445frozen or not.
4446
4447.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4448.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4449.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4450The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4451be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4452for later delivery.
4453
4454.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4455.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4456When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4457lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4458starting message id. For example:
4459.code
4460exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4461.endd
4462Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4463second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4464are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4465.code
4466exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4467.endd
4468just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4469&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4470that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4471mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4472are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4473queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4474
4475.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4476.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4477.cindex "periodic queue running"
4478When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4479starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4480(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4481&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4482single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4483combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4484.code
4485/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4486.endd
4487Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4488process every 30 minutes.
4489
4490When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4491pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4492
4493.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4494.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4495This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4496compatibility.
4497
4498.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4499.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4500This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4501
4502.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4503.oindex "&%-R%&"
4504.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4505.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4506.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4507The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4508is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4509which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4510<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4511
4512This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4513perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4514queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4515address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4516way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4517regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4518
4519If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4520you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4521.code
4522exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4523.endd
4524This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4525every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4526applied to each queue run.
4527
4528Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4529are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4530information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4531means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4532existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4533address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4534will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4535information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4536address will be skipped.
4537
4538.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4539If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4540all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4541&'ff'& is present.
4542
4543The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4544to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4545command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4546effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4547an arbitrary command instead.
4548
4549.vitem &%-r%&
4550.oindex "&%-r%&"
4551This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4552
4553.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4554.oindex "&%-S%&"
4555.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4556.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4557This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4558message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4559conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4560has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4561
4562.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4563.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4564This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4565recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4566&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4567
4568.vitem &%-t%&
4569.oindex "&%-t%&"
4570.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4571.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4572.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4573.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4574When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4575input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4576from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4577from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4578takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4579
4580.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4581If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4582is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4583the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4584and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4585Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4586Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4587argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4588Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4589instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4590&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4591
4592.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4593If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4594recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4595lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4596with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4597&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4598
4599RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4600message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4601added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4602not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4603nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4604In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4605are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4606once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4607&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4608
4609.vitem &%-ti%&
4610.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4611This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4612compatibility with Sendmail.
4613
4614.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4615.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4616.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4617.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4618This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4619incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4620&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4621&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4622
4623
4624.vitem &%-U%&
4625.oindex "&%-U%&"
4626.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4627Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4628documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4629syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4630set. Exim ignores this option.
4631
4632.vitem &%-v%&
4633.oindex "&%-v%&"
4634This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4635describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4636receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4637dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4638the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4639selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4640unconditional.
4641
4642.vitem &%-x%&
4643.oindex "&%-x%&"
4644AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4645National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4646It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4647this option.
4648
4649.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4650.oindex "&%-X%&"
4651This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4652to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4653
4654.new
4655.vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4656.oindex "&%-z%&"
4657This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4658Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4659Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4660under most shells.
4661.wen
4662.endlist
4663
4664.ecindex IIDclo1
4665.ecindex IIDclo2
4666
4667
4668. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4669. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4670. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4671. creates a man page for the options.
4672. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4673
4674.literal xml
4675<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4676.literal off
4677
4678
4679
4680
4681
4682. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4683. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4684
4685
4686.chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4687 "The runtime configuration file"
4688
4689.cindex "run time configuration"
4690.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4691.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4692.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4693.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4694.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4695Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4696binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4697because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4698control.
4699
4700If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4701writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4702The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4703errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4704not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4705actually alter the string.
4706
4707The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4708reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4709most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4710give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4711existing file in the list.
4712
4713.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4714.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4715.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4716.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4717.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4718.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4719The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4720specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4721configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4722group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4723CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4724
4725&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4726to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4727easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4728CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4729who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4730
4731Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4732be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4733since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4734compromise the Exim user account.
4735
4736A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4737is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4738defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4739configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4740CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4741&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4742configuration.
4743
4744
4745
4746.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4747.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4748A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4749option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4750&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4751unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4752CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4753is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4754is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4755installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4756specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4757
4758Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4759with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4760listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4761testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4762delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4763Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4764the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4765can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4766message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4767&%-M%&).
4768
4769If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4770prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4771start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4772There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4773name can be used with &%-C%&.
4774
4775One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4776option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4777configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4778non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4779If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4780completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4781
4782The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4783to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4784necessarily be discarded.
4785WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4786considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4787values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4788is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4789transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4790values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4791
4792Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4793share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4794If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4795looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4796and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4797file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4798each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4799
4800In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4801different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4802help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4803
4804
4805
4806.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4807.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4808.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4809Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4810option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4811are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4812is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4813optional parts are:
4814
4815.ilist
4816&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4817&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4818.next
4819.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4820&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4821are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4822.next
4823&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4824addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4825&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4826.next
4827&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4828define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4829&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4830.next
4831&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4832If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4833defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4834are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4835&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4836.next
4837&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4838when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4839chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4840.next
4841&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4842want to use this feature, you must set
4843.code
4844LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4845.endd
4846in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4847facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4848.endlist
4849
4850.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4851.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4852.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4853Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4854
4855Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4856leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4857# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4858and does not introduce a comment.
4859
4860Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4861the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4862backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4863lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4864appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4865
4866A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4867default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4868change settings as required.
4869
4870The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4871described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4872respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4873items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4874onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4875described.
4876
4877
4878
4879.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4880.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4881.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4882.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4883.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4884You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4885using this syntax:
4886.display
4887&`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4888&`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4889.endd
4890on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4891the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4892second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4893name is required.
4894
4895Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4896configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4897If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4898because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4899
4900The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4901comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4902for example:
4903.code
4904hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4905 .include /some/file
4906.endd
4907Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4908process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4909inclusion appears.
4910
4911
4912
4913.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4914.cindex "macro" "description of"
4915.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4916If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4917&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4918definition, and must be of the form
4919.display
4920<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4921.endd
4922The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4923in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4924continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4925space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4926a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4927
4928Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4929definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4930ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4931
4932.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4933Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4934files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4935scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4936replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4937for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4938the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4939define
4940.display
4941&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4942&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4943.endd
4944but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4945error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4946before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4947consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4948line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4949comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4950
4951
4952.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4953Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4954(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4955&'='&. For example:
4956.code
4957MAC = initial value
4958...
4959MAC == updated value
4960.endd
4961Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4962subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4963the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4964Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4965.code
4966MAC = initial value
4967...
4968MAC == MAC and something added
4969.endd
4970This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4971from a number of other files.
4972
4973.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4974The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4975&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4976used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4977using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4978file to be ignored.
4979
4980
4981
4982.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4983As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4984up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4985strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4986.code
4987ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4988 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4989.endd
4990This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4991.code
4992data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4993.endd
4994In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4995address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4996section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4997
4998
4999.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5000.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5001.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5002You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5003&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5004portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5005read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5006
5007The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5008be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5009that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5010line. Thus:
5011.code
5012.ifdef AAA
5013message_size_limit = 50M
5014.else
5015message_size_limit = 100M
5016.endif
5017.endd
5018sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5019(or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5020otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5021is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5022obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5023
5024Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5025it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5026in this line"& will always be true.
5027
5028Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5029to clarify complicated nestings.
5030
5031
5032
5033.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5034.cindex "common option syntax"
5035.cindex "syntax of common options"
5036.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5037For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5038each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5039lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5040these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5041space) and then the value. For example:
5042.code
5043qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5044.endd
5045.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5046.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5047.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5048Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5049accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5050line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5051word &"hide"&. For example:
5052.code
5053hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5054.endd
5055For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5056.code
5057mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5058.endd
5059If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5060all instances of the same driver.
5061
5062The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5063that are found in option settings.
5064
5065
5066.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5067.cindex "format" "boolean"
5068.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5069.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5070.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5071Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5072different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5073the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5074if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5075boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5076&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5077the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5078.code
5079queue_only
5080queue_only = true
5081.endd
5082The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5083.code
5084no_queue_only
5085queue_only = false
5086.endd
5087You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5088
5089
5090
5091
5092.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5093.cindex "integer configuration values"
5094.cindex "format" "integer"
5095If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5096hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5097number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5098with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5099hexadecimal number.
5100
5101If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5102it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5103of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
51041024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5105and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5106used.
5107
5108
5109.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5110.cindex "integer format"
5111.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5112If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5113interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5114Such options are always output in octal.
5115
5116
5117.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5118.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5119.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5120If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5121integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5122
5123
5124
5125.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5126.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5127.cindex "format" "time interval"
5128A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5129the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5130
5131.table2 30pt
5132.irow &%s%& seconds
5133.irow &%m%& minutes
5134.irow &%h%& hours
5135.irow &%d%& days
5136.irow &%w%& weeks
5137.endtable
5138
5139For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5140intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5141is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5142
5143
5144
5145.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5146.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5147.cindex "format" "string"
5148If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5149or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5150consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5151the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5152removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5153Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5154appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5155therefore equivalent:
5156.code
5157trusted_users = uucp:mail
5158trusted_users = uucp:\
5159 # This comment line is ignored
5160 mail
5161.endd
5162.cindex "string" "quoted"
5163.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5164If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5165double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5166continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5167
5168.table2 100pt
5169.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5170.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5171.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5172.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5173.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5174.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5175 character"
5176.endtable
5177
5178If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5179character, that character replaces the pair.
5180
5181Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5182insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5183trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5184current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5185in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5186and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5187
5188
5189.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5190.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5191Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5192by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5193circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5194is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5195strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5196However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5197backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5198within a quoted configuration string.
5199
5200
5201.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5202.cindex "user name" "format of"
5203.cindex "format" "user name"
5204.cindex "groups" "name format"
5205.cindex "format" "group name"
5206User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5207above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5208either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5209&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5210
5211
5212.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5213.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5214.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5215.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5216The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5217default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5218the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5219&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5220are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5221particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5222&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5223
5224In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5225input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5226&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5227in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5228on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5229start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5230example, the list
5231.code
5232local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5233.endd
5234contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5235
5236&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5237list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5238colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5239be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5240
5241.section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5242.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5243.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5244Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5245introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5246with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5247character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5248above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5249.code
5250local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5251.endd
5252This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5253&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5254confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5255
5256.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5257.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5258It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5259code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5260must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5261are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5262sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5263interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5264generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5265.code
5266domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5267.endd
5268This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5269to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5270expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5271the value in quotes. For example:
5272.code
5273local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5274.endd
5275Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5276doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5277set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5278enclosing an empty list item.
5279
5280
5281
5282.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5283.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5284An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5285separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5286.code
5287senders = user@domain :
5288.endd
5289contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5290in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5291items, the second of which is empty:
5292.code
5293senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5294.endd
5295&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5296are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5297would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5298just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5299.code
5300senders = :
5301.endd
5302In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5303is at the end of the list.
5304
5305
5306
5307
5308.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5309.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5310There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5311and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5312instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5313a sequence of lines like this:
5314.display
5315<&'instance name'&>:
5316 <&'option'&>
5317 ...
5318 <&'option'&>
5319.endd
5320In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5321followed by three options settings:
5322.code
5323localuser:
5324 driver = accept
5325 check_local_user
5326 transport = local_delivery
5327.endd
5328For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5329setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5330settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5331deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5332a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5333described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5334
5335You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5336the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5337
5338The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5339passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5340transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5341authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5342them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5343server.
5344
5345.cindex "generic options"
5346.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5347Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5348and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5349same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5350&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5351.cindex "private options"
5352The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5353they all have default values.
5354
5355The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5356precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5357this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5358
5359Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5360elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5361with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5362a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5363instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5364confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5365configuration lines:
5366.code
5367remote_smtp:
5368 driver = smtp
5369.endd
5370create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5371&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5372different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5373instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5374thus:
5375.code
5376special_smtp:
5377 driver = smtp
5378 port = 1234
5379 command_timeout = 10s
5380.endd
5381The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5382these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5383lines.
5384
5385Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5386list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5387defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5388option.
5389
5390
5391
5392
5393
5394
5395. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5396. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5397
5398.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5399.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5400.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5401The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5402is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5403the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5404configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5405of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5406itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5407initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5408mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5409
5410
5411
5412.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5413The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5414file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5415the line
5416.code
5417# primary_hostname =
5418.endd
5419This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5420to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5421can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5422it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5423
5424The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5425.code
5426domainlist local_domains = @
5427domainlist relay_to_domains =
5428hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5429.endd
5430These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5431domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5432domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5433configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5434
5435The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5436later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5437on the local host.
5438
5439.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5440There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5441of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5442called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5443be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5444the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5445
5446The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5447list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5448controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5449domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5450domain is permitted.
5451
5452The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5453used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5454that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5455loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5456submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5457hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5458
5459Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5460we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5461and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5462
5463The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5464.code
5465acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5466acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5467.endd
5468These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5469during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5470command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5471respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5472&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5473section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5474accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5475to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5476contents of a message to be checked.
5477
5478Two commented-out option settings are next:
5479.code
5480# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5481# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5482.endd
5483These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5484content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5485scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5486details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5487
5488Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5489.code
5490# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5491# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5492# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5493.endd
5494These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5495support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5496first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5497connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5498other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5499key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5500More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5501
5502Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5503.code
5504# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5505# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5506.endd
5507.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5508.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5509.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5510.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5511.cindex "smtps protocol"
5512.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5513.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5514These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5515server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5516TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5517more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5518on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5519port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5520configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5521non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5522&<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5523
5524Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5525.code
5526# qualify_domain =
5527# qualify_recipient =
5528.endd
5529The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5530complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5531receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5532the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5533you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5534addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5535
5536.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5537The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5538addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5539(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5540.code
5541# allow_domain_literals
5542.endd
5543The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5544Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5545quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5546try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5547people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5548&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5549
5550The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5551.code
5552never_users = root
5553.endd
5554It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5555convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5556setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5557The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5558list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5559FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5560contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5561FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5562
5563When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5564Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5565line,
5566.code
5567host_lookup = *
5568.endd
5569specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5570in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5571information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5572or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5573Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5574because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5575unreachable.
5576
5577The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
55781413 (hence their names):
5579.code
5580rfc1413_hosts = *
5581rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5582.endd
5583These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5584Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5585terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5586of an incoming SMTP connection.
5587If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5588information, you can change this.
5589
5590This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5591and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5592.code
5593prdr_enable = true
5594.endd
5595
5596When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5597be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5598if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5599find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5600.code
5601# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5602# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5603.endd
5604show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5605and recipient addresses, respectively.
5606
5607.new
5608The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5609over the default:
5610.code
5611log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5612 +tls_certificate_verified
5613.endd
5614.wen
5615
5616The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5617.code
5618# percent_hack_domains =
5619.endd
5620It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5621This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5622anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5623
5624The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5625concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5626message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5627occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5628address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5629bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5630are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5631always bounce messages.
5632.code
5633ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5634timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5635.endd
5636The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5637discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5638message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5639after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5640bounce message ever lasts a week.
5641
5642
5643
5644.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5645.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5646.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5647In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5648It starts with the line
5649.code
5650begin acl
5651.endd
5652and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5653&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5654and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5655
5656.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5657The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5658RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5659are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5660rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5661result of the ACL processing.
5662.code
5663acl_check_rcpt:
5664.endd
5665This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5666ACL, and names it.
5667.code
5668accept hosts = :
5669.endd
5670This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5671But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5672names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5673list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5674host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5675important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5676
5677What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5678messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5679input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5680manner.
5681.code
5682deny message = Restricted characters in address
5683 domains = +local_domains
5684 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5685
5686deny message = Restricted characters in address
5687 domains = !+local_domains
5688 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5689.endd
5690These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5691characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5692Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5693&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5694in Internet mail addresses.
5695
5696The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5697addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5698option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5699in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5700programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5701at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5702characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5703policy of being as safe as possible.
5704
5705The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5706to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5707first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5708&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5709reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5710&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5711
5712The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5713block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5714or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5715have to modify this rule.
5716
5717Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5718allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5719common convention of local parts constructed as
5720&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5721the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5722with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5723file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5724that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5725is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5726
5727The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5728allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5729and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5730with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5731local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5732and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5733(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5734.code
5735accept local_parts = postmaster
5736 domains = +local_domains
5737.endd
5738This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5739local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5740&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5741reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5742&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5743
5744The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5745by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5746in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5747.code
5748require verify = sender
5749.endd
5750This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5751ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5752address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5753see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5754addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5755used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5756discusses the details of address verification.
5757.code
5758accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5759 control = submission
5760.endd
5761This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5762hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5763verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5764that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5765second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5766is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5767messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5768&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5769probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5770.code
5771accept authenticated = *
5772 control = submission
5773.endd
5774This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5775Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5776likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5777authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5778examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5779fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5780.code
5781require message = relay not permitted
5782 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5783.endd
5784This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5785one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5786.code
5787require verify = recipient
5788.endd
5789This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5790fails, the address is rejected.
5791.code
5792# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5793# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5794# $dnslist_text
5795# dnslists = black.list.example
5796#
5797# warn dnslists = black.list.example
5798# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5799# a black list at $dnslist_domain
5800# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5801.endd
5802These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5803sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5804from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5805line.
5806.code
5807# require verify = csa
5808.endd
5809This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5810authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5811records.
5812.code
5813accept
5814.endd
5815The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5816address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5817.code
5818acl_check_data:
5819.endd
5820This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5821of this ACL are commented out:
5822.code
5823# deny malware = *
5824# message = This message contains a virus \
5825# ($malware_name).
5826.endd
5827These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5828viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5829suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5830virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5831.code
5832# warn spam = nobody
5833# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5834# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5835# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5836# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5837.endd
5838These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5839SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5840and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5841&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5842series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5843whatever the spam score.
5844.code
5845accept
5846.endd
5847This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5848
5849
5850.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5851.cindex "default" "routers"
5852.cindex "routers" "default"
5853The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5854by the line
5855.code
5856begin routers
5857.endd
5858Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5859messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5860accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5861matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5862manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5863.code
5864# domain_literal:
5865# driver = ipliteral
5866# domains = !+local_domains
5867# transport = remote_smtp
5868.endd
5869.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5870This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5871support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5872you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5873&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5874.code
5875dnslookup:
5876 driver = dnslookup
5877 domains = ! +local_domains
5878 transport = remote_smtp
5879 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5880 no_more
5881.endd
5882The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5883domains. This is specified by the line
5884.code
5885domains = ! +local_domains
5886.endd
5887The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5888exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5889that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5890the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5891indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5892passed on to the following routers.
5893
5894The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5895and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5896the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5897instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5898one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5899
5900The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5901DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5902router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5903specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5904in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5905the address fails and is bounced.
5906
5907The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5908be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5909encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5910whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5911Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5912email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5913continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5914out.
5915.code
5916system_aliases:
5917 driver = redirect
5918 allow_fail
5919 allow_defer
5920 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5921# user = exim
5922 file_transport = address_file
5923 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5924.endd
5925Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5926domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5927alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5928data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5929the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5930the next router.
5931
5932&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5933often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5934file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5935&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5936.code
5937userforward:
5938 driver = redirect
5939 check_local_user
5940# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5941# local_part_suffix_optional
5942 file = $home/.forward
5943# allow_filter
5944 no_verify
5945 no_expn
5946 check_ancestor
5947 file_transport = address_file
5948 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5949 reply_transport = address_reply
5950.endd
5951This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5952redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5953individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5954local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5955router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5956namely:
5957.code
5958# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5959# local_part_suffix_optional
5960.endd
5961.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5962show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5963is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5964by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5965variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5966presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5967the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5968
5969When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5970home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5971declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5972redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5973
5974.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5975Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5976files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5977is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5978of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5979filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5980separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5981
5982The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5983verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5984There are two reasons for doing this:
5985
5986.olist
5987Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5988checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5989unnecessary work.
5990.next
5991More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5992command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5993The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5994It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5995this time.
5996.endlist
5997
5998The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5999address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6000works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6001forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6002
6003The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6004forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6005auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6006.code
6007a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6008.endd
6009the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6010transport.
6011.code
6012localuser:
6013 driver = accept
6014 check_local_user
6015# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6016# local_part_suffix_optional
6017 transport = local_delivery
6018.endd
6019The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6020part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6021the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6022routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6023same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6024
6025
6026.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6027.cindex "default" "transports"
6028.cindex "transports" "default"
6029Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6030only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6031not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6032.code
6033begin transports
6034.endd
6035One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6036.code
6037remote_smtp:
6038 driver = smtp
6039 hosts_try_prdr = *
6040.endd
6041This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6042The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6043The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6044It is negotiated between client and server
6045and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6046All other options are defaulted.
6047.code
6048local_delivery:
6049 driver = appendfile
6050 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6051 delivery_date_add
6052 envelope_to_add
6053 return_path_add
6054# group = mail
6055# mode = 0660
6056.endd
6057This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6058traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6059local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6060directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6061under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6062show how this can be done.
6063
6064Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6065&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6066similarly-named options above.
6067.code
6068address_pipe:
6069 driver = pipe
6070 return_output
6071.endd
6072This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6073redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6074option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6075sender.
6076.code
6077address_file:
6078 driver = appendfile
6079 delivery_date_add
6080 envelope_to_add
6081 return_path_add
6082.endd
6083This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6084redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6085&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6086.code
6087address_reply:
6088 driver = autoreply
6089.endd
6090This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6091filter files.
6092
6093
6094
6095.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6096.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6097.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6098The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6099Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6100introduced by the line
6101.code
6102begin retry
6103.endd
6104In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6105errors:
6106.code
6107* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6108.endd
6109This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
61102 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
61111.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6112is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6113
6114If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6115if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6116temporary errors into permanent errors.
6117
6118
6119.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6120The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6121.code
6122begin rewrite
6123.endd
6124contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6125rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6126
6127
6128
6129.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6130.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6131The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6132.code
6133begin authenticators
6134.endd
6135defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6136configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6137which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6138standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6139mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6140to support most MUA software.
6141
6142The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6143.code
6144#PLAIN:
6145# driver = plaintext
6146# server_set_id = $auth2
6147# server_prompts = :
6148# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6149# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6150.endd
6151And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6152.code
6153#LOGIN:
6154# driver = plaintext
6155# server_set_id = $auth1
6156# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6157# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6158# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6159.endd
6160
6161The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6162in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6163&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6164that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6165i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6166when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6167when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6168need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6169
6170The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6171password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6172To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6173expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6174
6175Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6176usercode and password are in different positions.
6177Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6178
6179.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6180
6181
6182
6183. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6184. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6185
6186.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6187
6188.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6189.cindex "PCRE"
6190Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6191uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6192matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6193regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6194Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6195O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6196
6197The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6198are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6199description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6200the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6201the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6202case-insensitive.
6203
6204In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6205it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6206or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6207second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6208.code
6209domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6210.endd
6211The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6212precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6213of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6214regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6215backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6216normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6217matched.
6218
6219There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6220recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6221string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6222these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6223it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6224match anywhere in the subject string.
6225
6226In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6227you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6228.code
6229domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6230.endd
6231matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6232You need to use:
6233.code
6234domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6235.endd
6236if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6237$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6238
6239
6240
6241. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6242. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6243
6244.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6245.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6246.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6247.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6248Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6249messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6250
6251.olist
6252A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6253cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6254lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6255can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6256&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6257.next
6258Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6259way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6260returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6261succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6262chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6263.endlist
6264
6265String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6266that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6267involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6268if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6269time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6270chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6271
6272.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6273It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6274lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6275processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6276Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6277.code
6278domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6279domains = lsearch;/some/file
6280.endd
6281The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6282No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6283defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6284The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6285file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6286.code
6287192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6288192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6289.endd
6290When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6291possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6292
6293In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6294Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6295in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6296.code
6297domain1:
6298domain2:
6299.endd
6300Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6301matches the list item.
6302
6303It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6304Consider a file containing lines like this:
6305.code
6306192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6307.endd
6308If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6309first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6310causes a second lookup to occur.
6311
6312The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6313available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6314lookup is permitted.
6315
6316
6317.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6318.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6319.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6320Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6321
6322.ilist
6323The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6324and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6325lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6326.next
6327.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6328The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6329key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6330Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6331.endlist
6332
6333The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6334the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6335default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6336.code
6337LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6338LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6339.endd
6340which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6341For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6342libraries and header files before building Exim.
6343
6344
6345
6346
6347.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6348.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6349.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6350The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6351
6352.ilist
6353.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6354.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6355.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6356&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6357string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6358indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6359re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6360aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6361be found in several places:
6362.display
6363&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6364&url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6365&url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6366.endd
6367A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6368because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6369However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6370you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6371.next
6372.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6373.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6374.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6375&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6376DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6377zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6378&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6379
6380.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6381For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6382when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6383using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6384the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6385that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6386other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6387.next
6388.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6389.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6390.cindex "sasldb2"
6391.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6392&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6393interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6394ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6395authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6396&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6397&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6398.next
6399.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6400.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6401.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6402.cindex "Courier"
6403.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6404.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6405&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6406is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6407if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6408other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6409use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6410calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6411utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6412by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6413.next
6414.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6415.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6416&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6417whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6418contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6419the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6420symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6421lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6422&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6423.next
6424.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6425.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6426&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6427terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6428file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6429IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6430being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6431.code
64321.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6433192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6434"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6435"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6436.endd
6437The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6438file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6439key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6440&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6441&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6442
6443&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6444&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6445lookup types support only literal keys.
6446
6447&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6448the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6449&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6450.next
6451.cindex "linear search"
6452.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6453.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6454.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6455&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6456line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6457end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6458letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6459in the file is used.
6460
6461White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6462line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6463continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6464space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6465junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6466colon, for example:
6467.code
6468baduser: :fail:
6469.endd
6470Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6471middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6472that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6473wildcarding of any kind.
6474
6475.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6476.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6477In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6478characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6479If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6480matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6481contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6482quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6483quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6484
6485.next
6486.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6487.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6488.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6489&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6490the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6491&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6492reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6493aliases; the full map names must be used.
6494
6495.next
6496.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6497.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6498.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6499.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6500&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6501&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6502the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6503that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6504used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6505
6506.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6507Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6508file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6509&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6510
6511. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6512. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6513
6514.olist
6515The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6516.code
6517 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6518 *fish data for anythingfish
6519.endd
6520.next
6521The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6522example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6523.code
6524 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6525.endd
6526Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6527expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6528string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6529.code
6530 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6531.endd
6532The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6533expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6534For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6535.code
6536 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6537.endd
6538
6539If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6540either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6541ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6542colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6543escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6544
6545&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6546match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6547is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6548takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6549&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6550
6551.next
6552Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6553is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6554lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6555example:
6556.code
6557 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6558.endd
6559The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6560.endlist olist
6561
6562Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6563continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6564be followed by optional colons.
6565
6566&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6567&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6568lookup types support only literal keys.
6569.endlist ilist
6570
6571
6572.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6573.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6574.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6575The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6576many of them are given in later sections.
6577
6578.ilist
6579.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6580.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6581&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6582are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6583records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6584.next
6585.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6586.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6587&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6588.next
6589.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6590.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6591&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6592returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6593that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6594called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6595any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6596.next
6597.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6598.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6599&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6600MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6601.next
6602.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6603.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6604&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6605the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6606.next
6607.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6608.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6609&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6610Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6611.next
6612.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6613.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6614.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6615&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6616lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6617success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6618lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6619password value. For example:
6620.code
6621*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6622.endd
6623.next
6624.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6625.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6626&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6627PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6628
6629.next
6630.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6631.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6632&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6633that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6634
6635.next
6636&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6637not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6638.next
6639.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6640.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6641&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6642allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6643address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6644obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6645at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6646superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6647&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6648.code
6649require condition = \
6650 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6651.endd
6652The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6653the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6654this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6655one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6656.endlist
6657
6658
6659
6660.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6661.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6662Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6663completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6664reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6665options such as a list of local domains.
6666
6667When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6668of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6669temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6670or may give up altogether.
6671
6672
6673
6674.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6675.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6676.cindex "lookup" "default values"
6677.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6678.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6679.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6680In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6681that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6682
6683&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6684lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6685specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6686
6687If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6688and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6689provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6690
6691.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6692.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6693.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6694Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6695&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6696character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6697by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6698that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6699take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6700For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6701.code
6702data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6703.endd
6704Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6705looks up these keys, in this order:
6706.code
6707jane@eyre.example
6708*@eyre.example
6709*
6710.endd
6711The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6712&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6713complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6714Exim move on to try the next key.
6715
6716
6717
6718.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6719.cindex "partial matching"
6720.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6721.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6722.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6723.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6724The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6725match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6726being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6727information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6728domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6729a key in a DBM file is
6730.code
6731*.dates.fict.example
6732.endd
6733then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6734&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6735by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6736file.
6737
6738&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6739also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6740&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6741
6742Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6743keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6744be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6745partial matching keys
6746beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6747Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6748unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6749
6750Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6751the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6752is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6753is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6754fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6755start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6756remains.
6757
6758A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6759by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6760&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6761modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6762subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6763up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6764.code
67652250.dates.fict.example
6766*.2250.dates.fict.example
6767*.dates.fict.example
6768*.fict.example
6769.endd
6770As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6771finishes.
6772
6773.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6774.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6775The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6776changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6777formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6778parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6779.code
6780domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6781.endd
6782In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6783&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6784components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6785other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6786.code
6787domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6788.endd
6789For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6790&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6791
6792If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6793just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6794down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6795
6796.ilist
6797If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6798.next
6799If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6800example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6801.next
6802Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6803remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6804for &"*"& on its own.
6805.next
6806Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6807.endlist
6808
6809
6810If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6811&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6812this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6813specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6814prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6815lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6816&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6817
6818The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6819in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6820dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6821in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6822subject key is always followed by a dot.
6823
6824
6825
6826
6827.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6828.cindex "lookup" "caching"
6829.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6830Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6831lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6832of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6833single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6834
6835For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6836another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6837many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6838the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6839closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6840own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6841
6842The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6843strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6844complete.
6845
6846
6847
6848
6849.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6850.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6851.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6852When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6853is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6854the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6855.code
6856[name=$local_part]
6857.endd
6858will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6859For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6860.code
6861[name="$local_part"]
6862.endd
6863but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6864NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6865rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6866of the following form is provided:
6867.code
6868${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6869.endd
6870For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6871.code
6872[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6873.endd
6874See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6875operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6876lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6877
6878
6879
6880
6881.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6882.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6883.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6884.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6885The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6886of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6887an expansion string could contain:
6888.code
6889${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6890.endd
6891If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6892is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6893&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6894&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6895
6896.new
6897The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6898and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6899If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6900.wen
6901
6902For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6903concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6904depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6905between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6906by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6907.code
6908${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6909.endd
6910It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6911white space is ignored.
6912For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6913an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6914separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6915
6916.cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6917When the type is PTR,
6918the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6919&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6920.code
6921${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6922.endd
6923If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6924altered and nothing is added.
6925
6926.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6927.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6928For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6929each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6930port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6931The field separator can be modified as above.
6932
6933.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6934.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6935For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6936unless a field separator is specified.
6937To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6938For SPF records the
6939default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6940.code
6941${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6942${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6943${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6944.endd
6945It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6946white space is ignored.
6947
6948.new
6949.cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6950For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6951successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6952Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6953specified.
6954.code
6955${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6956.endd
6957.wen
6958
6959.section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6960.cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6961.cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6962.cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6963Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are givien by optional keywords,
6964each followed by a comma,
6965that may appear before the record type.
6966
6967The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6968temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6969a defer-option modifier.
6970The possible keywords are
6971&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6972With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6973whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6974ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6975With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6976error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6977succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6978.code
6979${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6980${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6981.endd
6982Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6983yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6984
6985.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6986Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6987The possible keywords are
6988&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6989With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6990with the lookup.
6991With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6992is not labelled as authenticated data
6993is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
6994The default is &"never"&.
6995
6996See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
6997
6998.new
6999.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7000.cindex "DNS" timeout
7001Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7002The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7003(eg &"5s"&).
7004The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7005
7006Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7007The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7008The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7009.wen
7010
7011
7012.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7013.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7014By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7015each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7016the pseudo-type MXH:
7017.code
7018${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7019.endd
7020In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7021returned.
7022
7023.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7024Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7025records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7026component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7027records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7028error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7029but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7030top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7031.code
7032${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7033${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7034.endd
7035Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7036the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7037the name servers for &%edu%&.
7038
7039You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7040top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7041sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7042given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7043for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7044such a list.
7045
7046.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7047A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7048records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7049&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7050not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7051result of a successful lookup such as:
7052.code
7053${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7054.endd
7055has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7056The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7057authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7058
7059.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7060The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7061and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7062(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7063.code
7064${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7065.endd
7066
7067
7068.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7069In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7070However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7071&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7072the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7073.code
7074${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7075${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7076${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7077.endd
7078In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7079the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7080to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7081case, it does not treat it as a list.
7082
7083The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7084in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7085different separator can be specified, as described above.
7086
7087
7088
7089
7090.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7091.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7092.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7093.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7094The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7095become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7096implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7097contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7098the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7099it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7100indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7101your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7102.code
7103LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7104LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7105LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7106LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7107LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7108.endd
7109If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7110same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7111
7112There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7113the way they handle the results of a query:
7114
7115.ilist
7116&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7117gives an error.
7118.next
7119&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7120Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7121.next
7122&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7123from all of them are returned.
7124.endlist
7125
7126
7127For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7128Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7129the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7130First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7131
7132
7133.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7134.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7135An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7136the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7137.code
7138data = ${lookup ldap \
7139 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7140 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7141.endd
7142.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7143The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7144secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7145encrypted TLS connection is used.
7146
7147With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7148LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7149See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7150
7151Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7152controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7153&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7154your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7155&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7156certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7157running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7158methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7159&_exim.conf_&.
7160
7161
7162.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7163.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7164Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7165and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7166within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7167reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7168
7169The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7170filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7171the string:
7172.code
7173* => \2A
7174( => \28
7175) => \29
7176\ => \5C
7177.endd
7178in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7179to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7180.code
7181! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7182.endd
7183are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7184.code
7185${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7186.endd
7187yields
7188.code
7189%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7190.endd
7191Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7192.code
7193a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7194.endd
7195The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7196base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7197by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7198.code
7199, + " \ < > ;
7200.endd
7201It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7202before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7203is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7204.code
7205${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7206.endd
7207yields
7208.code
7209%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7210.endd
7211Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7212.code
7213\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7214.endd
7215There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7216authentication below.
7217
7218
7219.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7220.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7221The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7222is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7223an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7224by starting it with
7225.code
7226ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7227.endd
7228If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7229used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7230taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7231colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7232handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7233returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7234are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7235Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7236failures, and timeouts.
7237
7238For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7239of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7240&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7241doubled. For example
7242.code
7243ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7244.endd
7245If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7246to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7247the local host) is used.
7248
7249If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7250a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7251&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7252to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7253not available.
7254
7255For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7256for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7257can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7258the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7259.code
7260ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7261.endd
7262When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7263&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7264.code
7265${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7266.endd
7267When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7268a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7269specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7270socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7271&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7272or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7273the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7274backup host.
7275
7276If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7277specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7278&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7279
7280.ilist
7281Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7282interface.
7283.next
7284Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7285.endlist
7286
7287
7288Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7289&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7290
7291
7292
7293.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7294.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7295The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7296information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7297be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7298spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7299when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7300them. The following names are recognized:
7301.display
7302&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7303&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7304&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7305&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7306&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7307&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7308&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7309&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7310.endd
7311The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7312&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7313must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7314library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7315
7316The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7317backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7318enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7319network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7320&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7321LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7322if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7323SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7324Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7325
7326The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7327set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7328
7329The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7330to use for an individual lookup. The global ldap_servers option provides a
7331default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7332server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7333different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7334different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7335alternate list (colon-separated).
7336
7337Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7338values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7339.code
7340${lookup ldap
7341 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7342 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7343 {$value}fail}
7344.endd
7345The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7346any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7347which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7348non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7349
7350The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7351connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7352on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7353
7354When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7355removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7356some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7357quoting has two advantages:
7358
7359.ilist
7360It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7361DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7362.next
7363It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7364.endlist
7365
7366For example, a setting such as
7367.code
7368USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7369.endd
7370should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7371
7372Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7373expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7374field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7375does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7376.code
7377PASS=${quote:$3}
7378.endd
7379The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7380SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7381&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7382
7383
7384
7385.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7386.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7387The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7388as a sequence of values, for example
7389.code
7390cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7391.endd
7392The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7393search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7394the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7395values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7396you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7397directory.
7398
7399In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7400result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7401has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7402
7403If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7404strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7405quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7406backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7407Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7408(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7409Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7410output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7411same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7412
7413Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7414LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7415&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7416&%attr2%& has only one value:
7417.code
7418ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7419value1.1,value1,,2
7420
7421ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7422value two
7423
7424ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7425attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7426
7427ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7428objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7429.endd
7430You can
7431make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7432results of LDAP lookups.
7433The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7434individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7435The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7436of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7437The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7438comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7439
7440
7441
7442
7443.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7444.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7445.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7446NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7447and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7448contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7449of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7450values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7451.code
7452[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7453.endd
7454might return the string
7455.code
7456name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7457home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7458.endd
7459(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7460.code
7461[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7462.endd
7463would just return
7464.code
7465Martin Guerre
7466.endd
7467with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7468for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7469operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7470
7471
7472
7473.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7474.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7475.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7476.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7477.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7478.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7479.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7480.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7481.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7482.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7483Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7484databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7485might be
7486.code
7487${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7488 {$value}fail}
7489.endd
7490If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7491field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7492.code
7493${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7494 {$value}}
7495.endd
7496might be
7497.code
7498home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7499.endd
7500Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7501quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7502field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7503.code
7504Mister X
7505.endd
7506If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7507with a newline between the data for each row.
7508
7509
7510.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7511.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7512.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7513.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7514.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7515.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7516.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7517.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7518.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7519If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7520&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7521option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7522information.
7523(For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7524queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7525&<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7526items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7527Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7528name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7529.code
7530hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7531.endd
7532Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7533&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7534option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7535.code
7536hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7537 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7538.endd
7539For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7540because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7541query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7542a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7543found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7544servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7545
7546The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7547convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7548respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7549itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7550addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7551for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7552characters are not special.
7553
7554.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7555For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7556it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7557done by starting the query with
7558.display
7559&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7560.endd
7561Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7562.olist
7563If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7564global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7565of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7566taken from there.
7567.next
7568If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7569.endlist
7570The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7571Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7572successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7573
7574This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7575are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7576master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7577like this:
7578.code
7579mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7580 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7581 master/db/name/pw
7582.endd
7583In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7584.code
7585${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7586.endd
7587That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7588the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7589option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7590.code
7591${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7592.endd
7593
7594
7595.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7596For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7597causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7598socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7599each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7600.display
7601<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7602 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7603.endd
7604Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7605the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7606
7607No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7608the queries.
7609
7610If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7611or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7612
7613&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7614anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7615is zero because no rows are affected.
7616
7617
7618.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7619PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7620This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7621However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7622database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7623looks like this:
7624.code
7625hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7626.endd
7627In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7628given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7629visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7630
7631If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7632update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7633affected.
7634
7635.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7636.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7637.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7638SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7639addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7640daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7641of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7642separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7643contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7644.code
7645${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7646 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7647.endd
7648In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7649.code
7650domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7651 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7652.endd
7653The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7654quote, which it doubles.
7655
7656The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7657internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7658update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7659are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7660waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7661to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7662option.
7663.ecindex IIDfidalo1
7664.ecindex IIDfidalo2
7665
7666
7667. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7668. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7669
7670.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7671 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7672 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7673.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7674A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7675email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7676contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7677are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7678arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7679
7680Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7681host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7682different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7683general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7684
7685.new
7686Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7687support all the complexity availible in
7688domain, host, address and local part lists.
7689.wen
7690
7691
7692
7693.section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7694.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7695Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7696expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7697into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7698but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7699&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7700discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7701
7702
7703If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7704testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7705expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7706
7707If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7708other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7709misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7710the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7711expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7712.code
7713deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7714 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7715.endd
7716The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7717&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7718senders based on the receiving domain.
7719
7720
7721
7722
7723.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7724.cindex "list" "negation"
7725.cindex "negation" "in lists"
7726Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7727leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7728defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7729it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7730(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7731
7732The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7733subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7734subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7735subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7736was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7737.code
7738domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7739.endd
7740matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7741neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7742list is positive. However, if the setting were
7743.code
7744domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7745.endd
7746then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7747list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7748as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7749
7750Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7751the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7752item.
7753
7754
7755
7756.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7757.cindex "list" "file name in"
7758If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7759name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7760processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7761file names are not allowed,
7762and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7763Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7764lines:
7765
7766.ilist
7767For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7768file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7769.next
7770Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7771address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7772white space or the start of the line. For example:
7773.code
7774not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7775.endd
7776.endlist
7777
7778Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7779file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7780is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7781so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7782
7783If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7784within the file is inverted. For example, if
7785.code
7786hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7787.endd
7788and the file contains the lines
7789.code
7790!a.b.c
7791*.b.c
7792.endd
7793then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7794any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7795
7796
7797
7798.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7799As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7800to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7801confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7802an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7803sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7804non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7805always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7806
7807If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7808list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7809in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7810&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7811
7812
7813
7814
7815.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7816.cindex "named lists"
7817.cindex "list" "named"
7818A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7819which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7820particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7821places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7822the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7823a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7824locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7825.code
7826domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7827.endd
7828Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7829for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7830configured with the line
7831.code
7832domains = +local_domains
7833.endd
7834The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7835except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7836.code
7837dnslookup:
7838 driver = dnslookup
7839 domains = ! +local_domains
7840 transport = remote_smtp
7841 no_more
7842.endd
7843The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7844the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7845respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7846equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7847.code
7848hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7849addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7850.endd
7851A named list may refer to other named lists:
7852.code
7853domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7854domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7855domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7856.endd
7857&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7858effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7859out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7860.code
7861domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7862domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7863.endd
7864The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7865list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7866means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7867.code
7868domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7869.endd
7870where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7871referenced lists if you can.
7872
7873Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7874address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7875lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7876.code
7877domains = +local_domains
7878.endd
7879on several of your routers
7880or in several ACL statements,
7881the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7882if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7883references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7884the same each time they are referenced.
7885
7886By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7887extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7888is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7889hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7890
7891
7892
7893.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7894.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7895.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7896At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7897configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7898write
7899.code
7900ALIST = host1 : host2
7901auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7902.endd
7903it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7904.code
7905auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7906.endd
7907Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7908list, and write
7909.code
7910hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7911auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7912.endd
7913the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7914.code
7915auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7916.endd
7917
7918
7919.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7920.cindex "list" "caching of named"
7921.cindex "caching" "named lists"
7922While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7923it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7924the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7925that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7926an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7927message. For example:
7928.code
7929domainlist special_domains = \
7930 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7931.endd
7932This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7933address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7934in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7935cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7936same list each time.
7937
7938By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7939cache the result anyway. For example:
7940.code
7941domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7942.endd
7943If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7944the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7945
7946
7947
7948.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7949.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7950.cindex "list" "domain list"
7951Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7952The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7953
7954.ilist
7955.cindex "primary host name"
7956.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7957.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7958.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7959.cindex "@ in a domain list"
7960If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7961as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7962possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7963differ only in their names.
7964.next
7965.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7966.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7967.cindex "domain literal"
7968If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7969in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7970only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7971&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7972control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7973In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7974.next
7975.cindex "@mx_any"
7976.cindex "@mx_primary"
7977.cindex "@mx_secondary"
7978.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7979If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7980has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7981.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7982&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7983are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7984local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7985but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7986preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7987
7988The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7989performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7990example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7991resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7992options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7993
7994Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7995patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7996list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7997ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7998on a router). For example:
7999.code
8000domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8001.endd
8002This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8003the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8004
8005The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8006host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8007contain negative items.
8008
8009Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8010be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8011list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8012.code
8013domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8014 an.other.domain : ...
8015.endd
8016so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8017involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8018.code
8019domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8020 an.other.domain ? ...
8021.endd
8022.next
8023.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8024.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8025.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8026If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8027are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8028domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8029list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8030matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8031list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8032&'cipher.key.ex'&.
8033
8034.next
8035.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8036.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8037If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8038expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8039function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8040Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8041default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8042with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8043are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8044
8045&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8046must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8047use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8048it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8049expression by expansion, of course).
8050.next
8051.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8052.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8053If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8054semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8055must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8056&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8057.code
8058domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8059.endd
8060The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8061key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8062only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8063is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8064or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8065&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8066other statements in the same ACL.
8067
8068.next
8069Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8070&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8071.code
8072domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8073.endd
8074This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8075works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8076
8077.next
8078.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8079Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8080a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8081original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8082select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8083value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8084expansion variable.
8085.next
8086If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8087semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8088pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8089chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8090.code
8091hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8092 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8093.endd
8094In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8095example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8096whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8097&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8098variable and can be referred to in other options.
8099.next
8100.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8101If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8102between the pattern and the domain.
8103.endlist
8104
8105Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8106.code
8107domainlist funny_domains = \
8108 @ : \
8109 lib.unseen.edu : \
8110 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8111 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8112 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8113 nis;domains.byname : \
8114 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8115.endd
8116There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8117an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8118explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8119but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8120patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8121patterns earlier.
8122
8123
8124
8125.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8126.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8127.cindex "list" "host list"
8128Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8129example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8130may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8131two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8132pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8133You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8134involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8135
8136
8137.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8138.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8139.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8140If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8141involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8142process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8143not used.
8144
8145.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8146The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8147the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8148
8149
8150
8151.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8152.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8153If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8154the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8155&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8156list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8157systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8158concerns.)
8159
8160The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8161inspecting its IP address:
8162
8163.ilist
8164If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8165with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8166to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8167&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8168This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8169with the IP address of the subject host.
8170
8171If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8172lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8173ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8174temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8175what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8176
8177.next
8178.cindex "@ in a host list"
8179If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8180domain name, as just described.
8181
8182.next
8183If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8184subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8185IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8186be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8187separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8188without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8189IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8190that can never match a client host.
8191
8192.next
8193.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8194If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8195the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8196interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8197.code
8198accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8199accept hosts = @[]
8200.endd
8201.next
8202.cindex "CIDR notation"
8203If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8204example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8205host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8206included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8207specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8208significant end of the address.
8209
8210&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8211of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8212address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8213addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8214.code
8215192.168.23.236/31
8216.endd
8217matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
821832 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8219matches.
8220
8221Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8222.code
8223recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8224 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8225.endd
8226The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8227appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8228For example:
8229.code
8230recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8231.endd
8232could make use of a file containing
8233.code
8234172.16.0.0/12
82353ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8236.endd
8237to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8238addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8239changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8240.code
8241recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8242 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8243.endd
8244The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8245list.
8246.endlist
8247
8248
8249
8250.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8251 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8252.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8253When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8254address, the pattern takes this form:
8255.display
8256&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8257.endd
8258For example:
8259.code
8260hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8261.endd
8262The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8263IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8264letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8265&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8266quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8267returned by the lookup is not used.
8268
8269.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8270.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8271Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8272patterns of this form:
8273.display
8274&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8275.endd
8276For example:
8277.code
8278net24-dbm;/networks.db
8279.endd
8280The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8281length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8282mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8283is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8284&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8285
8286When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8287of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8288terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8289to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8290recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8291(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8292For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8293converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8294addresses are always used.
8295
8296Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8297colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8298However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8299configurations.
8300
8301&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8302IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8303the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8304case the IP address is used on its own.
8305
8306
8307
8308.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8309.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8310.cindex "unknown host name"
8311.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8312There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8313remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8314complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8315address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8316above.)
8317
8318If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8319patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8320Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8321DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8322Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8323effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8324Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8325
8326Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8327against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8328
8329By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8330if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8331&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8332are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8333security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8334for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8335Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8336discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8337found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8338
8339There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8340found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8341
8342.cindex "host" "alias for"
8343.cindex "alias for host"
8344As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8345of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8346
8347.ilist
8348.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8349If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8350the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8351&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8352requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8353expression.
8354.next
8355.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8356.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8357If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8358matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8359expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8360case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8361syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8362example,
8363.code
8364^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8365.endd
8366is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8367&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8368that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8369string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8370part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8371.code
8372sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8373.endd
8374&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8375&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8376example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8377required.
8378.endlist
8379
8380
8381
8382
8383.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8384.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8385While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8386name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8387from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8388behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8389
8390&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8391apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8392
8393.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8394.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8395Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8396lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8397Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8398does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8399To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8400&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8401not recognized in an indirected file).
8402
8403.ilist
8404If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8405cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8406.code
8407host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8408.endd
8409rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8410any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8411
8412.next
8413If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8414be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8415example:
8416.code
8417accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8418 192.168.4.5
8419.endd
8420accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8421whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8422name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8423.endlist
8424
8425Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8426list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8427list.
8428
8429.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8430 "SECTmixwilhos"
8431.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8432
8433This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8434as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8435wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8436
8437.ilist
8438If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8439IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8440addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8441.code
8442accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8443.endd
8444The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8445left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8446without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8447a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8448pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8449&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8450if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8451
8452.next
8453If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8454address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8455.code
8456accept hosts = *.friend.example
8457accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8458.endd
8459If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8460&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8461&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8462this section.
8463.endlist
8464
8465
8466.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8467 "SECTtemdnserr"
8468.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8469.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8470.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8471A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8472&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8473host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8474&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8475section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8476host lists such as whitelists.
8477
8478
8479
8480.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8481 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8482.cindex "unknown host name"
8483.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8484If a pattern is of the form
8485.display
8486<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8487.endd
8488for example
8489.code
8490dbm;/host/accept/list
8491.endd
8492a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8493lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8494is not used.
8495
8496&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8497keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8498addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8499&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8500two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8501lookup, both using the same file.
8502
8503
8504
8505.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8506If a pattern is of the form
8507.display
8508<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8509.endd
8510the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8511data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8512&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8513.code
8514hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8515 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8516.endd
8517The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8518can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8519use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8520operator.
8521
8522If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8523looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8524&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8525
8526Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8527host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8528&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8529still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8530effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8531See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8532
8533
8534
8535
8536
8537.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8538.cindex "list" "address list"
8539.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8540.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8541Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8542is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8543always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8544list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8545using this option setting:
8546.code
8547senders = :
8548.endd
8549The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8550data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8551detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8552and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8553
8554Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8555example:
8556.code
8557senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8558.endd
8559A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8560character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8561semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8562subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8563with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8564the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8565wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8566.code
8567deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8568 *@+hostile_domains:\
8569 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8570 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8571.endd
8572.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8573.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8574If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8575specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8576treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8577
8578If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8579contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8580address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8581domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8582is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8583.code
8584deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8585.endd
8586
8587The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8588address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8589senders:
8590
8591.ilist
8592.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8593.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8594If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8595done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8596You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8597as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8598to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8599.code
8600deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8601 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8602.endd
8603The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8604start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8605
8606.next
8607.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8608Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8609lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8610example:
8611.code
8612deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8613 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8614 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8615.endd
8616Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8617lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8618not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8619always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8620
8621Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8622cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8623panic log.
8624.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8625However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8626&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8627default. For example, with this lookup:
8628.code
8629accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8630.endd
8631the file could contains lines like this:
8632.code
8633user1@domain1.example
8634*@domain2.example
8635.endd
8636and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8637that are tried is:
8638.code
8639nimrod@jaeger.example
8640*@jaeger.example
8641*
8642.endd
8643&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8644would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8645
8646&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8647.code
8648deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8649deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8650.endd
8651The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8652because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8653domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8654.endlist
8655
8656
8657The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8658If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8659always fails.
8660
8661
8662.ilist
8663.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8664.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8665.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8666If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8667(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8668split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8669it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8670from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8671of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8672
8673.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8674The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8675keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8676patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8677even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8678with
8679.code
8680deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8681.endd
8682the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8683.code
8684baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8685.endd
8686to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8687
8688.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8689If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8690has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8691may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8692but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8693surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8694.code
8695aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8696 spammer3 : spammer4
8697.endd
8698As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8699doubling.
8700
8701If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8702of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8703list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8704might have entries like
8705.code
8706aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8707xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8708*: ^\d{8}$
8709.endd
8710in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8711local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8712each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8713chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8714
8715.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8716It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8717them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8718
8719.next
8720The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8721lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8722can only return a single list of local parts.
8723.endlist
8724
8725&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8726in these two examples:
8727.code
8728senders = +my_list
8729senders = *@+my_list
8730.endd
8731In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8732example it is a named domain list.
8733
8734
8735
8736
8737.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8738.cindex "case of local parts"
8739.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8740.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8741Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8742case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8743Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8744Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8745blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8746lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8747default.
8748
8749The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8750address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8751comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8752the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8753that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8754keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8755works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8756case-independent.
8757
8758.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8759To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8760an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8761part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8762longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8763lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8764performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8765become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8766
8767
8768
8769.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8770.cindex "list" "local part list"
8771.cindex "local part" "list"
8772Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8773lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8774setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8775set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8776case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8777matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8778&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8779option is case-sensitive from the start.
8780
8781If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8782comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8783only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8784Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8785that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8786&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8787Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8788types.
8789.ecindex IIDdohoadli
8790
8791
8792
8793
8794. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8795. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8796
8797.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8798.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8799Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8800them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8801
8802When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8803when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8804start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8805below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8806escape character, as described in the following section.
8807
8808Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8809dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8810options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8811the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8812conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8813reasons.
8814
8815
8816
8817.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8818.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8819An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8820backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8821character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8822If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8823required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8824the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8825
8826.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8827A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8828two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8829expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8830.code
8831deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8832.endd
8833On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8834without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8835string.
8836
8837
8838
8839.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8840.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8841A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8842expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8843carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8844octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8845backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8846encoding.
8847
8848These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8849in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8850and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8851
8852
8853.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8854.cindex "expansion" "testing"
8855.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8856.oindex "&%-be%&"
8857Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8858takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8859arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8860to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8861since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8862value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8863database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8864and &%nhash%&.
8865
8866Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8867instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8868using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8869
8870.oindex "&%-bem%&"
8871If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8872from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8873option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8874read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8875.code
8876exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8877.endd
8878The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8879Exim message identifier. For example:
8880.code
8881exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8882.endd
8883This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8884is therefore restricted to admin users.
8885
8886
8887.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8888.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8889A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8890alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8891(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8892used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8893instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8894the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8895that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8896its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8897from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8898taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8899being expanded.
8900
8901
8902
8903
8904.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8905The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8906between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8907outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8908white space is significant.
8909
8910.vlist
8911.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8912.cindex "expansion" "variables"
8913Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8914.code
8915$local_part
8916${domain}
8917.endd
8918The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8919characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8920&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8921section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8922given, the expansion fails.
8923
8924.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8925.cindex "expansion" "operators"
8926The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8927<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8928.code
8929${lc:$local_part}
8930.endd
8931The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8932leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8933below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8934one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8935string easier to understand.
8936
8937.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8938This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8939expansion item below.
8940
8941
8942.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8943.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8944.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8945The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8946arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8947Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8948arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8949and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8950are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8951a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8952the result of the expansion.
8953If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8954the expansion result is an empty string.
8955If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8956
8957
8958.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8959 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8960.cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8961.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8962.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8963The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8964The field name is expanded and used to retrive the relevant field from
8965the certificate. Supported fields are:
8966.display
8967&`version `&
8968&`serial_number `&
8969&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8970&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8971&`notbefore `& time
8972&`notafter `& time
8973&`sig_algorithm `&
8974&`signature `&
8975&`subj_altname `& tagged list
8976&`ocsp_uri `& list
8977&`crl_uri `& list
8978.endd
8979If the field is found,
8980<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8981otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8982variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8983is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8984
8985If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8986key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8987extracted is used.
8988
8989Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8990
8991The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8992output a Distinguished Name string which is
8993not quite
8994parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8995(the exceptions being elements containing commas).
8996RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8997a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
8998result is a list (newline-separated by default).
8999The separator may be changed by another modifer of
9000a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9001Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9002
9003The field selectors marked as "time" above
9004take an optional modifier of "int"
9005for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9006Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9007in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9008
9009The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9010newline-separated by default,
9011(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9012The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9013a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9014
9015The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9016prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9017Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9018which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9019if so the elenment tags are omitted.
9020
9021If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9022
9023.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9024 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9025.cindex &%dlfunc%&
9026This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9027This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9028.code
9029EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9030.endd
9031set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9032object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9033(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9034
9035There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9036a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9037included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9038are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9039must have the following type:
9040.code
9041int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9042.endd
9043Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9044function should return one of the following values:
9045
9046&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9047into the expanded string that is being built.
9048
9049&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9050from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9051
9052&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9053taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9054
9055&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9056
9057When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9058you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9059configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9060
9061
9062.new
9063.vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9064.cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9065.cindex "environment" "value from"
9066The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9067removed.
9068This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9069If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9070and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9071
9072Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9073appear, for example:
9074.code
9075${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9076.endd
9077This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9078{<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9079
9080If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9081search failure.
9082If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9083search success.
9084.wen
9085
9086
9087.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9088 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9089.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9090.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9091The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9092white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9093must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9094form:
9095.display
9096<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9097.endd
9098.vindex "&$value$&"
9099where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9100values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9101values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9102described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9103for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9104the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9105otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9106variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9107is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9108
9109If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9110key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9111extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9112yield &"2001"&:
9113.code
9114${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9115${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9116.endd
9117Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9118appear, for example:
9119.code
9120${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9121.endd
9122This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9123{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9124
9125
9126.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9127 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9128.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9129.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9130The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9131apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9132This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9133behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9134extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9135argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9136<&'string3'&> as before.
9137
9138The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9139separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9140The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9141counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9142number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9143number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9144expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9145provided. For example:
9146.code
9147${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9148.endd
9149yields &"42"&, and
9150.code
9151${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9152.endd
9153yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9154empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9155
9156
9157.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9158.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9159.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9160.vindex "&$item$&"
9161After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9162default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9163in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9164evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9165item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9166separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9167input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9168.code
9169${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9170.endd
9171yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9172to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9173
9174
9175.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9176.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9177.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9178This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9179early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9180(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9181
9182The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9183<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9184<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9185use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9186.code
9187${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9188.endd
9189The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9190or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9191Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9192function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9193first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9194.code
9195abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9196.endd
9197If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9198letters appear. For example:
9199.display
9200&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9201&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9202&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9203.endd
9204
9205.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9206 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9207 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9208 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9209 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9210 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9211.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9212.vindex "&$header_$&"
9213.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9214.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9215.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9216.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9217.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9218Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9219.code
9220$header_reply-to:
9221.endd
9222The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9223internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9224lines) may be present.
9225
9226The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9227the data in the header line is interpreted.
9228
9229.ilist
9230.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9231&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9232processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9233
9234.next
9235.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9236&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9237or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9238character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9239&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9240.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9241produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9242what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9243
9244.next
9245&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9246standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9247be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9248returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9249&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9250a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9251.endlist ilist
9252
9253In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9254command of the following form:
9255.code
9256headers charset "UTF-8"
9257.endd
9258This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9259subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9260character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9261option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9262value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9263ISO-8859-1.
9264
9265Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9266any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9267&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9268if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9269
9270Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9271this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9272message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9273filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9274router or transport are not accessible.
9275
9276For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9277before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9278message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9279are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9280point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9281by earlier ACLs are visible.
9282
9283Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9284following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9285this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9286white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9287If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9288replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9289&<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9290
9291If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9292to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9293&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9294each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9295newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9296newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9297those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9298junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9299
9300
9301.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9302.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9303.cindex &%hmac%&
9304This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9305shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9306RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9307&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9308cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9309or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9310present. For example:
9311.code
9312${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9313.endd
9314For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9315produces:
9316.code
9317dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9318.endd
9319As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9320an Exim configuration:
9321.code
9322SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9323.endd
9324In a router or a transport you could then have:
9325.code
9326headers_add = \
9327 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9328 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9329 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9330.endd
9331Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9332&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9333this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9334host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9335using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9336&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9337
9338
9339.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9340.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9341.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9342If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9343item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9344in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9345.code
9346${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9347.endd
9348The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9349true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9350be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9351case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9352&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9353
9354If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9355is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9356cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9357.code
9358condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9359.endd
9360you can use
9361.code
9362condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9363.endd
9364
9365.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9366.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9367.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9368The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9369strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9370you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9371change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9372some of the braces:
9373.code
9374${length_<n>:<string>}
9375.endd
9376The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9377of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9378&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9379
9380
9381.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9382 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9383.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9384.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9385.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9386The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9387apart from an optional leading minus,
9388and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9389
9390After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9391default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9392
9393The first field of the list is numbered one.
9394If the number is negative, the fields are
9395counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9396The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9397then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9398
9399If the modulus of the
9400number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9401the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9402
9403For example:
9404.code
9405${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9406.endd
9407yields &"42"&, and
9408.code
9409${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9410.endd
9411yields &"result: 99"&.
9412
9413If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9414If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9415extracted is used.
9416You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9417
9418
9419.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9420 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9421This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9422described in the next item.
9423
9424.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9425 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9426.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9427.cindex "file" "lookups"
9428.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9429The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9430discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9431lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9432<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9433
9434If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9435a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9436other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9437in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9438out by the system administrator.
9439
9440.vindex "&$value$&"
9441If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9442During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9443lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9444level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9445the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9446string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9447lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9448original lookup fails.
9449
9450If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9451data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9452expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9453the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9454appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9455to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9456{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9457successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9458
9459For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9460search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9461type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9462&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9463
9464.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9465If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9466and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9467They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9468
9469This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9470.code
9471${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9472.endd
9473This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9474the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9475.code
9476${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9477 {$value}fail}
9478.endd
9479
9480
9481.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9482.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9483.vindex "&$item$&"
9484After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9485default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9486in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9487expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9488for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9489setting is not included in the output. For example:
9490.code
9491${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9492.endd
9493expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9494value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9495and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9496
9497.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9498.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9499.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9500The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9501<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9502if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9503can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9504.code
9505${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9506.endd
9507The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9508the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9509processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9510slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9511example,
9512.code
9513${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9514.endd
9515returns the string &"6/33"&.
9516
9517
9518
9519.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9520.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9521.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9522This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9523interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9524expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9525additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9526name of the subroutine, is nine.
9527
9528The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9529the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9530way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9531Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9532return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9533not its contents.
9534
9535If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9536with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9537Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9538
9539The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9540out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9541
9542
9543.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9544.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9545The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9546keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9547it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9548to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9549as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9550and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9551
9552.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9553 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9554.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9555This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9556checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9557yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9558empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9559prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9560version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9561variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9562
9563These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9564retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9565against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9566which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9567
9568The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9569string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9570result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9571whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9572is the expansion of the third argument.
9573
9574All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9575However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9576For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9577
9578.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9579.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9580.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9581.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9582The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9583then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9584the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9585newlines are left in the string.
9586String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9587you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9588the string expansion fails.
9589
9590The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9591locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9592
9593
9594
9595.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9596 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9597.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9598.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9599.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9600This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9601string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9602examples:
9603.code
9604${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9605${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9606.endd
9607For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9608For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9609a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9610number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9611optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9612example:
9613.code
9614${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9615.endd
9616Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9617one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9618both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9619(unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9620is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9621extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9622.code
9623${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9624.endd
9625A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9626that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9627turns them into spaces:
9628.code
9629${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9630.endd
9631As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9632happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9633addition, the following errors can occur:
9634
9635.ilist
9636Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9637.next
9638Failure to connect the socket;
9639.next
9640Failure to write the request string;
9641.next
9642Timeout on reading from the socket.
9643.endlist
9644
9645By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9646you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9647errors occurs. For example:
9648.code
9649${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9650 {socket failure}}
9651.endd
9652You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9653expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9654and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9655if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9656non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9657
9658The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9659locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9660
9661
9662.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9663.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9664.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9665.vindex "&$value$&"
9666.vindex "&$item$&"
9667This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9668<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9669separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9670assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9671list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9672them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9673iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9674added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9675number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9676.code
9677${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9678.endd
9679The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9680can be found:
9681.code
9682${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9683.endd
9684At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9685restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9686expansion items.
9687
9688.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9689This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9690expansion item above.
9691
9692.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9693 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9694.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9695.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9696The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9697split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9698in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9699executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9700a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9701
9702Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9703which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9704simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9705script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9706variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9707quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9708in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9709around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9710variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9711character.
9712
9713The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9714and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9715.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9716.vindex "&$value$&"
9717If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9718and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9719from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9720<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9721expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9722&$value$&.
9723
9724If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9725can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9726command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9727of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9728
9729.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9730The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9731In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9732troubleshoot:
9733.code
9734warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9735 log_message = Output of id: $value
9736.endd
9737If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9738shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9739.code
9740${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9741.endd
9742
9743.vindex "&$runrc$&"
9744The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9745remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9746.code
9747if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9748 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9749 ...
9750endif
9751.endd
9752If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9753the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9754commands.
9755
9756&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9757option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9758testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9759by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9760
9761The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9762out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9763
9764
9765.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9766.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9767.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9768This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9769option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9770modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9771into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9772a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9773.code
9774${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9775.endd
9776yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9777if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9778substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9779.code
9780${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9781.endd
9782yields &"defabc"&, and
9783.code
9784${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9785.endd
9786yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9787the regular expression from string expansion.
9788
9789
9790
9791.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9792.cindex sorting "a list"
9793.cindex list sorting
9794.cindex expansion "list sorting"
9795After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9796default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9797The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9798of a two-argument expansion condition.
9799The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9800The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9801if the first value should sort before the second value.
9802The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9803the element being placed in &$item$&,
9804to give values for comparison.
9805
9806The item result is a sorted list,
9807with the original list separator,
9808of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9809
9810Examples:
9811.code
9812${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9813.endd
9814sorts a list of numbers, and
9815.code
9816${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9817.endd
9818will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9819
9820
9821.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9822.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9823.cindex "substring extraction"
9824.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9825The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9826<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9827if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9828can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9829.code
9830${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9831.endd
9832The second number is optional (in both notations).
9833If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9834omitted.
9835
9836The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9837&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9838length required. For example
9839.code
9840${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9841.endd
9842If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9843null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9844length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9845given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9846
9847The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9848from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9849second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9850.code
9851${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9852.endd
9853yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9854length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9855the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9856.code
9857${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9858.endd
9859yields an empty string, but
9860.code
9861${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9862.endd
9863yields &"1"&.
9864
9865When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9866is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9867string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9868no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9869.code
9870${substr_-1:abcde}
9871${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9872.endd
9873yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9874
9875
9876
9877.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9878 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9879.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9880.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9881This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9882argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9883matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9884replacement list. For example
9885.code
9886${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9887.endd
9888yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9889last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9890last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9891place.
9892.endlist
9893
9894
9895
9896.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9897.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9898For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9899the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9900The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9901following operations can be performed:
9902
9903.vlist
9904.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9905.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9906.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9907The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9908header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9909not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9910
9911
9912.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9913.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9914.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9915The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
99162822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9917operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9918result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9919doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9920Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9921
9922It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9923separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9924character. For example:
9925.code
9926${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9927.endd
9928expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9929expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9930address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9931processing lists.
9932
9933To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9934a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9935unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9936email address seperator. For the example header line:
9937.code
9938From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9939.endd
9940The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9941properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9942It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9943example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9944de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9945The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9946quoted.
9947.code
9948# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9949=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9950user@example.com
9951# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9952Last:user@example.com
9953# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9954user@example.com
9955.endd
9956
9957.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9958.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9959.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9960The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9961base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9962the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9963its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9964names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9965be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9966
9967.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9968.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9969.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9970The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9971environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9972identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9973string.
9974
9975
9976.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9977.cindex "domain" "extraction"
9978.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9979The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9980from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9981
9982
9983.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9984.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9985.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9986If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9987escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9988significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9989is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9990
9991
9992.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9993.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9994.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9995.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9996These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9997expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9998arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9999logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10000integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10001C programming language):
10002.table2 70pt 300pt
10003.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10004.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10005.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10006.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10007.irow "" "and (&&)"
10008.irow "" "xor (^)"
10009.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10010.endtable
10011Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10012space is permitted before or after operators.
10013
10014For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10015hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10016decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10017permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10018times, which often do have leading zeros.
10019
10020A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10021or 1024*1024*1024,
10022respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10023a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10024
10025.display
10026&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10027&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10028&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10029&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10030&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10031&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10032&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10033&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10034&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10035&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10036&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10037.endd
10038
10039As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10040.code
10041deny message = Too many bad recipients
10042 condition = \
10043 ${if and { \
10044 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10045 { \
10046 < \
10047 {$recipients_count} \
10048 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10049 } \
10050 }{yes}{no}}
10051.endd
10052The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10053fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10054
10055
10056.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10057.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10058The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10059example,
10060.code
10061${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10062.endd
10063first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10064and then re-expands what it has found.
10065
10066
10067.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10068.cindex "Unicode"
10069.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10070.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10071.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10072The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10073email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10074to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10075UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10076converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10077the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10078
10079Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10080ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10081For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10082way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10083characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10084single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10085translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10086
10087
10088.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10089.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10090.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10091The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10092be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10093change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10094.code
10095${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10096.endd
10097See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10098abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10099
10100
10101
10102.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10103.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10104.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10105.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10106This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10107be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10108
10109
10110
10111.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10112.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10113.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10114This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10115escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10116as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10117byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10118
10119
10120.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10121.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10122.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10123.cindex "lower casing"
10124.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10125.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10126This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10127.code
10128${lc:$local_part}
10129.endd
10130
10131.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10132.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10133.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10134The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10135can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10136changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10137.code
10138${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10139.endd
10140See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10141&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10142when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10143
10144
10145.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10146.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10147.cindex "list" "item count"
10148.cindex "list" "count of items"
10149.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10150The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10151
10152
10153.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10154.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10155.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10156The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10157expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10158If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10159and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10160Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10161matching list is returned.
10162
10163
10164.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10165.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10166.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10167The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10168extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10169empty.
10170
10171
10172.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10173.cindex "masked IP address"
10174.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10175.cindex "CIDR notation"
10176.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10177.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10178If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10179slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10180expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10181masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10182the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10183.code
10184${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10185.endd
10186returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10187be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10188address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10189terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10190.code
10191${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10192.endd
10193returns the string
10194.code
101953ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10196.endd
10197Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10198
10199
10200.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10201.cindex "MD5 hash"
10202.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10203.cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10204.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10205The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10206as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10207
10208
10209.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10210.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10211.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10212The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10213that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10214strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10215.code
10216${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10217.endd
10218See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10219
10220
10221.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10222.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10223.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10224.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10225The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10226is an empty string or
10227contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10228Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10229Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10230respectively For example,
10231.code
10232${quote:ab"*"cd}
10233.endd
10234becomes
10235.code
10236"ab\"*\"cd"
10237.endd
10238The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10239variable or a message header.
10240
10241.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10242.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10243This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10244required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10245example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10246If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10247(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10248
10249
10250.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10251.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10252This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10253query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10254the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10255.code
10256${quote_ldap:two * two}
10257.endd
10258returns
10259.code
10260two%20%5C2A%20two
10261.endd
10262For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10263yields an unchanged string.
10264
10265
10266.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10267.cindex "random number"
10268This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10269supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10270on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10271If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10272If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10273for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10274Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10275srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10276random().
10277
10278
10279.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10280.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10281This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10282dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
10283dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10284for DNS. For example,
10285.code
10286${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10287${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10288.endd
10289returns
10290.code
102914.2.0.192
10292f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10293.endd
10294
10295
10296.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10297.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10298.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10299.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10300This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10301encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10302assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10303&%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10304contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10305characters
10306.code
10307? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10308.endd
10309it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10310string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10311characters.
10312
10313
10314.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10315.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10316.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10317.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10318This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10319bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10320character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10321not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10322
10323&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10324access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10325to use this operator as well.
10326
10327
10328
10329.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10330.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10331.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10332.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10333The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10334characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10335variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10336
10337
10338.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10339.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10340.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10341.cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10342.cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10343The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10344it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10345
10346
10347.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10348.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10349.cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10350.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10351.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10352The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10353certificate,
10354and returns
10355it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10356Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10357
10358
10359.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10360.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10361.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10362.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10363The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10364function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10365expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10366series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10367except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10368a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1036910-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10370&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10371can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10372
10373The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10374the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10375systems for files larger than 2GB.
10376
10377.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10378.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10379.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10380.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10381This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10382
10383
10384
10385.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10386.cindex "expansion" "string length"
10387.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10388.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10389The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10390decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10391
10392
10393.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10394.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10395.cindex "substring extraction"
10396.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10397The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10398can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10399that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10400.code
10401${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10402.endd
10403See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10404abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10405
10406.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10407.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10408.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10409This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10410seconds.
10411
10412.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10413.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10414.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10415The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10416represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10417number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10418&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10419
10420.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10421.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10422.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10423.cindex "upper casing"
10424.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10425.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10426This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10427
10428.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10429.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10430.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10431.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10432.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10433.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10434This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10435.endlist
10436
10437
10438
10439
10440
10441
10442.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10443.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10444The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10445while expanding strings:
10446
10447.vlist
10448.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10449.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10450.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10451Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10452condition.
10453
10454.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10455.cindex "numeric comparison"
10456.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10457There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10458are:
10459.display
10460&`= `& equal
10461&`== `& equal
10462&`> `& greater
10463&`>= `& greater or equal
10464&`< `& less
10465&`<= `& less or equal
10466.endd
10467For example:
10468.code
10469${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10470.endd
10471Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10472two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10473optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10474lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10475As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10476zero.
10477
10478In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10479<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1048010M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10481
10482
10483.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10484 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10485.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10486.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10487The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10488arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10489Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10490arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10491and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10492are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10493a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10494the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10495If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10496If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10497
10498.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10499.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10500.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10501This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10502a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10503(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10504false if zero.
10505An empty string is treated as false.
10506Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10507thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10508All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10509
10510When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10511make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10512For example:
10513.code
10514${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10515.endd
10516
10517
10518.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10519.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10520.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10521Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10522where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10523loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10524and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10525true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10526
10527Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10528
10529.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10530.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10531.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10532.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10533This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10534authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10535necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10536included in the binary.
10537
10538The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10539compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10540be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10541encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10542does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10543&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10544Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10545string in LDAP form is:
10546.code
10547{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10548.endd
10549If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10550be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10551.code
10552${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10553.endd
10554The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10555supported:
10556
10557.ilist
10558.cindex "MD5 hash"
10559.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10560&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10561printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10562length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10563(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10564hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10565comparison fails.
10566
10567.next
10568.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10569&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10570printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10571length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10572If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10573SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10574
10575.next
10576.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10577&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10578only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10579systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10580whatever its length.
10581
10582.next
10583.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10584&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10585use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10586modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10587.endlist
10588Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10589&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10590HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10591operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10592the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10593support &[crypt16()]&.
10594
10595Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10596it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10597turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10598&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10599algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10600
10601However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10602functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10603Exim is seen as very low priority.
10604
10605If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10606comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10607determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10608default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10609function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10610
10611.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10612.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10613.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10614The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10615variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10616variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10617.code
10618${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10619.endd
10620Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10621variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10622
10623.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10624 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10625.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10626This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10627exists in the message. For example,
10628.code
10629${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10630.endd
10631&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10632the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10633
10634.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10635 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10636.cindex "string" "comparison"
10637.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10638.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10639.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10640The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10641resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10642letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10643
10644.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10645.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10646.cindex "file" "existence test"
10647.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10648The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10649condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10650is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10651users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10652
10653.vitem &*first_delivery*&
10654.cindex "delivery" "first"
10655.cindex "first delivery"
10656.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10657.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10658This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10659attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10660
10661
10662.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10663 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10664.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10665.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10666.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10667.vindex "&$item$&"
10668These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10669the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10670the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10671be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10672condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10673.ilist
10674For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10675the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10676items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10677.next
10678For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10679and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10680all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10681.endlist
10682Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10683items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10684that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10685list separator is changed to a comma:
10686.code
10687${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10688.endd
10689The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10690being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10691
10692To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10693
10694
10695.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10696 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10697.cindex "string" "comparison"
10698.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10699.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10700.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10701The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10702string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10703comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10704case-independent.
10705
10706.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10707 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10708.cindex "string" "comparison"
10709.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10710.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10711.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10712The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10713string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10714includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10715case-independent.
10716
10717.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10718 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10719.cindex "string" "comparison"
10720.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10721Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10722strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10723is true.
10724
10725These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10726Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10727.code
10728${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10729 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10730${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10731 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10732.endd
10733
10734.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10735 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10736 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10737.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10738.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10739.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10740.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10741.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10742The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10743an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10744&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10745
10746For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10747which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10748colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10749hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10750component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10751
10752&*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10753values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10754check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10755host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10756.code
10757${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10758.endd
10759to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10760
10761.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10762.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10763.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10764.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10765This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10766&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10767queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10768query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10769password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10770server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10771with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10772will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10773of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10774this can be used.
10775
10776
10777.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10778 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10779.cindex "string" "comparison"
10780.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10781.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10782.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10783The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10784string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10785comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10786case-independent.
10787
10788.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10789 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10790.cindex "string" "comparison"
10791.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10792.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10793.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10794The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10795string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10796includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10797case-independent.
10798
10799
10800.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10801.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10802.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10803.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10804The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10805expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10806regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10807escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10808(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10809premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10810&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10811For example,
10812.code
10813${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10814.endd
10815If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10816backslashes is also required.
10817
10818The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10819The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10820metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10821and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10822the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10823metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10824
10825.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10826At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10827substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10828succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10829will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10830of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10831combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10832variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10833
10834.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10835.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10836See &*match_local_part*&.
10837
10838.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10839.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10840See &*match_local_part*&.
10841
10842.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10843.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10844This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10845be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10846address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10847list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10848.code
10849${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10850.endd
10851The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10852
10853.ilist
10854An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10855.next
10856A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10857.next
10858An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10859useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10860in a single test such as
10861. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10862. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10863. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10864. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10865.code
10866 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10867.endd
10868where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10869.next
10870The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10871.next
10872Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10873even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10874address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10875&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10876masks. For example:
10877.code
10878 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10879.endd
10880It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10881do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10882address mask, for example:
10883.code
10884 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10885.endd
10886However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10887just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10888.code
10889 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10890.endd
10891.endlist ilist
10892
10893Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10894Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10895
10896Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10897
10898.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10899.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10900.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10901.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10902.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10903This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10904possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10905condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10906example is:
10907.code
10908${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10909.endd
10910In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10911list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10912expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10913Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10914.code
10915${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10916.endd
10917.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10918For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10919item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10920have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10921caselessly.
10922
10923Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10924Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10925
10926&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10927hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10928how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10929matched using &%match_ip%&.
10930
10931.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10932.cindex "PAM authentication"
10933.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10934.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10935.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10936.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10937&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10938(&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10939available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10940distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10941the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10942.code
10943SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10944.endd
10945in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10946in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10947
10948The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10949colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10950The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10951taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10952The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10953from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10954request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10955
10956There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10957characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10958separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10959item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10960of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10961.code
10962server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10963.endd
10964For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10965.code
10966server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10967.endd
10968In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10969running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10970messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10971A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10972Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10973The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10974to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10975group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10976
10977
10978.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10979.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10980.cindex "Cyrus"
10981.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10982.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10983This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10984This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10985that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10986deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10987
10988The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10989the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10990building Exim. For example:
10991.code
10992CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10993.endd
10994You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10995the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10996from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10997access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10998
10999The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11000password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11001configuration, you might have this:
11002.code
11003server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11004.endd
11005Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11006.code
11007server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11008.endd
11009.vitem &*queue_running*&
11010.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11011.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11012.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11013This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11014initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11015
11016
11017.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11018.cindex "Radius"
11019.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11020.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11021Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11022set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11023the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11024support.
11025
11026With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11027library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11028this library, you need to set
11029.code
11030RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11031.endd
11032in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11033&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11034.code
11035RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11036.endd
11037in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11038You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11039Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11040
11041The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11042Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11043the authentication is successful. For example:
11044.code
11045server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11046.endd
11047
11048
11049.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11050 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11051.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11052.cindex "Cyrus"
11053.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11054.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11055This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11056daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11057Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11058by a process that is not running as root.
11059
11060The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11061the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11062building Exim. For example:
11063.code
11064CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11065.endd
11066You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11067the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11068from the Cyrus SASL library.
11069
11070Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11071two are mandatory. For example:
11072.code
11073server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11074.endd
11075The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11076in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11077realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11078.endlist vlist
11079
11080
11081
11082.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11083.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11084Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11085and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11086conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11087sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11088the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11089
11090
11091.vlist
11092.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11093.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11094.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11095The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11096any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11097For example,
11098.code
11099${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11100.endd
11101When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11102evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11103numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11104
11105.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11106.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11107.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11108The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11109all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11110sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11111the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11112parsed but not evaluated.
11113.endlist
11114.ecindex IIDexpcond
11115
11116
11117
11118
11119.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11120.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11121This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11122of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11123support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11124
11125.vlist
11126.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11127.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11128When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11129captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11130processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11131However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11132values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11133variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11134precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11135Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11136matching condition.
11137
11138.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11139Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11140any arguments are copied to these variables,
11141any unused variables being made empty.
11142
11143.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11144Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11145can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11146long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11147example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11148variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11149used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11150same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11151with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11152during subsequent delivery.
11153
11154.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11155These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11156are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11157received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11158message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11159also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11160message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11161and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11162delivery.
11163
11164.vitem &$acl_narg$&
11165Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11166this variable has the number of arguments.
11167
11168.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11169.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11170After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11171message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11172be preserved by coding like this:
11173.code
11174warn !verify = sender
11175 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11176.endd
11177You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11178&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11179failure.
11180
11181.vitem &$address_data$&
11182.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11183This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11184value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11185and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11186the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11187for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11188user filter files.
11189
11190If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11191a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11192conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11193to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11194of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11195from the child's routing.
11196
11197If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11198sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11199&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11200address.
11201
11202In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11203after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11204these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11205
11206.vitem &$address_file$&
11207.vindex "&$address_file$&"
11208When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11209to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11210is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11211default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11212.code
11213/home/r2d2/savemail
11214.endd
11215then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11216contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11217.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11218For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11219then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11220to the relevant file.
11221
11222.vitem &$address_pipe$&
11223.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11224When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11225this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11226
11227.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11228.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11229These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11230&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11231
11232.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11233.cindex "authentication" "id"
11234.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11235When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11236preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11237&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11238user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11239in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11240&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11241When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11242the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11243process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11244command line option.
11245
11246.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11247.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11248.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11249When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11250will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11251id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11252available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11253A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11254authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11255the ACL's as well.
11256
11257
11258.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11259.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11260.cindex "authentication" "sender"
11261.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11262.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11263When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11264SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11265described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11266&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11267available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11268sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11269
11270.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11271When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11272value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11273name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11274can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11275
11276
11277.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11278.cindex "authentication" "failure"
11279.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11280This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11281command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11282possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11283(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11284&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11285is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11286negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11287an undefined mechanism.
11288
11289.vitem &$av_failed$&
11290.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11291This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11292extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11293problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11294the ACL malware condition.
11295
11296.vitem &$body_linecount$&
11297.cindex "message body" "line count"
11298.cindex "body of message" "line count"
11299.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11300When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11301number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11302
11303.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11304.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11305.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11306.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11307.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11308When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11309number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11310
11311.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11312.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11313This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11314it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11315chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11316
11317.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11318.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11319This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11320up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11321file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11322
11323.vitem &$caller_gid$&
11324.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11325.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11326The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11327not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11328&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11329incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11330
11331.vitem &$caller_uid$&
11332.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11333.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11334The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11335not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11336&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11337incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11338
11339.vitem &$compile_date$&
11340.vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11341The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11342
11343.vitem &$compile_number$&
11344.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11345The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11346of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11347compilations of the same version of the program.
11348
11349.new
11350.vitem &$config_dir$&
11351.vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11352The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11353&$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11354contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11355&$config_dir$& is ".".
11356
11357.vitem &$config_file$&
11358.vindex "&$config_file$&"
11359The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11360.wen
11361
11362.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11363.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11364This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11365the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11366details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11367
11368.vitem &$demime_reason$&
11369.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11370This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11371content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11372see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11373
11374.new
11375.vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11376 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11377 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11378 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11379 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11380 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11381 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11382 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11383 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11384 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11385 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11386 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11387 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11388 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11389 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11390 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11391 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11392 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11393 &$dkim_key_notes$&
11394These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11395For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11396
11397.vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11398.vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11399When a message has been received this variable contains
11400a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11401For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11402.wen
11403
11404.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11405 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11406 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11407 &$dnslist_value$&
11408.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11409.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11410.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11411.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11412.cindex "black list (DNS)"
11413When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11414the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11415looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11416main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11417
11418.vitem &$domain$&
11419.vindex "&$domain$&"
11420When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11421contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11422case for &$domain$&.
11423
11424Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11425&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11426is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11427message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11428
11429When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11430RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11431have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11432at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11433the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11434which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11435
11436.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11437At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11438set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11439
11440The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11441
11442.ilist
11443When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11444the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11445&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11446normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11447is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11448&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11449the &(smtp)& transport.
11450
11451.next
11452When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11453&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11454it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11455rewrite domains by file lookup.
11456
11457.next
11458With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11459&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11460a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11461is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11462that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11463recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11464
11465.next
11466.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11467.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11468When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11469the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11470.endlist
11471
11472
11473.vitem &$domain_data$&
11474.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11475When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11476means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11477of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11478address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11479transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11480used.
11481
11482&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11483domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11484the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11485to nothing.
11486
11487.vitem &$exim_gid$&
11488.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11489This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11490
11491.vitem &$exim_path$&
11492.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11493This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11494
11495.vitem &$exim_uid$&
11496.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11497This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11498
11499.new
11500.vitem &$exim_version$&
11501.vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11502This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11503The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11504Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11505There may be other characters following the minor version.
11506.wen
11507
11508.vitem &$found_extension$&
11509.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11510This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11511content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11512see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11513
11514.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11515This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11516inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11517be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11518characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11519
11520.vitem &$headers_added$&
11521.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11522Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11523the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11524The headers are a newline-separated list.
11525
11526.vitem &$home$&
11527.vindex "&$home$&"
11528When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11529directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11530means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11531explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11532by a setting on the transport itself.
11533
11534When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11535of the environment variable HOME.
11536
11537.vitem &$host$&
11538.vindex "&$host$&"
11539If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11540list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11541to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11542to local and remote transports.
11543
11544.cindex "transport" "filter"
11545.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11546For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11547&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11548particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11549using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11550&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11551is connected.
11552
11553When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11554&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11555client is connected.
11556
11557
11558.vitem &$host_address$&
11559.vindex "&$host_address$&"
11560This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11561for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11562when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11563
11564.vitem &$host_data$&
11565.vindex "&$host_data$&"
11566If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11567result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11568allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11569.code
11570deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11571message = $host_data
11572.endd
11573.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11574.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11575.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11576This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11577message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11578name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11579variables is set to &"1"&.
11580
11581.ilist
11582If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11583succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11584
11585.next
11586If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11587tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11588lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11589.endlist ilist
11590
11591Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11592single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11593names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11594is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11595&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11596IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11597sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11598lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11599the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11600&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11601
11602.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11603.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11604See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11605
11606.vitem &$host_port$&
11607.vindex "&$host_port$&"
11608This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11609for an outbound connection.
11610
11611
11612.vitem &$inode$&
11613.vindex "&$inode$&"
11614The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11615option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11616of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11617a unique name for the file.
11618
11619.vitem &$interface_address$&
11620.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11621This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11622
11623.vitem &$interface_port$&
11624.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11625This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11626
11627.vitem &$item$&
11628.vindex "&$item$&"
11629This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11630conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11631&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11632empty.
11633
11634.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11635.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11636This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11637contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11638lookup.
11639
11640.vitem &$load_average$&
11641.vindex "&$load_average$&"
11642This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11643is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11644variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11645
11646.vitem &$local_part$&
11647.vindex "&$local_part$&"
11648When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11649variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11650delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11651session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11652
11653Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11654&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11655&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11656because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11657once.
11658
11659.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11660.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11661If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11662value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11663any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11664&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11665
11666When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11667result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11668the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11669&$address_pipe$&).
11670
11671When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11672local part of the recipient address.
11673
11674When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11675&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11676it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11677
11678In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11679the addresses
11680.code
11681"abc:xyz"@test.example
11682abc\:xyz@test.example
11683.endd
11684the value of &$local_part$& is
11685.code
11686abc:xyz
11687.endd
11688If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11689inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11690have:
11691.code
11692data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11693.endd
11694&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11695to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11696&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11697
11698.vitem &$local_part_data$&
11699.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11700When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11701lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11702router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11703to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11704handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11705
11706&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11707matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11708available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11709variable expands to nothing.
11710
11711.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11712.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11713When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11714specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11715variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11716
11717.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11718.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11719When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11720specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11721variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11722
11723.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11724.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11725This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11726a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11727
11728.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11729.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11730See &$local_user_uid$&.
11731
11732.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11733.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11734This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11735&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11736are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11737and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11738router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11739are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11740
11741.vitem &$localhost_number$&
11742.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11743This contains the expanded value of the
11744&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11745been read.
11746
11747.vitem &$log_inodes$&
11748.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11749The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11750log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11751referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11752the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11753
11754.vitem &$log_space$&
11755.vindex "&$log_space$&"
11756The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11757partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11758whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11759ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11760the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11761
11762
11763.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11764.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11765This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11766a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11767.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11768It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11769&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11770and &"yes"& if it was.
11771.new
11772Results that are labelled as authoritive answer that match
11773the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
11774as authenticated data.
11775.wen
11776
11777.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11778.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11779This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11780&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11781&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11782contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11783without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11784variable is empty.
11785
11786.vitem &$malware_name$&
11787.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11788This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11789content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11790when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11791
11792.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11793.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11794.cindex "maximum" "line length"
11795.cindex "line length" "maximum"
11796This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11797received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11798character(s).
11799
11800.vitem &$message_age$&
11801.cindex "message" "age of"
11802.vindex "&$message_age$&"
11803This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11804of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11805delivery attempt.
11806
11807.vitem &$message_body$&
11808.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11809.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11810.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11811.vindex "&$message_body$&"
11812.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11813This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11814being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11815number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11816&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11817
11818.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11819By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11820easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11821this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11822zeros are always converted into spaces.
11823
11824.vitem &$message_body_end$&
11825.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11826.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11827.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11828This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11829body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11830&$message_body$&.
11831
11832.vitem &$message_body_size$&
11833.cindex "body of message" "size"
11834.cindex "message body" "size"
11835.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11836When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11837in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11838separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11839also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11840
11841.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11842.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11843When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11844unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11845An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11846received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11847line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11848&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11849
11850.vitem &$message_headers$&
11851.vindex &$message_headers$&
11852This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11853is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11854lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11855same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11856
11857.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11858.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11859This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11860contents of header lines is done.
11861
11862.vitem &$message_id$&
11863This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11864
11865.vitem &$message_linecount$&
11866.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11867This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11868message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11869During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11870number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11871routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11872&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11873lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11874from the body is not counted.
11875
11876As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11877appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11878&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11879file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11880header and the body).
11881
11882Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11883.code
11884deny message = Too many lines in message header
11885 condition = \
11886 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11887.endd
11888In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11889message has not yet been received.
11890
11891.vitem &$message_size$&
11892.cindex "size" "of message"
11893.cindex "message" "size"
11894.vindex "&$message_size$&"
11895When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11896most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11897message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11898deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11899expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11900doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11901precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11902&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11903
11904.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11905While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11906contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11907value may not, of course, be truthful.
11908
11909.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11910A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11911available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11912details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11913
11914.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11915These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11916of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11917
11918.vitem &$original_domain$&
11919.vindex "&$domain$&"
11920.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11921When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11922same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11923generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11924variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11925differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11926aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11927single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11928
11929If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11930filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11931part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11932
11933.vitem &$original_local_part$&
11934.vindex "&$local_part$&"
11935.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11936When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11937same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11938local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11939part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11940filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11941the original address.
11942
11943If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11944case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11945This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11946one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11947delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11948
11949If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11950filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11951part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11952
11953.vitem &$originator_gid$&
11954.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11955.cindex "sender" "gid"
11956.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11957.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11958This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11959message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11960gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11961normally the gid of the Exim user.
11962
11963.vitem &$originator_uid$&
11964.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11965.cindex "sender" "uid"
11966.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11967.vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11968The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11969messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11970For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11971user.
11972
11973.vitem &$parent_domain$&
11974.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11975This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11976above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11977
11978.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11979.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11980This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11981(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11982
11983.vitem &$pid$&
11984.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11985.vindex "&$pid$&"
11986This variable contains the current process id.
11987
11988.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11989.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11990.cindex "transport" "filter"
11991.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11992This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11993&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11994&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11995(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11996It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11997variable"& error if encountered.
11998
11999.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12000.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12001This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12002configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12003a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12004&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12005qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12006
12007
12008.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12009This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12010which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12011&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12012
12013.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12014This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12015which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12016&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12017
12018.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12019This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12020which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12021&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12022
12023.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12024.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12025The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12026
12027.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12028.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12029The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12030or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12031
12032.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12033.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12034When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12035RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12036RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12037
12038.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12039.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12040.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12041When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12042RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12043temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12044
12045.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12046.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12047When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12048RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12049permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12050
12051.vitem &$received_count$&
12052.vindex "&$received_count$&"
12053This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12054including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12055is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12056delivering.
12057
12058.vitem &$received_for$&
12059.vindex "&$received_for$&"
12060If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12061variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12062built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12063the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12064
12065.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12066.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12067As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12068variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12069is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12070&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12071the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12072option.
12073
12074As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12075could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12076on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12077values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12078messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12079time.
12080For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12081
12082.vitem &$received_port$&
12083.vindex "&$received_port$&"
12084See &$received_ip_address$&.
12085
12086.vitem &$received_protocol$&
12087.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12088When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12089protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12090by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12091&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12092(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12093is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12094connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12095
12096Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12097automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12098&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12099encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12100where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12101STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12102
12103The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12104messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12105identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12106
12107.vitem &$received_time$&
12108.vindex "&$received_time$&"
12109This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12110as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12111
12112.vitem &$recipient_data$&
12113.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12114This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12115condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12116until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12117.display
12118&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12119&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12120.endd
12121&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12122method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12123The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12124expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12125
12126.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12127.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12128In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12129information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12130
12131.ilist
12132&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12133was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12134
12135.next
12136&"route"&: Routing failed.
12137
12138.next
12139&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12140or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12141MAIL).
12142
12143.next
12144&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12145.next
12146
12147&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12148.endlist
12149
12150The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12151rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12152
12153.vitem &$recipients$&
12154.vindex "&$recipients$&"
12155This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12156a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12157is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12158unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12159cases:
12160
12161.olist
12162In a system filter file.
12163.next
12164In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12165is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12166&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12167&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12168.next
12169From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12170.endlist
12171
12172
12173.vitem &$recipients_count$&
12174.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12175When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12176envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12177from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12178increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12179
12180
12181.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12182.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12183This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12184&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12185
12186
12187.vitem &$reply_address$&
12188.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12189When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12190&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12191contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12192white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12193decoding or character code translation takes place.
12194
12195.vitem &$return_path$&
12196.vindex "&$return_path$&"
12197When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12198the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12199in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12200same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12201mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12202for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12203address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12204that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12205the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12206envelope sender.
12207
12208.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12209.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12210This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12211
12212.vitem &$router_name$&
12213.cindex "router" "name"
12214.cindex "name" "of router"
12215.vindex "&$router_name$&"
12216During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12217
12218.vitem &$runrc$&
12219.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12220.vindex "&$runrc$&"
12221This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12222&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12223assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12224preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12225reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12226another.
12227
12228.vitem &$self_hostname$&
12229.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12230.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12231When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12232local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12233One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12234happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12235original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12236
12237.vitem &$sender_address$&
12238.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12239When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12240that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12241is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12242value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12243
12244.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12245.vindex "&$address_data$&"
12246.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12247If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12248sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12249distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12250after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12251longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12252
12253.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12254.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12255The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12256
12257.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12258.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12259The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12260
12261.vitem &$sender_data$&
12262.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12263This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12264in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12265value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12266this:
12267.display
12268&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12269&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12270.endd
12271&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12272method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12273The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12274expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12275
12276.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12277.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12278When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12279name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12280brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12281enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12282issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12283looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12284&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12285start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12286verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12287the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12288the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12289
12290.new
12291.vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12292.vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12293This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12294.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12295done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticatied data.
12296.wen
12297
12298.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12299.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12300When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12301command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12302set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12303the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12304
12305.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12306.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12307When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12308this variable contains that
12309host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12310
12311.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12312.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12313This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12314driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12315received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12316&$authenticated_id$&.
12317
12318.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12319.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12320If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12321(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12322otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12323resolver library states that both
12324the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12325other times, this variable is false.
12326
12327.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12328It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12329library, by setting:
12330.code
12331dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12332.endd
12333
12334Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12335validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12336
12337If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12338mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12339
12340
12341.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12342.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12343When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12344host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12345other means, this variable is empty.
12346
12347.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12348If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12349&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12350A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12351via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12352any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12353&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12354
12355.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12356However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12357DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12358&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12359
12360Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12361host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12362in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12363is set to &"1"&.
12364
12365Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12366maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12367these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12368following are true:
12369
12370.ilist
12371A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12372.next
12373The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12374configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12375to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12376.next
12377Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12378that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12379&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12380.next
12381The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12382In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12383EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12384.next
12385The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12386domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12387. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12388. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12389.code
12390 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12391.endd
12392which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12393IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12394.endlist
12395
12396
12397.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12398.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12399When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12400number that was used on the remote host.
12401
12402.vitem &$sender_ident$&
12403.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12404When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12405identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12406been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12407called Exim.
12408
12409.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12410A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12411&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12412&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12413
12414.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12415.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12416.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12417.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12418This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12419either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12420there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12421there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12422the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12423followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12424first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12425the parentheses.
12426
12427There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12428was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12429address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12430all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12431into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12432
12433.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12434.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12435In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12436about the failure. The details are the same as for
12437&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12438
12439.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12440.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12441This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12442been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12443used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12444on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12445connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12446
12447.vitem &$sending_port$&
12448.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12449This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12450been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12451connections, see &$received_port$&.
12452
12453.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12454.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12455During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12456host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12457&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12458value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12459
12460.vitem &$smtp_command$&
12461.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12462During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12463entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12464the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12465.code
12466MAIL FROM:<>
12467MAIL FROM: <>
12468.endd
12469For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12470command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12471rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12472the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12473
12474.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12475.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12476.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12477While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12478argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12479space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12480somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12481
12482.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12483.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12484This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12485daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12486in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12487connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12488the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12489never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12490there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12491single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12492daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12493
12494.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12495These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12496that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12497filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12498example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12499message is junk mail.
12500
12501.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12502A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12503is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12504&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12505
12506
12507.vitem &$spool_directory$&
12508.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12509The name of Exim's spool directory.
12510
12511.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12512.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12513The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12514being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12515If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12516is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12517
12518.vitem &$spool_space$&
12519.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12520The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12521Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12522variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12523find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12524value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12525megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12526.code
12527condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12528.endd
12529See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12530
12531
12532.vitem &$thisaddress$&
12533.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12534This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12535command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12536command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12537interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12538
12539.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12540.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12541Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12542on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12543this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12544If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12545The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12546when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12547
12548The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12549except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12550the outbound.
12551
12552.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12553.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12554Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12555on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12556this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12557If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12558
12559.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12560.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12561This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12562inbound connection when the message was received.
12563It is only useful as the argument of a
12564&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12565or a &%def%& condition.
12566
12567.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12568.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12569This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12570inbound connection when the message was received.
12571It is only useful as the argument of a
12572&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12573or a &%def%& condition.
12574.new
12575If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12576which is not the leaf.
12577.wen
12578
12579.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12580.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12581This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12582outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12583&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12584or a &%def%& condition.
12585
12586.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12587.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12588This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12589outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12590&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12591or a &%def%& condition.
12592.new
12593If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12594which is not the leaf.
12595.wen
12596
12597.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12598.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12599This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12600message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12601
12602The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12603except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12604the outbound.
12605
12606.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12607.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12608This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12609outbound SMTP connection was made,
12610and &"0"& otherwise.
12611
12612.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12613.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12614.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12615When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12616connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12617example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12618received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12619&$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12620non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12621
12622The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12623but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12624becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12625
12626.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12627.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12628This variable is
12629cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12630and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12631&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12632details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12633
12634.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12635.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12636When a message is received from a remote client connection
12637the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12638.code
126390 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
126401 No response to request
126412 Response not verified
126423 Verification failed
126434 Verification succeeded
12644.endd
12645
12646.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12647.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12648When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12649the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12650See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12651
12652.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12653.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12654.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12655When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12656connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12657the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12658&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12659.new
12660If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12661which is not the leaf.
12662.wen
12663
12664The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12665except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12666the outbound.
12667
12668.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12669.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12670When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12671connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12672the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12673&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12674.new
12675If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12676which is not the leaf.
12677.wen
12678
12679.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12680.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12681.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12682.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12683When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12684Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12685If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12686some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12687will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12688a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12689used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12690
12691The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12692except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12693the outbound.
12694
12695.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12696.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12697.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12698During outbound
12699SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12700the transport.
12701
12702.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12703.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12704The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12705files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12706
12707.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12708.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12709The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12710
12711.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12712.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12713The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12714
12715.vitem &$tod_full$&
12716.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12717A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12718+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12719positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12720values for those that are behind (west).
12721
12722.vitem &$tod_log$&
12723.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12724The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
127251995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12726
12727.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12728.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12729This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12730is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12731flag.
12732
12733.vitem &$tod_zone$&
12734.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12735This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12736-0500.
12737
12738.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12739.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12740This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12741by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12742
12743.vitem &$transport_name$&
12744.cindex "transport" "name"
12745.cindex "name" "of transport"
12746.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12747During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12748
12749.vitem &$value$&
12750.vindex "&$value$&"
12751This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12752or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12753&*reduce*& expansion.
12754
12755.vitem &$verify_mode$&
12756.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12757While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12758or for cutthrough delivery,
12759contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12760Otherwise, empty.
12761
12762.vitem &$version_number$&
12763.vindex "&$version_number$&"
12764The version number of Exim.
12765
12766.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12767.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12768This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12769delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12770
12771.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12772.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12773This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12774delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12775.endlist
12776.ecindex IIDstrexp
12777
12778
12779
12780. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12781. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12782
12783.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12784.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12785Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12786Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12787use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12788your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12789the line
12790.code
12791EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12792.endd
12793in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12794
12795
12796.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12797.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12798Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12799&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12800no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12801interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12802the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12803option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12804a newly created Perl interpreter.
12805
12806The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12807need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12808should usually be something like
12809.code
12810perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12811.endd
12812where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12813use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12814soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12815the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12816its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12817fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12818necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12819the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12820two ways:
12821
12822.ilist
12823.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12824Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12825a startup when Exim is entered.
12826.next
12827The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12828overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12829.endlist
12830
12831There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12832initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12833
12834
12835.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12836When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12837of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12838by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12839forms:
12840.code
12841${perl{foo}}
12842${perl{foo}{argument}}
12843${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12844.endd
12845which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12846arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12847with an error message of the form
12848.code
12849Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12850.endd
12851The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12852it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12853return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12854an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12855by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12856that was passed to &%die%&.
12857
12858
12859.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12860Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12861is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12862the Perl code
12863.code
12864my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12865.endd
12866makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12867Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12868&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12869
12870If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12871&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12872expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12873an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12874
12875.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12876.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12877Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12878&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12879debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12880&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12881timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12882
12883
12884.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12885.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12886You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12887Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12888before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12889SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12890is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12891error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12892avoided, but the output is lost.
12893
12894.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12895The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12896Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12897you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12898output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12899change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12900For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12901.code
12902$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12903.endd
12904Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12905example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12906include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12907as the first subroutine argument.
12908.ecindex IIDperl
12909
12910
12911. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12912. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12913
12914.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12915 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12916 "Starting the daemon"
12917.cindex "daemon" "starting"
12918.cindex "interface" "listening"
12919.cindex "network interface"
12920.cindex "interface" "network"
12921.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12922.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12923.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12924.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12925A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12926hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12927or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12928works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12929In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12930IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12931knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12932
12933.olist
12934When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12935and ports to listen on.
12936.next
12937When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12938are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12939processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12940same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12941when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12942local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12943option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12944as an error situation.
12945.next
12946When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12947for the outgoing connection.
12948.endlist
12949
12950
12951Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12952of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12953addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12954standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12955rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12956
12957In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12958interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12959options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12960chapter describes how they operate.
12961
12962When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12963actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12964
12965
12966
12967.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12968When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12969option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12970following options:
12971
12972.ilist
12973&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12974or service names.
12975(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12976.next
12977&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12978listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12979.endlist
12980
12981The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12982described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12983it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12984colons. For example:
12985.code
12986local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12987 192.168.23.65 ; \
12988 ::1 ; \
12989 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12990.endd
12991There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12992in &%local_interfaces%&:
12993
12994.olist
12995The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12996on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12997.code
12998local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12999 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13000.endd
13001.next
13002The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13003with a colon separator, for example:
13004.code
13005local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13006 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13007.endd
13008.endlist
13009
13010When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13011default setting contains just one port:
13012.code
13013daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13014.endd
13015If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13016specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13017&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13018&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13019IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13020
13021
13022
13023.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13024The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13025as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13026case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13027instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13028default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13029.code
13030local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13031.endd
13032when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13033.code
13034local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13035.endd
13036Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13037
13038
13039
13040.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13041The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13042&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13043instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13044option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13045the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13046exim.
13047
13048The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13049changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13050contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13051&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13052items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13053replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13054.code
13055-oX 1225
13056.endd
13057overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13058whereas
13059.code
13060-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13061.endd
13062overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13063(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13064value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13065
13066
13067
13068.section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13069.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13070.cindex "smtps protocol"
13071.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13072.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13073Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13074before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13075still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13076list of port numbers or service names,
13077connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13078common use of this option is expected to be
13079.code
13080tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13081.endd
13082because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13083a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13084this way when a daemon is started.
13085
13086&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13087daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13088&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13089because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13090connections via the daemon.)
13091
13092
13093
13094
13095.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13096.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13097IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13098can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13099interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13100address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13101percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13102adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13103.code
13104fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13105.endd
13106To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13107allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13108to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13109percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13110address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13111&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13112.code
13113IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13114.endd
13115is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13116Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13117instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13118function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13119&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13120
13121.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13122.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13123Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13124run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13125using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13126connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13127.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13128&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13129activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13130that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13131etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13132to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13133
13134On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13135disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13136option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13137and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13138IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13139
13140
13141
13142.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13143The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13144.code
13145daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13146local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13147.endd
13148This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13149Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13150the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13151read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13152
13153To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13154.code
13155daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13156.endd
13157(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13158.code
13159local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13160 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13161.endd
13162To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13163IPv4 loopback address only:
13164.code
13165local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13166.endd
13167To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13168.code
13169local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13170.endd
13171&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13172
13173
13174
13175.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13176The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13177whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13178addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13179treated as local.
13180
13181For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13182the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13183available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13184(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13185
13186Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13187many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13188email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13189interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13190&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13191&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13192used for listening. Consider this example:
13193.code
13194local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13195 192.168.53.235 ; \
13196 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13197
13198extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13199.endd
13200The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13201address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13202Exim is routing.
13203
13204In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13205address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13206desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13207these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13208This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13209during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13210host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13211addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13212
13213
13214
13215.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13216Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13217allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13218there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13219&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13220description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13221details.
13222
13223
13224
13225
13226. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13227. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13228
13229.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13230.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13231.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13232The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13233
13234.ilist
13235Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13236&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13237.next
13238Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13239&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13240section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13241.next
13242Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13243(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13244&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13245only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13246settings.
13247.endlist
13248
13249This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13250types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13251in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13252are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13253an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13254listed in more than one group.
13255
13256.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13257.table2
13258.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13259.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13260.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13261.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13262.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13263.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13264.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13265.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13266.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13267.endtable
13268
13269
13270.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13271.table2
13272.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13273.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13274.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13275.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13276.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13277.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13278.endtable
13279
13280
13281
13282.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13283.table2
13284.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13285.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13286.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13287.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13288.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13289.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13290.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13291.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13292.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13293.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13294.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13295.endtable
13296
13297
13298
13299.section "Logging" "SECID99"
13300.table2
13301.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13302.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13303.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13304.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13305.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13306.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13307.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13308.row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13309.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13310.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13311.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13312.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13313.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13314.endtable
13315
13316
13317
13318.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13319.table2
13320.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13321.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13322.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13323.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13324.endtable
13325
13326
13327
13328.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13329.table2
13330.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13331.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13332.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13333.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13334.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13335.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13336.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13337.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13338.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13339.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13340.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13341.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13342.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13343.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13344.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13345.endtable
13346
13347
13348
13349.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13350.table2
13351.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13352.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13353.endtable
13354
13355
13356
13357.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13358.table2
13359.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13360.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13361.endtable
13362
13363
13364
13365.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13366.table2
13367.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13368.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13369.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13370.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13371.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13372.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13373.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13374.endtable
13375
13376
13377
13378.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13379.table2
13380.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13381.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13382.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13383.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13384.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13385.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13386.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13387.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13388.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13389.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13390.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13391.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13392.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13393.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13394.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13395.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13396 connection"
13397.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13398.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13399.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13400.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13401.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13402.endtable
13403
13404
13405
13406.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13407.table2
13408.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13409.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13410.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13411.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13412.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13413.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13414.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13415.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13416.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13417.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13418.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13419.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13420.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13421.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13422.row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13423.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13424.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13425.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13426.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13427.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13428.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13429.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13430 words""&"
13431.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13432.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13433.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13434.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13435.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13436.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13437.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13438.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13439.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13440.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13441.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13442.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13443.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13444.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13445.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13446.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13447.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13448.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13449.endtable
13450
13451
13452
13453.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13454.table2
13455.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13456 item"
13457.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13458 item"
13459.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13460.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13461.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13462.endtable
13463
13464
13465
13466.section "TLS" "SECID108"
13467.table2
13468.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13469.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13470.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13471.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13472.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13473.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13474.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13475.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13476.row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13477.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13478.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13479.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13480.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13481.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13482.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13483.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13484.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13485.endtable
13486
13487
13488
13489.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13490.table2
13491.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13492.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13493.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13494.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13495.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13496.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13497.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13498.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13499.endtable
13500
13501
13502
13503.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13504.table2
13505.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13506.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13507.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13508.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13509.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13510.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13511.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13512.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13513.endtable
13514
13515
13516
13517
13518.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13519.table2
13520.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13521.endtable
13522
13523
13524
13525
13526
13527.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13528See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13529
13530.table2
13531.row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13532.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13533.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13534.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13535.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13536.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13537.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13538.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13539.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13540.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13541.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13542.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13543.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13544.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13545.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13546 connection"
13547.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13548.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13549.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13550.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13551.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13552.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13553.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13554.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13555.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13556.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13557.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13558.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13559.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13560.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13561.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13562.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13563.endtable
13564
13565
13566
13567.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13568.table2
13569.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13570.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13571.row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13572.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13573.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13574.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13575.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13576.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13577.endtable
13578
13579
13580
13581.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13582.table2
13583.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13584.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13585.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13586.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13587 words""&"
13588.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13589.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13590.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13591.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13592.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13593.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13594.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13595.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13596.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13597.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13598.endtable
13599
13600
13601
13602.section "System filter" "SECID115"
13603.table2
13604.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13605.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13606 directory"
13607.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13608.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13609.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13610.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13611.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13612.endtable
13613
13614
13615
13616.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13617.table2
13618.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13619.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13620.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13621.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13622.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13623.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13624.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13625.row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13626.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13627.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13628.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13629.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13630.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13631.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13632.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13633.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13634.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13635.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13636.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13637.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13638.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13639.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13640.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13641.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13642.endtable
13643
13644
13645
13646.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13647.table2
13648.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13649.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13650.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13651.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13652.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13653.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13654.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13655.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13656.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13657.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13658.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13659.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13660.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13661.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13662.endtable
13663
13664
13665
13666.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13667Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13668&dagger;.
13669
13670.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13671.cindex "8BITMIME"
13672.cindex "8-bit characters"
13673.cindex "log" "selectors"
13674.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13675This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13676EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13677However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13678takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13679
13680Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13681feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13682It now defaults to true.
13683A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13684.display
13685&url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13686.endd
13687
13688To log received 8BITMIME status use
13689.code
13690log_selector = +8bitmime
13691.endd
13692
13693.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13694.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13695.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13696This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13697read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13698further details.
13699
13700.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13701This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13702messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13703SMTP messages.
13704
13705.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13706.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13707.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13708This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13709non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13710
13711.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13712.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13713.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13714This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13715received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13716
13717.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13718.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13719This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13720See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13721
13722.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13723.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13724This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13725processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13726acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13727
13728.new
13729.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13730.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13731.cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13732.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13733.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13734.wen
13735This option defines the ACL that,
13736if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13737is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13738processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13739acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13740
13741.new
13742.option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13743.cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13744This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13745of a received message.
13746See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13747.wen
13748
13749.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13750.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13751This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13752received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13753
13754.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13755.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13756This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13757received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13758
13759.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13760.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13761.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13762This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13763command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13764
13765
13766.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13767.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13768This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13769received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13770
13771.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13772.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13773This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13774a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13775&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13776
13777.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13778.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13779This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13780extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13781section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13782
13783.new
13784.option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13785.cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13786This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13787ends without a QUIT command being received.
13788See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13789.wen
13790
13791.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13792This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13793received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13794further details.
13795
13796.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13797.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13798This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13799received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13800
13801.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13802.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13803This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13804received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13805
13806.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13807.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13808This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13809received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13810
13811.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13812.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13813This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13814received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13815
13816.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13817.cindex "admin user"
13818This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13819current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13820colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13821programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13822admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13823not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13824To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13825
13826.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13827.cindex "domain literal"
13828If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13829email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13830format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13831has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13832
13833Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13834format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13835addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13836&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13837domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13838configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13839the local host's IP addresses.
13840
13841
13842.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13843.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13844It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13845and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13846MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13847that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13848practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13849&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13850recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13851
13852.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13853.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13854.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13855Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13856camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13857that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13858experiment if they wish.
13859
13860If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13861UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13862letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13863enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13864adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13865suitable setting is:
13866.code
13867dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13868 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13869.endd
13870Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13871.code
13872dns_check_names_pattern =
13873.endd
13874That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13875
13876
13877.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13878.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13879.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13880If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13881response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13882Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13883Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13884advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13885authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13886&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13887authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13888
13889Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13890and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13891not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13892authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13893to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13894which Exim advertises AUTH.
13895
13896.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13897If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13898is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13899option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13900.code
13901auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13902.endd
13903.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13904If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13905the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13906expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13907
13908
13909.option auto_thaw main time 0s
13910.cindex "thawing messages"
13911.cindex "unfreezing messages"
13912If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13913new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13914this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13915being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13916saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13917
13918&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13919&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13920thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13921
13922
13923.option av_scanner main string "see below"
13924This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13925It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13926.code
13927sophie:/var/run/sophie
13928.endd
13929If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13930before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13931
13932
13933.option bi_command main string unset
13934.oindex "&%-bi%&"
13935This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13936the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13937just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13938required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13939
13940
13941.option bounce_message_file main string unset
13942.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13943.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13944This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13945for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13946chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13947
13948
13949.option bounce_message_text main string unset
13950When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13951message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13952delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13953
13954.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13955.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13956This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13957bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13958causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13959value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13960message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13961error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13962point at which the error was detected are returned.
13963.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13964
13965.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13966If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13967bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13968&%bounce_return_body%&.
13969
13970
13971.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13972.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13973.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13974.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13975This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13976senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13977limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13978any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13979that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13980
13981When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13982greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13983added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13984to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13985size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13986messages.
13987
13988.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13989.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13990.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13991.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13992This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13993bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13994connection. A typical setting might be:
13995.code
13996bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13997.endd
13998which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13999.code
14000MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14001.endd
14002The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14003address.
14004
14005.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14006.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14007.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14008This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14009domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14010section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14011
14012
14013.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14014This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14015domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14016section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14017
14018
14019.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14020This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14021address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14022section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14023
14024
14025.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14026This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14027address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14028section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14029
14030
14031.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14032This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14033callout verification. The default value is
14034.code
14035$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14036.endd
14037See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14038
14039
14040.option check_log_inodes main integer 0
14041See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14042
14043
14044.option check_log_space main integer 0
14045See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14046
14047.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14048.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14049.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14050RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14051system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14052word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14053multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14054exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14055of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14056set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14057
14058
14059.option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14060See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14061
14062
14063.option check_spool_space main integer 0
14064.cindex "checking disk space"
14065.cindex "disk space, checking"
14066.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14067The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14068message is accepted.
14069
14070.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14071.vindex "&$log_space$&"
14072.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14073.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14074When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14075want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14076testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14077&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14078
14079
14080&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14081either value is greater than zero, for example:
14082.code
14083check_spool_space = 10M
14084check_spool_inodes = 100
14085.endd
14086The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14087SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14088transit.
14089
14090&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14091files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14092&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14093
14094If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14095incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14096error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14097SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14098&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14099&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14100
14101The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14102number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14103
14104For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14105failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14106it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14107
14108.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14109.cindex "port" "for daemon"
14110.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14111This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14112listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14113backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14114
14115.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14116.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14117This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14118the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14119(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14120defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14121&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14122
14123.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14124See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14125
14126.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14127.cindex "warning of delay"
14128.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14129When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14130intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14131after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14132string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14133message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14134between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14135with
14136.code
14137delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14138.endd
14139the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14140the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14141because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14142just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14143.code
14144delay_warning = 6h
14145.endd
14146messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14147a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14148.code
14149delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14150.endd
14151Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14152which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14153Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14154
14155.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14156.vindex "&$domain$&"
14157The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14158deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14159expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14160forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14161&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14162not sent. The default is:
14163.code
14164delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14165 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14166 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14167 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14168 } {no}{yes}}
14169.endd
14170This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14171&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14172&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14173&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14174
14175.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14176.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14177.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14178If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14179delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14180the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14181of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14182chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14183
14184.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14185.cindex "load average"
14186.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14187When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14188becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14189ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14190See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14191
14192
14193.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14194.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14195Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14196message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14197handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14198should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14199removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14200occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14201
14202.option disable_fsync main boolean false
14203.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14204This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14205ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14206a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14207build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14208really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14209distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14210
14211When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14212updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14213such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14214Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14215
14216
14217.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14218.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14219If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14220activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14221that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14222etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14223to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14224
14225
14226.new
14227.option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14228.cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14229This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14230It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14231the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14232See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14233.wen
14234
14235
14236.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14237.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14238DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14239&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14240keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14241incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14242may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14243anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14244This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14245by a setting such as this:
14246.code
14247dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14248.endd
14249This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14250&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14251since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14252&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14253when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14254options are applied after this global option.
14255
14256.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14257.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14258When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14259names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14260the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14261contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14262a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14263done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14264value of this option. The default pattern is
14265.code
14266dns_check_names_pattern = \
14267 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14268.endd
14269which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14270they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14271permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14272accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14273&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14274empty string.
14275
14276.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14277This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14278DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14279
14280.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14281This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14282reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14283section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14284
14285
14286.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14287.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14288.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14289If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14290DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14291default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14292
14293If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14294
14295
14296.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14297.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14298.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14299When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14300looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14301(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14302domain matches this list.
14303
14304This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14305not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14306servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14307
14308
14309.option dns_retrans main time 0s
14310.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14311.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14312.cindex "DNS" timeout
14313The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14314retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14315defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14316time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14317totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14318take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14319parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14320but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14321to set in them.
14322.new
14323See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14324.wen
14325
14326
14327.option dns_retry main integer 0
14328See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14329
14330
14331.new
14332.option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14333.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14334.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14335If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14336(Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14337DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14338match with this expanded domain list.
14339
14340Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14341authoritive for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14342bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14343mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14344Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14345a resolver that is an authoritive server for some zones.
14346
14347Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14348to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14349zones that your resolver is authoritive for).
14350
14351If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14352in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14353authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14354authoritive but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14355record in the authoritive section is used instead.
14356.wen
14357
14358.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14359.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14360.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14361.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14362If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14363DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14364the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14365on.
14366
14367If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14368
14369
14370.option drop_cr main boolean false
14371This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14372handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14373described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14374
14375.new
14376.option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14377.cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14378.cindex "DSN" "success"
14379.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14380DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14381and accepted from, these hosts.
14382Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14383and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14384A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14385A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14386are sent.
14387.wen
14388
14389.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14390.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14391.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14392This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14393bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14394Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14395.code
14396dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14397.endd
14398The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14399panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14400
14401.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14402.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14403Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14404message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14405handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14406messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14407be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14408the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14409delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14410
14411
14412.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14413.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14414.cindex "copy of bounce message"
14415Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14416generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14417coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14418items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14419a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14420must be enclosed in double quotes.
14421
14422Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14423(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14424the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14425items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14426are examined. For example:
14427.code
14428errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14429 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14430 postmaster@mydomain.example
14431.endd
14432.vindex "&$domain$&"
14433.vindex "&$local_part$&"
14434The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14435and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14436there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14437.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14438variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14439
14440
14441.option errors_reply_to main string unset
14442.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14443By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14444.display
14445&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14446.endd
14447.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14448where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14449A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14450&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14451overrides the default.
14452
14453Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14454&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14455and warning messages. For example:
14456.code
14457errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14458.endd
14459The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14460address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14461&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14462own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14463not used.
14464
14465
14466.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14467.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14468.cindex "Exim group"
14469This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14470privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14471option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14472of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14473configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14474security issues.
14475
14476
14477.option exim_path main string "see below"
14478.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14479This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14480needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14481the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14482is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14483other place.
14484&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14485you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14486where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14487settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14488
14489
14490.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14491.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14492.cindex "Exim user"
14493This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14494privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14495time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14496options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14497
14498Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14499&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14500not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14501used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14502
14503
14504.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14505This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14506routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14507&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14508
14509
14510. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14511. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14512
14513.option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
14514 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14515.oindex "&%-t%&"
14516.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14517.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14518According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14519are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14520envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14521line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14522behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14523command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14524&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14525argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14526addresses.
14527
14528
14529.option finduser_retries main integer 0
14530.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14531On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14532distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14533related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14534Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14535errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14536many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14537retries.
14538
14539.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14540You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14541a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14542search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14543
14544
14545
14546.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14547.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14548On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14549ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14550delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14551&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14552feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14553warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14554freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14555is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14556supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14557message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14558freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14559log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14560logging that you require.
14561
14562
14563.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14564.cindex "HP-UX"
14565.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14566Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14567password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14568looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14569headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14570of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14571it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14572upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14573
14574When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14575expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14576login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14577user's name.
14578
14579.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14580Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14581pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14582name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14583.code
14584gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14585gecos_name = $1
14586.endd
14587
14588.option gecos_pattern main string unset
14589See &%gecos_name%& above.
14590
14591
14592.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14593This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14594server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14595implementations of TLS.
14596
14597
14598option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14599This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14600the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14601
14602See
14603&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14604for documentation.
14605
14606
14607
14608.option headers_charset main string "see below"
14609This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14610&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14611default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14612ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14613insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14614
14615
14616
14617.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14618.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14619.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14620This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14621section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14622&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14623sections are rejected.
14624
14625
14626.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14627.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14628.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14629This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14630all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14631header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14632zero means &"no limit"&.
14633
14634
14635
14636
14637.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14638.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14639.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14640Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14641mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14642some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14643this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14644if you want to do semantic checking.
14645See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14646set.
14647
14648
14649.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14650.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14651.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14652.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14653This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14654all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14655hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14656.code
14657helo_allow_chars = _
14658.endd
14659Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14660
14661
14662.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14663.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14664.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14665If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14666list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14667default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14668its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14669do.
14670
14671
14672.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14673.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14674.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14675By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14676&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14677to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14678condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14679Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14680to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14681necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14682encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14683Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14684
14685When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14686&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14687EHLO command either:
14688
14689.ilist
14690is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14691.next
14692.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14693.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14694matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14695calling host address, or
14696.next
14697when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14698.endlist
14699
14700However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14701fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14702be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14703
14704If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14705.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14706&$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14707
14708.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14709.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14710.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14711Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14712backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14713name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14714&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14715rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14716If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14717error.
14718
14719.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14720.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14721.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14722This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14723manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14724&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14725verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14726item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14727it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14728
14729This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14730delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14731configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14732domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14733&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14734
14735A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14736messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14737time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14738retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14739
14740
14741.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14742.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14743Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14744is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14745&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14746option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14747default configuration file contains
14748.code
14749host_lookup = *
14750.endd
14751which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14752is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14753
14754After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14755has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14756this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14757
14758.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14759.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14760After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14761unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14762&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14763&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14764
14765
14766.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14767This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14768to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14769first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14770if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14771if you want.
14772
14773&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14774multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14775&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14776case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14777
14778
14779
14780.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14781.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14782If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14783as soon as the connection is made.
14784This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14785nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14786connections immediately.
14787
14788The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14789ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14790sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14791incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14792chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14793
14794
14795.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14796.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14797This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14798happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14799you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14800127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14801the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14802list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14803local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14804.code
14805hosts_connection_nolog = :
14806.endd
14807If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14808
14809
14810
14811.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14812.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14813.cindex "host" "treated as local"
14814If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14815if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14816records
14817or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14818host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14819
14820This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14821&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14822section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14823&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14824that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14825chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14826interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14827
14828
14829.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14830.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14831This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14832to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14833The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14834
14835
14836
14837.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14838.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14839.cindex "discarding bounce message"
14840This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14841that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14842suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14843
14844After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14845because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14846message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14847the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14848again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14849bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14850for frozen messages. For example,
14851.code
14852ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14853.endd
14854retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14855failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14856failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14857value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14858dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14859&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14860
14861
14862.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14863.cindex "&""From""& line"
14864.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14865Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14866the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14867message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14868such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14869match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14870process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14871&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14872
14873
14874.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14875See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14876
14877
14878.option keep_malformed main time 4d
14879This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14880have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14881next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14882logged.
14883
14884
14885.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14886.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14887This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14888a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14889While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14890Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14891and constrained to be a directory.
14892
14893
14894.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14895.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14896This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14897a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14898While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14899Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14900and constrained to be a file.
14901
14902
14903.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14904.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14905This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14906Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14907Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14908
14909
14910.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14911.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14912This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14913to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14914Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14915identity to be proven.
14916
14917
14918.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14919.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14920This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14921the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14922cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14923
14924
14925.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14926.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14927This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14928LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14929details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14930with LDAP support.
14931
14932
14933.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14934.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14935This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14936A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14937See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14938Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14939to hard/demand.
14940
14941
14942.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14943.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14944If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14945connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14946"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14947of SSL-on-connect.
14948In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14949by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14950
14951
14952.option ldap_version main integer unset
14953.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14954This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14955LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14956-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14957the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14958has been built with LDAP support.
14959
14960
14961
14962.option local_from_check main boolean true
14963.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14964.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14965When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14966an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14967checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14968the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14969
14970&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14971locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14972&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14973
14974You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14975on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14976&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14977and the default qualify domain.
14978
14979If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14980and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14981&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14982&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14983
14984.cindex "envelope sender"
14985These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14986is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14987&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14988
14989For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14990request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14991has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14992
14993
14994
14995
14996.option local_from_prefix main string unset
14997When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14998matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14999ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15000done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15001appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15002&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15003example, if
15004.code
15005local_from_prefix = *-
15006.endd
15007is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15008.code
15009From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15010.endd
15011will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15012matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15013qualify domain.
15014
15015
15016.option local_from_suffix main string unset
15017See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15018
15019
15020.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15021This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15022listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15023&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15024options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15025&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15026&%local_interfaces%& is
15027.code
15028local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15029.endd
15030when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15031.code
15032local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15033.endd
15034
15035.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15036.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15037.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15038This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15039&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15040the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15041message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15042non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15043
15044
15045
15046.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15047.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15048When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15049an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15050do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15051also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15052See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15053&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15054
15055
15056
15057
15058.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15059.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15060.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15061.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15062Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15063uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15064value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15065after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15066host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15067range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15068systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15069&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15070characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15071time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15072section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15073
15074
15075
15076.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15077.cindex "log" "file path for"
15078This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15079files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15080when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15081name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15082or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15083they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15084Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15085section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15086used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15087variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15088configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15089&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15090early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15091
15092
15093.option log_selector main string unset
15094.cindex "log" "selectors"
15095This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15096writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15097minus characters. For example:
15098.code
15099log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15100.endd
15101A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15102logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15103
15104
15105.option log_timezone main boolean false
15106.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15107.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15108.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15109By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15110timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15111in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15112avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15113&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15114timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15115of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15116&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15117another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15118
15119
15120.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15121.cindex "too many open files"
15122.cindex "open files, too many"
15123.cindex "file" "too many open"
15124.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15125.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15126This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15127lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15128Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15129file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15130recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15131actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15132as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15133open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15134&%lookup_open_max%&.
15135
15136
15137.option max_username_length main integer 0
15138.cindex "length of login name"
15139.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15140.cindex "limit" "user name length"
15141Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15142&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15143this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15144an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15145
15146
15147.option message_body_newlines main bool false
15148.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15149.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15150.vindex "&$message_body$&"
15151.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15152By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15153the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15154option is set true, this no longer happens.
15155
15156
15157.option message_body_visible main integer 500
15158.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15159.cindex "message body" "visible size"
15160.vindex "&$message_body$&"
15161.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15162This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15163&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15164
15165
15166.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15167.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15168If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15169(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15170locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15171means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15172Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15173Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15174replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15175empty string, the option is ignored.
15176
15177
15178.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15179If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15180the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15181message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15182take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15183the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15184it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15185yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15186before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15187that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15188means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15189colons will become hyphens.
15190
15191
15192.option message_logs main boolean true
15193.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15194.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15195If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15196&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15197Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15198minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15199per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15200which is not affected by this option.
15201
15202
15203.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15204.cindex "message" "size limit"
15205.cindex "limit" "message size"
15206.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15207This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15208value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15209to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15210TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15211optionally followed by K or M.
15212
15213&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15214other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15215the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15216error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15217&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15218
15219Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15220exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15221failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15222an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15223the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15224message that an individual transport can process.
15225
15226If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15227maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15228failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15229virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15230probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
15231default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15232some problems may result.
15233
15234A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15235SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15236SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15237
15238
15239.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15240.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15241This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15242.code
15243SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15244.endd
15245in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15246moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15247and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15248standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15249lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15250
15251
15252.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15253Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15254it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15255contains a full description of this facility.
15256
15257
15258
15259.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15260.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15261This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15262be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15263option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15264
15265
15266.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15267This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15268message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15269recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15270It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15271safety precaution.
15272
15273When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15274list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15275the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15276contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15277can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15278
15279If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15280&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15281example is
15282.code
15283never_users = root:daemon:bin
15284.endd
15285Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15286harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15287transport driver.
15288
15289
15290.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15291.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15292This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15293by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15294each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15295
15296This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15297available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15298The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15299the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15300list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15301&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15302names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15303
15304Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15305SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15306yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15307adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15308invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15309
15310The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15311
15312Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15313"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15314with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15315some now infamous attacks.
15316
15317Examples:
15318.code
15319# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15320openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15321 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15322
15323# Disable older protocol versions:
15324openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15325.endd
15326
15327Possible options may include:
15328.ilist
15329&`all`&
15330.next
15331&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15332.next
15333&`cipher_server_preference`&
15334.next
15335&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15336.next
15337&`ephemeral_rsa`&
15338.next
15339&`legacy_server_connect`&
15340.next
15341&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15342.next
15343&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15344.next
15345&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15346.next
15347&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15348.next
15349&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15350.next
15351&`no_compression`&
15352.next
15353&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15354.next
15355&`no_sslv2`&
15356.next
15357&`no_sslv3`&
15358.next
15359&`no_ticket`&
15360.next
15361&`no_tlsv1`&
15362.next
15363&`no_tlsv1_1`&
15364.next
15365&`no_tlsv1_2`&
15366.next
15367&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15368.next
15369&`single_dh_use`&
15370.next
15371&`single_ecdh_use`&
15372.next
15373&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15374.next
15375&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15376.next
15377&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15378.next
15379&`tls_d5_bug`&
15380.next
15381&`tls_rollback_bug`&
15382.endlist
15383
15384As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15385all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15386to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15387to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15388release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15389where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15390
15391
15392.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15393.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15394This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15395to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15396The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15397
15398
15399.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15400.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15401.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15402.cindex "address" "source-routed"
15403The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15404percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15405replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15406also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15407option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15408but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15409an ACL.
15410
15411&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15412trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15413if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15414implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15415routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15416a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15417local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15418
15419
15420.option perl_at_start main boolean false
15421This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15422interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15423
15424
15425.option perl_startup main string unset
15426This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15427interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15428
15429
15430.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15431.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15432This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15433data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15434&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15435PostgreSQL support.
15436
15437
15438.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15439.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15440.cindex "pid file, path for"
15441This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15442process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15443to the host name:
15444.code
15445pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15446.endd
15447If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15448spool directory.
15449The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15450option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15451of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15452
15453
15454.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15455.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15456This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15457PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15458control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15459&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15460for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15461that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15462not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15463
15464
15465.option prdr_enable main boolean false
15466.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15467This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15468to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15469If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15470If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15471an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15472is recieved. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15473
15474.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15475.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15476If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15477completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15478called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15479purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15480volume of mail. Use with care!
15481
15482
15483.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15484.cindex "name" "of local host"
15485.cindex "host" "name of local"
15486.cindex "local host" "name of"
15487.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15488This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15489HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15490option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15491The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15492server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15493
15494If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15495name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15496contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15497&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15498version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15499explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15500
15501
15502.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15503.cindex "printing characters"
15504.cindex "8-bit characters"
15505By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1550632&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15507when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15508sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15509is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15510characters.
15511
15512This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15513&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15514the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15515described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15516Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15517standards.
15518
15519
15520.option process_log_path main string unset
15521.cindex "process log path"
15522.cindex "log" "process log"
15523.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15524This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15525&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15526utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15527in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15528can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15529different spool directories.
15530
15531
15532.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15533.oindex "&%-M%&"
15534.oindex "&%-R%&"
15535.oindex "&%-q%&"
15536The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15537admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15538&%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15539
15540
15541.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15542.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15543.cindex "address" "qualification"
15544This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15545addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15546recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15547are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15548also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15549locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15550
15551Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15552unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15553&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15554addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15555necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15556addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15557&%primary_hostname%& value.
15558
15559
15560.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15561This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15562addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15563
15564
15565
15566.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15567.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15568.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15569.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15570This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15571A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15572domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15573next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15574
15575
15576.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15577.oindex "&%-bp%&"
15578The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15579queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15580&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15581
15582
15583.option queue_only main boolean false
15584.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15585.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15586If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15587whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15588next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15589delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15590
15591The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15592and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15593&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15594&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15595
15596
15597.option queue_only_file main string unset
15598.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15599.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15600This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15601one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15602it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15603each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15604For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15605&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15606.code
15607queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15608.endd
15609causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15610&_/some/file_& exists.
15611
15612
15613.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15614.cindex "load average"
15615.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15616.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15617If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15618all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15619happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15620the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15621the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15622false.
15623
15624Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15625option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15626determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15627&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15628
15629
15630.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15631.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15632When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15633because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15634all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15635This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15636threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15637connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15638circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15639where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15640should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15641re-evaluated for each message.
15642
15643
15644.option queue_only_override main boolean true
15645.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15646When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15647setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15648&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15649to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15650
15651
15652.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15653.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15654If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15655in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15656must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15657single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15658and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15659single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15660the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15661avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15662&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15663when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15664large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15665
15666
15667
15668.option queue_run_max main integer 5
15669.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15670This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15671can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15672but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15673start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15674very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15675however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15676started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15677
15678Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15679the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15680run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15681the daemon's command line.
15682
15683.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15684.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15685.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15686When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15687received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15688However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15689&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15690message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15691has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15692when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15693over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15694SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15695&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15696&%queue_domains%&.
15697
15698
15699.option receive_timeout main time 0s
15700.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15701This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15702maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15703the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15704&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15705controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15706
15707.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15708.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15709.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15710This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15711added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15712on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15713used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15714added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15715&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15716header lines. The default setting is:
15717
15718.code
15719received_header_text = Received: \
15720 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15721 {${if def:sender_ident \
15722 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15723 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15724 by $primary_hostname \
15725 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15726 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15727 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15728 ${if def:sender_address \
15729 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15730 id $message_exim_id\
15731 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15732.endd
15733
15734The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15735support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15736locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15737header lines such as the following:
15738.code
15739Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15740by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15741(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15742id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15743for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15744Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15745id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15746.endd
15747Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15748the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15749checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15750message was accepted.
15751
15752
15753.option received_headers_max main integer 30
15754.cindex "loop" "prevention"
15755.cindex "mail loop prevention"
15756.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15757When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15758counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15759have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15760This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15761
15762
15763.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15764.cindex "unqualified addresses"
15765.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15766This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15767recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15768qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15769affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15770addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15771host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15772or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15773option was not set.
15774
15775
15776.option recipients_max main integer 0
15777.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15778.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15779If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15780original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15781by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15782all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15783Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15784done.
15785
15786.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15787&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15788RCPT commands in a single message.
15789
15790
15791.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15792If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15793recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15794error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15795error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15796initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15797for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15798
15799
15800.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15801.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15802This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15803hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15804does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15805message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15806have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15807deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15808deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15809each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15810same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15811&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15812with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15813tagged with its process id.
15814
15815This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15816message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15817manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15818deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15819is received.
15820
15821.cindex "number of deliveries"
15822.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15823If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15824need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15825are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15826daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15827fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15828runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15829delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15830then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15831&%remote_max_parallel%&.
15832
15833If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15834&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15835doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15836host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15837
15838
15839.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15840.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15841.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15842When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15843domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15844.code
15845remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15846.endd
15847would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15848then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15849
15850
15851.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15852.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15853This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15854database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15855host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15856past failures.
15857
15858
15859.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15860.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15861.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15862Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15863intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15864straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15865retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15866the default value.
15867
15868
15869.option return_path_remove main boolean true
15870.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15871RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15872&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15873The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15874MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15875in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15876&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15877received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15878the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15879
15880
15881.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15882This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15883
15884
15885.new
15886.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
15887.cindex "RFC 1413"
15888.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15889RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
15890an item in the list.
15891The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
15892for the system.
15893.wen
15894
15895.new
15896.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
15897.wen
15898.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15899.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15900This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15901no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15902
15903
15904.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15905.cindex "unqualified addresses"
15906.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15907This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15908sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15909&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15910not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15911it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15912&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15913using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15914
15915
15916.new
15917.option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
15918.cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
15919.cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
15920This option controls logging of slow lookups.
15921If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
15922and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
15923Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
15924.wen
15925
15926
15927
15928.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15929.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15930This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15931TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15932connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15933other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15934still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15935this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15936connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15937tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15938hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15939
15940
15941
15942.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15943.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15944.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15945.cindex "inetd"
15946This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15947that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15948control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15949value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15950non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15951set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15952
15953A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15954has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15955that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15956and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15957
15958
15959.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15960.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15961.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15962Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15963the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15964check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15965client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15966client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15967
15968When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15969allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15970but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15971or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15972starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15973counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15974following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15975MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15976
15977
15978.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15979You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15980check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15981changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15982live with.
15983
15984
15985. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15986. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15987. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15988. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15989. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15990. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15991. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15992. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15993. the option name to split.
15994
15995.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15996 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15997.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15998.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15999The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16000prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16001results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16002response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16003precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16004seen).
16005
16006
16007.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16008.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16009.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16010This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16011host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16012expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16013reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16014connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16015is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16016of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16017required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16018
16019&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16020constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16021happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16022without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16023could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16024doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16025
16026
16027
16028.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16029.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16030.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16031.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16032If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16033listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16034on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16035fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16036subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16037to all messages received in the same connection.
16038
16039A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16040if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16041also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16042various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16043
16044
16045. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16046
16047.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16048 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16049.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16050.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16051This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16052automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16053the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16054and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16055number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16056are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16057restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16058systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16059dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16060
16061
16062.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16063.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16064.cindex "host" "reserved"
16065When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16066number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16067that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16068&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16069restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16070of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16071of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16072the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16073individual host.
16074
16075For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16076set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16077connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16078provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16079
16080
16081.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16082.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16083.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16084.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16085This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16086several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16087is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16088responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16089incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16090
16091.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16092The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16093is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16094in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16095
16096If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16097expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16098used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16099panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16100value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16101For example:
16102.code
16103smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16104 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16105.endd
16106
16107Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16108messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16109verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16110&%helo_data%& value.
16111
16112.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16113.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16114.cindex "banner for SMTP"
16115.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16116.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16117This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16118positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16119.code
16120smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16121 $version_number $tod_full
16122.endd
16123Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16124multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16125appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16126in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16127multiline response).
16128
16129
16130.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16131.cindex "checking disk space"
16132.cindex "disk space, checking"
16133.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16134When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16135option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16136spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16137leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16138is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16139
16140
16141.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16142.cindex "connection backlog"
16143.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16144.cindex "backlog of connections"
16145This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16146this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16147of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16148attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16149say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16150out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16151value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16152attacks by SYN flooding.
16153
16154
16155.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16156.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16157.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16158The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16159the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16160synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16161fewer, but they still exist.
16162
16163Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16164for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16165client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16166SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16167for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16168input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16169does detect many instances.
16170
16171The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16172If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16173hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16174(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16175
16176
16177
16178.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16179.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16180.vindex "&$domain$&"
16181If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16182command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16183chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16184are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16185argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16186example:
16187.code
16188smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16189 $sender_host_address
16190.endd
16191A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16192complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16193run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16194a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16195receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16196the command.
16197
16198
16199.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16200.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16201When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16202one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16203section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16204
16205
16206.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16207.cindex "load average"
16208If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16209accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16210If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16211the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16212systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16213&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16214
16215
16216
16217.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16218.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16219.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16220Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16221particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16222.code
16223RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16224.endd
16225causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16226(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16227example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16228too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16229dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16230
16231.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16232When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16233&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16234Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16235&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16236not count towards the limit.
16237
16238
16239
16240.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16241.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16242.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16243If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16244Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16245that subvert web
16246clients
16247into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16248non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16249
16250
16251
16252.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16253.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16254.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16255.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16256Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16257can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16258recipients.
16259
16260Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16261facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16262&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16263&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16264
16265When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16266&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16267rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16268respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16269values:
16270
16271.ilist
16272A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16273.next
16274An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16275fractional parts are allowed here.
16276.next
16277A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16278.next
16279A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16280because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16281.endlist
16282
16283For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16284first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16285.code
16286smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16287smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16288.endd
16289The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16290two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16291seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16292delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16293
16294
16295.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16296See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16297
16298
16299.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16300See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16301
16302
16303.option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16304.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16305.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16306This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16307input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16308data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16309the message is abandoned.
16310A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16311.code
16312SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16313SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16314.endd
16315The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16316means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16317
16318.new
16319If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16320expanded before use and may depend on
16321&$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16322.wen
16323
16324
16325.oindex "&%-os%&"
16326The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16327&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16328this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16329of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16330timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16331
16332
16333.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16334This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16335&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16336
16337
16338.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16339.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16340.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16341In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16342&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16343reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16344to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16345policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16346&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16347example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16348.code
16349550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16350550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16351.endd
16352
16353.option spamd_address main string "see below"
16354This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16355extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16356The default value is
16357.code
16358127.0.0.1 783
16359.endd
16360See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16361
16362
16363
16364.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16365.cindex "multiple spool directories"
16366.cindex "spool directory" "split"
16367.cindex "directories, multiple"
16368If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16369subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16370sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16371subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16372arrival of the message.
16373
16374Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16375where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16376directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16377directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16378are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16379
16380It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16381changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16382&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16383after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16384automatically deleted.
16385
16386When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16387changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16388trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16389sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16390sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16391spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16392particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16393if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16394entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16395
16396
16397.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16398.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16399This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16400it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16401configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16402string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16403&$primary_hostname$&.
16404
16405If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16406that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16407log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16408Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16409as failures in the configuration file.
16410
16411By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16412tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16413
16414.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16415.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16416This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16417access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16418
16419.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16420.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16421This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16422variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16423is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16424&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16425
16426.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16427.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16428If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16429items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16430treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16431passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16432option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16433
16434
16435.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16436.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16437.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16438If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16439ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16440MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16441domain causes a syntax error.
16442However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16443syntax checking.
16444
16445
16446.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16447.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16448When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16449separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16450be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16451separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16452nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16453particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16454both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16455containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16456Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16457the LOG_ALERT priority.
16458
16459
16460.option syslog_facility main string unset
16461.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16462This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16463syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16464&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16465If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16466details of Exim's logging.
16467
16468
16469
16470.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16471.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16472This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16473syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16474&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16475
16476
16477
16478.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16479.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16480If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16481omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16482details of Exim's logging.
16483
16484
16485.option system_filter main string&!! unset
16486.cindex "filter" "system filter"
16487.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16488.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16489This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16490the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16491must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16492generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16493appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16494which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16495&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16496
16497
16498.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16499.vindex "&$address_file$&"
16500This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16501&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16502implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16503During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16504
16505
16506.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16507.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16508This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16509command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16510the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16511
16512.option system_filter_group main string unset
16513.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16514This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16515gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16516with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16517
16518.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16519.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16520.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16521This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16522is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16523contains the pipe command.
16524
16525
16526.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16527.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16528This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16529is used in a system filter.
16530
16531
16532.option system_filter_user main string unset
16533.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16534If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16535delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16536process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16537Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16538is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16539configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16540specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16541&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16542
16543If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16544under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16545transport option overrides.
16546
16547
16548.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16549.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16550.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16551.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16552If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16553TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16554turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16555performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16556should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16557However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16558this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16559daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16560TCP_NODELAY.
16561
16562
16563.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16564.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16565.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16566If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16567message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16568is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16569bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16570sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16571If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16572frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16573
16574&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16575frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16576messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16577
16578
16579.option timezone main string unset
16580.cindex "timezone, setting"
16581The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16582running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16583created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16584to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16585.code
16586timezone = UTC
16587.endd
16588The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16589or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16590is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16591time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16592runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16593unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16594
16595
16596.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16597.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16598.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16599.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16600When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16601of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16602response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16603chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16604
16605
16606.option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16607.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16608.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16609The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16610file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16611assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16612&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16613
16614&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16615receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16616use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16617option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16618
16619If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16620if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16621Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16622&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16623
16624.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16625.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16626.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16627This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16628be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16629
16630See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16631
16632
16633.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16634.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16635The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16636the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16637interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16638suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16639
16640The value must be at least 1024.
16641
16642The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16643hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16644by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16645
16646If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16647number.
16648
16649Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16650little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16651larger prime than requested.
16652
16653
16654.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16655.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16656The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16657to be used by Exim.
16658
16659If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16660parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16661PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16662OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16663fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16664loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16665and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16666
16667If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16668loaded by Exim.
16669
16670If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16671Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16672does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16673See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16674
16675If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16676a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
166772.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16678in IKE is assigned number 23.
16679
16680Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16681of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16682"ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16683"ike23".
16684
16685The available primes are:
16686&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16687&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16688&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16689
16690Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16691Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16692
16693The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16694to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16695whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16696tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16697need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16698userbase.
16699
16700Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16701is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16702applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16703used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16704mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16705prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16706acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16707
16708
16709.new
16710.option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16711.cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16712If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16713this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16714
16715Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16716For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16717are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16718which tell the library to choose.
16719
16720If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16721.wen
16722
16723
16724.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16725.cindex TLS "certificate status"
16726.cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16727This option
16728must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16729status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16730Certificate Authority.
16731
16732
16733.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16734.cindex SSMTP
16735.cindex SMTPS
16736This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16737operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16738set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16739further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16740
16741
16742
16743.option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16744.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16745The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16746file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16747the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16748key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16749&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16750
16751See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16752
16753
16754.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16755.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16756.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16757If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16758&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16759support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16760TLS session.
16761
16762
16763.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16764.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16765.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16766This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16767The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16768connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16769different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16770permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16771in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16772preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16773&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16774
16775
16776.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16777.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16778.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16779See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16780
16781
16782.new
16783.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
16784.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16785.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16786The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
16787word "system"
16788or the absolute path to
16789a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
16790match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
16791
16792The "system" value for the option will use a
16793system default location compiled into the SSL library.
16794This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
16795and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
16796must be specified.
16797
16798The use of a directory for the option value is not avilable for GnuTLS versions
16799preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
16800
16801With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16802explicitly
16803either by file or directory
16804are added to those given by the system default location.
16805.wen
16806
16807These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16808than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16809the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16810connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16811Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16812use the explicit directory version.
16813
16814See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16815
16816A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16817being unset.
16818
16819
16820.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16821.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16822.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16823This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16824certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16825&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16826either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16827&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16828
16829Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16830&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16831present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16832aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16833the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16834connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16835ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16836
16837A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16838matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16839certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16840abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16841state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16842such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16843but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16844certificate"&.
16845
16846Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16847certificates.
16848
16849
16850.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16851.cindex "trusted groups"
16852.cindex "groups" "trusted"
16853This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16854option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16855which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16856specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16857details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16858&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16859are trusted.
16860
16861.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16862.cindex "trusted users"
16863.cindex "user" "trusted"
16864This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16865option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16866trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16867&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16868If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16869Exim user are trusted.
16870
16871.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16872.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16873.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16874This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16875the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16876gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16877used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16878can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16879is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16880&%-F%& option.
16881
16882.option unknown_username main string unset
16883See &%unknown_login%&.
16884
16885.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16886.cindex "trusted users"
16887.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16888.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16889.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16890.cindex "envelope sender"
16891When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16892normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16893default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16894senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16895is used) is ignored.
16896
16897However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16898to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16899.code
16900exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16901.endd
16902.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16903The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16904other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16905users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16906patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16907identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16908users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16909followed by a hyphen
16910by a setting like this:
16911.code
16912untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16913.endd
16914If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16915restriction, you can use
16916.code
16917untrusted_set_sender = *
16918.endd
16919The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16920only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16921to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16922parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16923&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16924necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16925overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16926described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16927
16928The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16929&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16930&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16931envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16932sender address.
16933
16934
16935.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16936.cindex "&""From""& line"
16937.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16938Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16939an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16940particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16941of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16942matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16943&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16944default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16945.code
16946From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16947From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16948.endd
16949The pattern can be seen by running
16950.code
16951exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16952.endd
16953It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16954year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16955regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16956&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16957(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16958&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16959
16960
16961.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16962See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16963
16964
16965.option warn_message_file main string unset
16966.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16967.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16968This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16969for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16970been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16971&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16972&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16973
16974
16975.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16976.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16977If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16978See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16979.ecindex IIDconfima
16980.ecindex IIDmaiconf
16981
16982
16983
16984
16985. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16986. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16987
16988.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16989.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16990.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16991This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16992Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16993
16994For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16995&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16996which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16997provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16998&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16999
17000
17001
17002.option address_data routers string&!! unset
17003.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17004The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17005precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17006router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17007&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17008delivery of the address to be deferred.
17009
17010.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17011When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17012accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17013routers, and the eventual transport.
17014
17015&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17016that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17017in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17018either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17019put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17020
17021Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17022with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17023on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17024&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17025&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17026
17027The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17028for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17029you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17030.code
17031uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17032.endd
17033In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17034.code
17035file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17036.endd
17037This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17038lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17039
17040.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17041.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17042The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17043from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17044&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17045ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17046verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17047
17048
17049
17050.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17051.oindex "&%-bt%&"
17052.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17053If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17054by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17055your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17056having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17057routing.
17058
17059
17060
17061.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17062.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17063.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17064This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17065routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17066&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17067&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17068value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17069includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17070well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17071you could put:
17072.code
17073cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17074.endd
17075on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17076and
17077.code
17078cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17079.endd
17080on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17081this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17082explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17083logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17084
17085
17086.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17087.cindex "case of local parts"
17088.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17089By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17090manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17091If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17092this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17093part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17094turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17095more details.
17096
17097.vindex "&$local_part$&"
17098.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17099.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17100The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17101router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17102an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17103is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17104addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17105and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17106
17107This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17108recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17109modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17110(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17111
17112
17113
17114.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17115.cindex "local user, checking in router"
17116.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17117.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17118.vindex "&$home$&"
17119When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17120address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17121local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17122than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17123holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17124user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17125preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17126given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17127overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17128the router is skipped.
17129
17130If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17131or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17132setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17133two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17134setting to achieve this. For example:
17135.code
17136local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17137.endd
17138Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17139up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17140&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17141
17142
17143
17144.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17145.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17146This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17147router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17148evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17149result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17150&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17151router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17152
17153If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17154precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17155
17156This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17157All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17158
17159The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17160running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17161the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17162.code
17163condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17164.endd
17165Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17166.code
17167condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17168.endd
17169
17170A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17171.code
17172condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17173condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17174condition = foobar
17175.endd
17176
17177If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17178of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17179be specified using &%condition%&.
17180
17181Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17182are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17183they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17184parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17185ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17186Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17187Router rules processing behavior.
17188
17189This is best illustrated in an example:
17190.code
17191# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17192# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17193
17194$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17195true {yes} {no}}
17196
17197$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17198 {yes} {no}}
17199.endd
17200In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17201&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17202default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17203(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17204string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17205with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17206resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17207&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17208
17209In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17210&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17211mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17212conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17213string characters.
17214
17215Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17216true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17217match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17218contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17219expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17220
17221
17222.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17223.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17224If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17225option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17226the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17227If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17228output, and Exim carries on processing.
17229This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17230so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17231option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17232variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17233&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17234are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17235The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17236
17237
17238
17239.option disable_logging routers boolean false
17240If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17241or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17242unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17243transport option of the same name.
17244
17245.new
17246.option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17247.cindex "MX record" "security"
17248.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17249.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17250.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17251DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17252the dnssec request bit set.
17253This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17254
17255.option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17256.cindex "MX record" "security"
17257.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17258.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17259.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17260DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17261the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17262(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17263This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17264.wen
17265
17266
17267.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17268.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17269.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17270If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17271the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17272lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17273expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17274a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17275
17276
17277
17278.option driver routers string unset
17279This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17280to be used.
17281
17282
17283.new
17284.option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17285.cindex "DSN" "success"
17286.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17287If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17288Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17289instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17290Not effective on redirect routers.
17291.wen
17292
17293
17294
17295.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17296.cindex "envelope sender"
17297.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17298If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17299transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17300there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17301message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17302provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17303expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17304
17305The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17306subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17307settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17308setting.
17309
17310If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17311the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17312address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17313expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17314
17315If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17316SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17317any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17318sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17319settings:
17320.code
17321errors_to =
17322errors_to = ""
17323.endd
17324An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17325this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17326no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17327address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17328overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17329
17330.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17331If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17332MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17333path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17334setting &%return_path%&.
17335
17336The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17337manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17338implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17339
17340
17341
17342.option expn routers&!? boolean true
17343.cindex "address" "testing"
17344.cindex "testing" "addresses"
17345.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17346.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17347If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17348as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17349want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17350on for the system alias file.
17351See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17352are evaluated.
17353
17354The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17355&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17356an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17357
17358
17359
17360.option fail_verify routers boolean false
17361.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17362Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17363&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17364
17365
17366
17367.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17368If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17369verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17370
17371
17372
17373.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17374If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17375verifying a sender, verification fails.
17376
17377
17378
17379.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17380.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17381.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17382String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17383colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17384changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17385each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17386defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17387&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17388
17389If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17390associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17391list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17392randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17393transport for further details.
17394
17395
17396.option group routers string&!! "see below"
17397.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17398.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17399.cindex "transport" "local"
17400.cindex "router" "setting group"
17401When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17402specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17403process.
17404The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17405error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17406The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17407is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17408and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17409
17410
17411
17412.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17413.cindex "header lines" "adding"
17414.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17415This option specifies a list of text headers,
17416.new
17417newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17418.wen
17419that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17420Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17421option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17422the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17423&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17424message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17425header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17426&"see"& the added header lines.
17427
17428The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17429&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17430an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17431failures are treated as configuration errors.
17432
17433Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17434for a router; all listed headers are added.
17435
17436&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17437router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17438
17439.cindex "duplicate addresses"
17440.oindex "&%unseen%&"
17441&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17442additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17443For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17444address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17445modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17446circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17447which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17448avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17449
17450
17451
17452.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17453.cindex "header lines" "removing"
17454.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17455This option specifies a list of text headers,
17456.new
17457colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17458.wen
17459that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17460Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17461option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17462the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17463section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17464the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17465to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17466&"see"& the original header lines.
17467
17468The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17469&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17470the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17471errors.
17472
17473Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17474for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17475
17476&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17477router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17478
17479&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17480removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17481routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17482warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17483
17484.new
17485&*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17486items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17487To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17488.wen
17489
17490
17491
17492.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17493.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17494.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17495Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17496entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17497IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17498address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17499like
17500.code
17501remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17502.endd
17503by setting
17504.code
17505ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17506.endd
17507on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17508discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17509attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17510domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17511Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17512router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17513
17514You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17515means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17516.code
17517ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17518ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17519.endd
17520The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17521in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17522
17523This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17524addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17525is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17526domain that is being routed.
17527
17528.vindex "&$host_address$&"
17529During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17530checked.
17531
17532.option initgroups routers boolean false
17533.cindex "additional groups"
17534.cindex "groups" "additional"
17535.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17536.cindex "transport" "local"
17537If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17538the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17539&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17540any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17541and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17542
17543
17544
17545.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17546.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17547.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17548If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17549one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17550section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17551evaluated.
17552
17553The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17554used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17555asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17556the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17557some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17558.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17559.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17560Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17561section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17562
17563.vindex "&$local_part$&"
17564.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17565During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17566running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17567expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17568the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17569a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17570command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17571This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17572the relevant transport.
17573
17574When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17575behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17576means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17577callout.
17578
17579The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17580&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17581&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17582to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17583immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17584.code
17585real_localuser:
17586 driver = accept
17587 local_part_prefix = real-
17588 check_local_user
17589 transport = local_delivery
17590.endd
17591For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17592router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17593.code
17594 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17595 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17596.endd
17597
17598If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17599both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17600are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17601separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17602
17603
17604.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17605See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17606
17607
17608
17609.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17610.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17611.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17612This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17613local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17614&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17615mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17616character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17617parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17618&%username-foo%&.
17619
17620
17621.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17622See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17623
17624
17625
17626.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17627.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17628.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17629The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17630See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17631are evaluated, and
17632section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17633string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17634example:
17635.code
17636local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17637.endd
17638.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17639If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17640for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17641expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17642example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17643send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17644each virtual domain:
17645.code
17646postmaster:
17647 driver = redirect
17648 local_parts = postmaster
17649 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17650.endd
17651
17652
17653.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17654.cindex "log" "delivery line"
17655.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17656Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17657deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17658recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17659this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17660router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17661router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17662redirect addresses.
17663
17664
17665
17666.option more routers boolean&!! true
17667The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17668that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17669result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17670fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17671delivery to be deferred.
17672
17673If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17674further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17675.oindex "&%self%&"
17676However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17677means of the setting
17678.code
17679self = pass
17680.endd
17681or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17682does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17683case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17684
17685Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17686expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17687controls what happens next.
17688
17689
17690.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17691.cindex "timeout" "of router"
17692.cindex "router" "timeout"
17693If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17694address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17695router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17696intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17697host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17698
17699There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17700lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17701applies to all of them.
17702
17703
17704
17705.option pass_router routers string unset
17706.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17707Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17708&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17709routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17710these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17711router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17712of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17713be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17714to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17715&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17716
17717
17718
17719.option redirect_router routers string unset
17720.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17721Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17722generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17723example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17724point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17725
17726The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17727It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17728instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17729which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17730
17731
17732
17733.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17734.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17735.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17736This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17737router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17738Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17739through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17740
17741Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17742be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17743If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17744failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17745
17746If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17747below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17748&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17749existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17750preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17751
17752.cindex "NFS"
17753If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17754the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17755unavailable.
17756
17757This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17758options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17759look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17760full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17761these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17762to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17763that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17764transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17765
17766During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17767facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17768This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17769operates as follows:
17770
17771If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17772characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17773comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17774but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17775used. For example:
17776.code
17777require_files = mail:/some/file
17778require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17779.endd
17780If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17781&%require_files%& condition fails.
17782
17783Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17784checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17785directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17786access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17787
17788&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17789incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17790may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17791may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17792user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17793
17794&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17795&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17796without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17797is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17798check again in that process.
17799
17800The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17801be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17802existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17803circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17804not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17805name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17806as if the file did not exist. For example:
17807.code
17808require_files = +/some/file
17809.endd
17810If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17811handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17812option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17813
17814
17815
17816.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17817.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17818.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17819When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17820in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17821domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17822other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17823Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17824latter kind.
17825
17826This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17827hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17828router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17829set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17830for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17831same name.
17832
17833The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17834appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17835independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17836
17837
17838
17839.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17840.cindex "router" "home directory for"
17841.cindex "home directory" "for router"
17842.vindex "&$home$&"
17843This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17844&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17845transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17846sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17847forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17848cause the router to defer.
17849
17850Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17851&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17852place.
17853(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17854are evaluated.)
17855While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17856&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17857
17858When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17859the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17860delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17861of these values that is set:
17862
17863.ilist
17864The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17865.next
17866The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17867.next
17868The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17869.next
17870The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17871.endlist
17872
17873In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17874router, but not for the transport.
17875
17876
17877
17878.option self routers string freeze
17879.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17880.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17881This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17882list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17883and &(manualroute)& routers.
17884Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17885of remote hosts.
17886Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17887&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17888host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17889The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17890&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17891
17892Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17893example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17894error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17895reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17896freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17897cases:
17898
17899.vlist
17900.vitem &%defer%&
17901Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17902
17903.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17904The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17905be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17906behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17907
17908.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17909The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17910reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17911rewritten.
17912
17913.vitem &%pass%&
17914.oindex "&%more%&"
17915.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17916The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17917&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17918subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17919name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17920distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17921combination
17922.code
17923self = pass
17924no_more
17925.endd
17926ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17927Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17928be passed to the next router.
17929
17930.vitem &%fail%&
17931Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17932
17933.vitem &%send%&
17934.cindex "local host" "sending to"
17935The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17936setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17937makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17938is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17939different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17940.endlist
17941
17942
17943
17944.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17945.cindex "router" "checking senders"
17946If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17947address matches something on the list.
17948See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17949are evaluated.
17950
17951There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17952dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17953setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17954to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17955set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17956verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17957SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17958matters.
17959
17960
17961.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17962.cindex "IP address" "translating"
17963.cindex "packet radio"
17964.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17965There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17966it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17967mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17968routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17969is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17970code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17971SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17972
17973.vindex "&$host_address$&"
17974The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17975by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17976expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17977For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17978If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17979address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17980up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17981produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17982addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17983.code
17984translate_ip_address = \
17985 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17986 {$value}fail}}
17987.endd
17988The file would contain lines like
17989.code
1799010.2.3.128/26 some.host
1799110.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17992.endd
17993You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17994are doing.
17995
17996
17997
17998.option transport routers string&!! unset
17999This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18000and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18001only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18002after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18003and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18004delivery is deferred.
18005
18006The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18007have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18008(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18009
18010
18011
18012.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18013.cindex "current directory for local transport"
18014This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18015to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18016explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18017file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18018option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18019overridden by a setting on the transport.
18020If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18021logged, and delivery is deferred.
18022See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18023environment.
18024
18025
18026
18027
18028.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18029.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18030This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18031local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18032configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18033pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18034string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18035setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18036If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18037logged, and delivery is deferred.
18038
18039If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18040&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18041the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18042the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18043is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18044
18045See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18046environment.
18047
18048
18049
18050
18051.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18052.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18053The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18054that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18055result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18056fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18057delivery to be deferred.
18058
18059When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18060address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18061overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18062&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18063the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18064sometimes true and sometimes false).
18065
18066.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18067Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18068qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18069delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18070In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18071&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18072to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18073&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18074
18075&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18076this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18077only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18078no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18079a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18080duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18081duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18082&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18083so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18084&%redirect%& router may be of help.
18085
18086Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18087&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18088subsequent routers.
18089
18090
18091.option user routers string&!! "see below"
18092.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18093.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18094.cindex "transport" "local"
18095.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18096.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18097When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18098specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18099The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18100error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18101This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18102The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18103the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18104a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18105See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18106&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18107
18108
18109
18110.option verify routers&!? boolean true
18111Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18112&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18113
18114
18115.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18116.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18117.oindex "&%-bv%&"
18118.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18119If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18120delivering in cutthrough mode or
18121testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18122with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18123restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18124&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18125
18126&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18127SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18128accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18129user or group.
18130
18131
18132.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18133If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18134addresses,
18135delivering in cutthrough mode
18136or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18137See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18138are evaluated.
18139See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18140
18141
18142.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18143If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18144or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18145See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18146are evaluated.
18147See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18148.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18149.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18150
18151
18152
18153
18154
18155
18156. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18157. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18158
18159.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18160.cindex "&(accept)& router"
18161.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18162The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18163used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18164be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18165specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18166it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18167up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18168.code
18169localusers:
18170 driver = accept
18171 domains = mydomain.example
18172 check_local_user
18173 transport = local_delivery
18174.endd
18175The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18176&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18177When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18178address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18179
18180
18181
18182
18183
18184
18185. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18186. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18187
18188.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18189.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18190.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18191The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18192recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18193unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18194
18195If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18196SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18197MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18198However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18199records.
18200
18201MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18202looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18203When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18204except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18205IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18206generic option, the router declines.
18207
18208Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18209to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18210are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18211
18212.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18213.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18214.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18215If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18216address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18217happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18218
18219
18220.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18221There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18222Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18223SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18224MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18225problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18226
18227For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18228&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18229&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18230an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18231domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18232such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18233proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18234look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18235case routing fails.
18236
18237
18238.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18239.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18240There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18241an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18242domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18243
18244.new
18245The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18246is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18247.wen
18248
18249Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18250.ilist
18251The domain does not exist in DNS
18252.next
18253The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18254convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18255for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18256.next
18257Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18258.next
18259MX record points to a non-existent host.
18260.next
18261MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18262&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18263.next
18264MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18265addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18266.next
18267The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18268&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18269.next
18270&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18271not be found in the MX records (see below)
18272.endlist
18273
18274
18275
18276
18277.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18278.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18279The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18280
18281.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18282.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18283If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18284(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18285process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18286differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18287the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18288
18289
18290.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18291.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18292The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18293addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18294enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18295required. For example,
18296.code
18297check_srv = smtp
18298.endd
18299looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18300expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18301to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18302submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18303option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18304normal way.
18305
18306When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18307the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18308host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18309this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18310SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18311according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18312
18313When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18314the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18315records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18316this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18317defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18318and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18319have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18320trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18321
18322See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18323when there is a DNS lookup error.
18324
18325
18326
18327
18328.new
18329.option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18330.cindex "MX record" "not found"
18331DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18332which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18333rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18334This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18335domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18336However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18337also being queued.
18338.wen
18339
18340
18341.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18342.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18343.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18344A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18345record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18346For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18347records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18348setting:
18349.code
18350mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18351.endd
18352This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18353has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18354the address record.
18355
18356
18357.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18358If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18359DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18360&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18361
18362
18363
18364
18365.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18366.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18367.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18368When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18369lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18370single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18371called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18372&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18373resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18374&'resolv.conf'&.
18375
18376
18377
18378.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18379.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18380.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18381If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18382qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18383an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18384expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18385occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18386&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18387any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18388header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18389
18390This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18391ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18392sense.
18393
18394When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18395servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18396making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18397some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18398name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18399header rewriting.
18400
18401
18402.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18403.cindex "address" "copying routing"
18404Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18405to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18406options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18407default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18408servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18409any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18410
18411If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18412domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18413local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18414lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18415routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18416message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18417without processing them independently,
18418provided the following conditions are met:
18419
18420.ilist
18421No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18422&%headers_remove%&.
18423.next
18424The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18425the domain.
18426.endlist
18427
18428
18429
18430
18431.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18432.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18433When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18434lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18435applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18436the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18437domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18438up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18439&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18440actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18441
18442Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18443record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18444local wildcard.
18445
18446
18447
18448.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18449If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18450DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18451&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18452
18453
18454
18455
18456.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18457.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18458If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18459added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18460if
18461.code
18462widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18463.endd
18464is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18465&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18466&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18467and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18468the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18469when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18470
18471
18472.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18473When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18474of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18475corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18476is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18477
18478These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18479for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18480such as that implied by
18481.code
18482domains = @mx_any
18483.endd
18484that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18485entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18486.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18487.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18488
18489
18490
18491
18492
18493
18494
18495
18496
18497. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18498. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18499
18500.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18501.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18502.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18503.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18504This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18505verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18506generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18507takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18508router handles the address
18509.code
18510root@[192.168.1.1]
18511.endd
18512by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18513consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18514are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18515.code
18516postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18517.endd
18518Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18519grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18520
18521.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18522If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18523declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18524&%self%& option determines what happens.
18525
18526The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18527controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18528also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18529Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18530
18531
18532
18533. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18534. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18535
18536.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18537.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18538.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18539The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18540Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18541not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18542must set
18543.code
18544ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18545.endd
18546in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18547
18548The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18549connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18550a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18551message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18552this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18553can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18554must not be specified for it.
18555
18556.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18557.option hosts iplookup string unset
18558This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18559names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18560(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18561and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18562happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18563
18564
18565.option optional iplookup boolean false
18566If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18567is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18568delivery to the address is deferred.
18569
18570
18571.option port iplookup integer 0
18572.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18573This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18574call.
18575
18576
18577.option protocol iplookup string udp
18578This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18579protocols is to be used.
18580
18581
18582.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18583This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18584default value is:
18585.code
18586$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18587.endd
18588The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18589query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18590
18591
18592.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18593If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18594returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18595string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18596in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18597&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18598whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18599up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18600
18601
18602.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18603This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18604returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18605router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18606response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18607check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18608address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18609the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18610following could be used:
18611.code
18612response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18613reroute = $local_part@$1
18614.endd
18615
18616.option timeout iplookup time 5s
18617This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18618machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18619call. It does not apply to UDP.
18620
18621
18622
18623
18624. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18625. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18626
18627.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18628.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18629.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18630.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18631The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18632routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18633route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18634normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18635route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18636messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18637
18638The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18639it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18640has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18641include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18642&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18643generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18644being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18645
18646.vindex "&$host$&"
18647In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18648router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18649an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18650transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18651with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18652passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18653host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18654text string.
18655
18656The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18657&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18658or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18659any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18660below, following the list of private options.
18661
18662
18663.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18664
18665.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18666The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18667
18668.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18669See &%host_find_failed%&.
18670
18671.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18672This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18673address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18674of the following values:
18675.code
18676decline
18677defer
18678fail
18679freeze
18680ignore
18681pass
18682.endd
18683The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18684error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18685forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18686&%pass_router%&),
18687.oindex "&%more%&"
18688overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18689router only if &%more%& is true.
18690
18691The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18692cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18693controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18694as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18695
18696The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18697state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18698generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18699
18700
18701.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18702.cindex "randomized host list"
18703.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18704If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18705is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18706overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18707crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18708same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18709(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18710deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18711
18712When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18713into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18714set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18715item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18716.code
18717route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18718.endd
18719The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18720randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18721If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18722randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18723&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18724
18725
18726.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18727If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18728Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18729example:
18730.code
18731route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18732.endd
18733If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18734router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18735deferred.
18736
18737
18738.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18739This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18740unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18741that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18742
18743
18744.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18745.cindex "address" "copying routing"
18746Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18747router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18748router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18749default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18750servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18751any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18752
18753If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18754domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18755local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18756lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18757&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18758addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18759same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18760if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18761
18762
18763
18764
18765.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18766The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18767rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18768entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18769described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18770Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18771.display
18772<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18773.endd
18774The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18775no options:
18776.code
18777route_list = \
18778 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18779 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18780.endd
18781The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18782list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18783usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18784single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18785pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18786&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18787except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18788That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18789lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18790in a &%route_list%&).
18791
18792The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18793matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18794then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18795&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18796
18797
18798
18799.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18800The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18801routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18802hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18803The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18804Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18805expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18806like this:
18807.code
18808dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18809thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18810.endd
18811This data can be accessed by setting
18812.code
18813route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18814.endd
18815Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18816decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18817requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18818possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18819be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18820
18821
18822
18823
18824.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18825A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18826always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18827declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18828and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18829in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18830as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18831
18832If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18833variables are set during its expansion:
18834
18835.ilist
18836.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18837If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18838&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18839.code
18840route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18841.endd
18842.next
18843&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18844.next
18845&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18846
18847.next
18848.vindex "&$value$&"
18849If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18850looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18851.code
18852route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18853.endd
18854.endlist
18855
18856Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18857semicolon is the default route list separator.
18858
18859
18860
18861.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18862Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18863optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18864is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18865specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18866by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18867
18868.ilist
18869Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18870the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18871be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18872.code
18873route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18874route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18875.endd
18876.next
18877When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18878colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18879enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18880number follows. For example:
18881.code
18882route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18883.endd
18884.endlist
18885
18886.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18887When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18888the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18889delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18890option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18891transport.
18892
18893Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18894hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18895interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18896records in the DNS. For example:
18897.code
18898route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18899.endd
18900If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18901example:
18902.code
18903route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18904.endd
18905If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18906randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18907that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18908be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18909Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18910happens is controlled by the
18911.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18912&%self%& option of the router.
18913
18914A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18915hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18916lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18917below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18918preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18919randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18920defined by MX preferences.
18921
18922If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18923not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18924preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18925
18926If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18927depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18928is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18929Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18930
18931If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18932most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18933router.
18934
18935DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18936failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18937&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18938
18939The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18940whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18941
18942
18943
18944.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18945The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18946present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18947&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18948other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18949per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18950routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18951
18952.ilist
18953&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18954setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18955.next
18956&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18957overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18958.next
18959&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18960find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18961also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18962.next
18963&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18964no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18965timeout), delivery is deferred.
18966.endlist
18967
18968For example:
18969.code
18970route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18971 domain2 host4:host5
18972.endd
18973If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18974DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18975result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18976or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18977call.
18978
18979&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18980called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18981instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18982lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18983function called.
18984
18985
18986
18987If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18988&%host_find_failed%& option.
18989
18990.vindex "&$host$&"
18991When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18992The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18993
18994
18995
18996.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18997In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18998transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18999
19000.ilist
19001.cindex "smart host" "example router"
19002The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19003&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19004named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19005.code
19006domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19007.endd
19008You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19009your first router something like this:
19010.code
19011smart_route:
19012 driver = manualroute
19013 domains = !+local_domains
19014 transport = remote_smtp
19015 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19016.endd
19017This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19018&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19019they are tried in order
19020(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19021Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19022.code
19023smart_route:
19024 driver = manualroute
19025 transport = remote_smtp
19026 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19027.endd
19028There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19029However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19030example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19031precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19032always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19033would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19034always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19035&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19036
19037.next
19038.cindex "mail hub example"
19039A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19040records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19041the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19042machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19043&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19044to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19045using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19046lookup is easier to manage.
19047
19048If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19049to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19050example:
19051.code
19052hub_route:
19053 driver = manualroute
19054 transport = remote_smtp
19055 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19056.endd
19057This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19058whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19059if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19060that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19061domain can be used to find the host:
19062.code
19063through_firewall:
19064 driver = manualroute
19065 transport = remote_smtp
19066 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19067.endd
19068The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19069hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19070data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19071next router.
19072
19073.next
19074.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19075.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19076You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19077SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19078storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19079can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19080.code
19081save_in_file:
19082 driver = manualroute
19083 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19084 route_list = saved.domain.example
19085.endd
19086though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19087several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19088different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19089.code
19090save_in_file:
19091 driver = manualroute
19092 route_list = \
19093 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19094 *.saved.domain2.example \
19095 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19096 batch_pipe
19097.endd
19098.vindex "&$domain$&"
19099.vindex "&$host$&"
19100The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19101doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19102file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19103the address if the lookup fails.
19104
19105.next
19106.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19107Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19108&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19109one way it can be done:
19110.code
19111# Transport
19112uucp:
19113 driver = pipe
19114 user = nobody
19115 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19116 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19117 return_fail_output = true
19118
19119# Router
19120uucphost:
19121 transport = uucp
19122 driver = manualroute
19123 route_data = \
19124 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19125.endd
19126The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19127.code
19128darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19129.endd
19130It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19131makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19132&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19133.endlist
19134.ecindex IIDmanrou1
19135.ecindex IIDmanrou2
19136
19137
19138
19139
19140
19141
19142
19143
19144. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19145. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19146
19147.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19148.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19149.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19150.cindex "routing" "by external program"
19151The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19152and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19153mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19154However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19155&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19156be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19157options:
19158.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19159
19160.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19161This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19162command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19163expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19164&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19165
19166
19167.option command_group queryprogram string unset
19168.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19169This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19170address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19171uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19172gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19173
19174
19175.option command_user queryprogram string unset
19176.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19177This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19178command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19179it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19180using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19181not set, a value for the gid also.
19182
19183&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19184root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19185However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19186usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19187is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19188the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19189gid.
19190
19191
19192.option current_directory queryprogram string /
19193This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19194before running the command.
19195
19196
19197.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19198If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19199is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19200timeout.
19201
19202
19203The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19204the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19205containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19206the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19207field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19208
19209.ilist
19210&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19211below).
19212.next
19213&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19214&%no_more%& is set.
19215.next
19216&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19217subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19218of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19219included in the SMTP response.
19220.next
19221&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19222subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19223included in any SMTP response.
19224.next
19225&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19226.next
19227&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19228&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19229.next
19230&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19231new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19232or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19233.endlist
19234
19235When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19236number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19237the page):
19238.code
19239ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19240LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19241.endd
19242The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19243is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19244used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19245an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19246
19247The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19248As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19249in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19250&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19251(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19252
19253If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19254find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19255anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19256goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19257result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19258
19259.vindex "&$address_data$&"
19260If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19261variable. For example, this return line
19262.code
19263accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19264.endd
19265routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19266the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19267.ecindex IIDquerou1
19268.ecindex IIDquerou2
19269
19270
19271
19272
19273. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19274. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19275
19276.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19277.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19278.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19279.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19280.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19281The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19282common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19283(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19284files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19285redirected in several different ways:
19286
19287.ilist
19288It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19289independently.
19290.next
19291It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19292.next
19293It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19294.next
19295It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19296.next
19297It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19298.next
19299It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19300.next
19301It can be discarded.
19302.endlist
19303
19304The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19305However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19306files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19307&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19308
19309.new
19310If success DSNs have been requested
19311.cindex "DSN" "success"
19312.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19313redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19314.wen
19315
19316
19317
19318.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19319The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19320expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19321contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19322options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19323aliases, in a configuration like this:
19324.code
19325system_aliases:
19326 driver = redirect
19327 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19328.endd
19329If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19330expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19331expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19332cause delivery to be deferred.
19333
19334A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19335&_.forward_& files, like this:
19336.code
19337userforward:
19338 driver = redirect
19339 check_local_user
19340 file = $home/.forward
19341 no_verify
19342.endd
19343If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19344empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19345is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19346yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19347comments.
19348
19349
19350
19351.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19352.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19353It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19354&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19355
19356.ilist
19357When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19358running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19359the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19360practice the router may not be able to operate.
19361.next
19362However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19363is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19364local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19365saves some resources.
19366.endlist
19367
19368
19369
19370
19371
19372
19373.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19374.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19375.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19376The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19377can be interpreted in two different ways:
19378
19379.ilist
19380If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19381&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19382&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19383respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19384in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19385document is intended for use by end users.
19386.next
19387Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19388described in the next section.
19389.endlist
19390
19391When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19392in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19393generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19394configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19395for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19396
19397
19398
19399.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19400.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19401When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19402comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19403addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19404&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19405disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19406depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19407commas or newlines.
19408If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19409quotes.
19410
19411Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19412also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19413next newline character is ignored.
19414
19415If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19416double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19417(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19418&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19419removed.
19420
19421.vindex "&$local_part$&"
19422&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19423and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19424of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19425special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19426&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19427setting:
19428.code
19429data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19430.endd
19431
19432
19433.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19434.cindex "routing" "loops in"
19435.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19436.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19437A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19438consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19439automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19440is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19441Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19442as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19443complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19444
19445.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19446Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19447filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19448mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19449&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19450.code
19451cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19452.endd
19453.cindex "backslash in alias file"
19454.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19455For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19456preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19457it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19458synonymously.
19459
19460If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
194612822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19462domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19463addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19464force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19465
19466Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19467Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19468contains:
19469.code
19470Sam.Reman: spqr
19471.endd
19472Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19473messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19474this forward file:
19475.code
19476Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19477.endd
19478With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19479&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19480second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19481and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19482should really contain
19483.code
19484spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19485.endd
19486but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19487below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19488&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19489
19490
19491
19492.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19493In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19494lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19495
19496.ilist
19497.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19498.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19499An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19500as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19501command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19502Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19503which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19504
19505Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19506the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19507the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19508in double quotes, for example:
19509.code
19510"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19511.endd
19512since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19513quote just the command. An item such as
19514.code
19515|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19516.endd
19517is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19518
19519Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19520of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19521redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19522quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19523string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19524are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19525data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19526transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19527an &%accept%& router.
19528
19529.next
19530.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19531.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19532An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19533parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19534.code
19535/home/world/minbari
19536.endd
19537is treated as a file name, but
19538.code
19539/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19540.endd
19541is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19542the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19543forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19544file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19545
19546Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19547which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19548
19549.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19550However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19551bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19552instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19553
19554.next
19555.cindex "included address list"
19556.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19557If an item is of the form
19558.code
19559:include:<path name>
19560.endd
19561a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19562point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19563out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19564by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19565item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19566the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19567.code
19568list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19569.endd
19570It must be given as
19571.code
19572list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19573.endd
19574.next
19575.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19576Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19577&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19578the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19579.cindex "black hole"
19580.cindex "abandoning mail"
19581&':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19582done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
19583&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19584
19585&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19586delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19587are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19588database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19589&_/dev/null_&.
19590
19591.next
19592.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19593.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19594.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19595.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19596.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19597An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19598redirection items of the form
19599.code
19600:defer:
19601:fail:
19602.endd
19603respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19604to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19605text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19606associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19607.code
19608X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19609.endd
19610In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19611of a
19612.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19613VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19614default.
19615.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19616The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19617the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19618
19619.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19620By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19621&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19622space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19623followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19624code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19625incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19626suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19627&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19628ignored.
19629
19630.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19631In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19632default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19633therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19634
19635Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19636not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19637normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19638as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19639lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19640
19641During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19642containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19643whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19644subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19645deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19646rules still apply.
19647
19648.next
19649.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19650Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19651chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19652for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19653&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19654router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19655results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19656.endlist
19657
19658
19659.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19660.cindex "duplicate addresses"
19661.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19662.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19663Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19664to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19665routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19666aliasing scheme of the type
19667.code
19668pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19669localpart1: pipe
19670localpart2: pipe
19671.endd
19672does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19673when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19674discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19675such as
19676.code
19677localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19678localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19679.endd
19680does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19681the pipes are distinct.
19682
19683
19684
19685.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19686.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19687.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19688When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19689leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19690afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19691delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19692members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19693can be used to avoid this.
19694
19695
19696.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19697.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19698If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19699error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19700for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19701detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19702deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19703
19704
19705
19706.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19707
19708.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19709The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19710
19711
19712.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19713Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19714data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19715
19716
19717.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19718.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19719If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19720and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19721
19722
19723.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19724.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19725.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19726Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19727&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19728are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19729lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19730
19731It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19732the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19733
19734
19735The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19736&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19737&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19738files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19739true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19740
19741
19742
19743.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19744.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19745Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19746This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19747default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19748let ordinary users do.
19749
19750
19751
19752.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19753This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19754as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19755Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19756configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19757for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19758
19759When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19760is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19761the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19762and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19763domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19764&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19765.code
19766\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19767.endd
19768Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19769&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19770originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19771(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19772&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19773&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19774file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19775original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19776
19777
19778.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19779When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19780when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19781&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19782&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19783deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19784is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19785&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19786
19787
19788
19789.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19790When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19791this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19792permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19793option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19794&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19795
19796
19797.option data redirect string&!! unset
19798This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19799set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19800list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19801expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19802has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19803
19804When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19805filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19806terminated with newline characters. For example:
19807.code
19808data = #Exim filter\n\
19809 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19810.endd
19811If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19812you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19813choice into a newline.
19814
19815
19816.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19817A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19818ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19819specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19820configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19821
19822
19823.option file redirect string&!! unset
19824This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19825is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19826use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19827failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19828must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19829data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19830entirely of comments), the router declines.
19831
19832.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19833If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19834runs a check on the containing directory,
19835unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19836If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19837happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19838is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19839not, the router declines.
19840
19841
19842.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19843.vindex "&$address_file$&"
19844A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19845ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19846specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19847configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19848it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19849
19850
19851.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19852When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19853relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19854relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19855relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19856
19857
19858.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19859If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19860redirection list.
19861
19862
19863.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19864If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19865&%allow_filter%& is true.
19866
19867
19868
19869
19870.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19871.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19872.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19873.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19874If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19875specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19876conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19877set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19878locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19879
19880
19881.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19882.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19883If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19884make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19885functions.
19886
19887.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19888.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19889If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19890make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19891
19892.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19893If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19894permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19895under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19896&_.forward_& files).
19897
19898
19899.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19900If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19901to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19902
19903
19904.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19905This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19906it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19907of the embedded Perl support.
19908
19909
19910.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19911If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19912to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19913
19914
19915.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19916If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19917to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19918
19919
19920.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19921If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19922message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19923files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19924&%one_time%& is set.
19925
19926
19927.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19928If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19929to make use of &%run%& items.
19930
19931
19932.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19933If this option is true, items of the form
19934.code
19935:include:<path name>
19936.endd
19937are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19938
19939
19940.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19941.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19942If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19943specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19944forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19945
19946
19947.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19948If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19949&%allow_filter%& is true.
19950
19951
19952.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19953.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19954If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19955of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19956the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19957
19958
19959
19960
19961.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19962.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19963If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19964generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19965generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19966bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19967bounce may well quote the generated address.
19968
19969
19970.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19971.cindex "EACCES"
19972If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19973EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19974file did not exist.
19975
19976
19977.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19978.cindex "ENOTDIR"
19979If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19980ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19981router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19982
19983Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19984router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19985(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19986against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19987is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19988is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19989a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19990that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19991
19992
19993
19994.option include_directory redirect string unset
19995If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19996redirection list must start with this directory.
19997
19998
19999.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20000This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20001&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20002
20003
20004.option one_time redirect boolean false
20005.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20006.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20007.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20008.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20009.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20010Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20011files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20012of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20013is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20014but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20015message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20016lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20017before they subscribed.
20018
20019If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20020deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20021&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20022&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20023attempt.
20024
20025&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20026router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20027reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20028permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20029
20030&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20031to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20032and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20033
20034&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20035&%one_time%&.
20036
20037The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20038addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20039addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20040&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20041typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20042expansion.
20043
20044
20045.option owners redirect "string list" unset
20046.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20047.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20048.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20049.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20050This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20051This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20052See &%check_owner%& above.
20053
20054
20055.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20056This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20057The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20058&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20059
20060
20061.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20062.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20063A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20064starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20065transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20066name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20067When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20068
20069
20070.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20071.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20072If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20073generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20074in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20075expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20076to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20077&$qualify_recipient$&.
20078
20079This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20080but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20081not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20082addresses.
20083
20084.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20085.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20086.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20087.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20088If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20089set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20090without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20091address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20092&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20093this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20094
20095
20096.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20097If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20098any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20099the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20100only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20101&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20102
20103
20104.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20105A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20106&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20107by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20108transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20109are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20110
20111
20112.option rewrite redirect boolean true
20113.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20114If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20115subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20116and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20117
20118
20119.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20120The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20121:subaddress part of an address.
20122
20123.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20124The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20125of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20126(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20127
20128
20129.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20130.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20131To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20132&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20133(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20134&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20135needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20136
20137
20138
20139.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20140.cindex "forward file" "broken"
20141.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20142.cindex "alias file" "broken"
20143.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20144.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20145.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20146.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20147If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20148non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20149&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20150giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20151are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20152&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20153be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20154&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20155
20156If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20157errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20158the following routers.
20159
20160If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20161error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20162taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20163so it is passed to the following routers.
20164
20165.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20166Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20167action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20168&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20169
20170&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20171lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20172option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20173notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20174.code
20175userforward:
20176 driver = redirect
20177 allow_filter
20178 check_local_user
20179 file = $home/.forward
20180 file_transport = address_file
20181 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20182 reply_transport = address_reply
20183 no_verify
20184 skip_syntax_errors
20185 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20186 syntax_errors_text = \
20187 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20188 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20189 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20190 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20191 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20192 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20193 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20194 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20195 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20196 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20197.endd
20198You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20199&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20200put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20201.code
20202real_localuser:
20203 driver = accept
20204 check_local_user
20205 local_part_prefix = real-
20206 transport = local_delivery
20207.endd
20208For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20209router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20210.code
20211 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20212 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20213.endd
20214
20215
20216.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20217See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20218
20219
20220.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20221See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20222.ecindex IIDredrou1
20223.ecindex IIDredrou2
20224
20225
20226
20227
20228
20229
20230. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20231. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20232
20233.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20234 "Environment for local transports"
20235.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20236.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20237.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20238Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20239transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20240in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20241mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20242
20243Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20244some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20245transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20246&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20247
20248The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20249different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20250settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20251or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20252configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20253
20254
20255
20256.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20257.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20258.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20259If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20260simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20261the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20262rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20263time.
20264
20265However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20266locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20267.code
20268my_transport:
20269 driver = pipe
20270 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20271.endd
20272This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20273messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20274&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20275file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20276
20277
20278
20279
20280.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20281.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20282.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20283All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20284overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20285set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20286delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20287group (set by the transport). For example:
20288.code
20289# Routers ...
20290# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20291local_users:
20292 driver = accept
20293 check_local_user
20294 transport = group_delivery
20295
20296# Transports ...
20297# This transport overrides the group
20298group_delivery:
20299 driver = appendfile
20300 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20301 group = mail
20302.endd
20303If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20304address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20305gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20306set.
20307
20308.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20309When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20310function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20311&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20312by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20313for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20314
20315.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20316The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20317is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20318receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20319original gid is also used.
20320
20321This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20322following that is set is used:
20323
20324.ilist
20325A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20326.next
20327A &%group%& setting of the router;
20328.next
20329A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20330&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20331.next
20332The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20333.next
20334In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20335the uid is the creator's uid;
20336.next
20337The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20338.endlist
20339
20340If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20341no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20342This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20343The first of the following that is set is used:
20344
20345.ilist
20346A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20347.next
20348In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20349.next
20350A &%user%& setting of the router;
20351.next
20352A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20353.next
20354The Exim uid.
20355.endlist
20356
20357Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20358&%never_users%& list.
20359
20360
20361
20362
20363
20364.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20365.cindex "current directory for local transport"
20366.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20367.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20368.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20369Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20370the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20371However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20372are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20373for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20374
20375.ilist
20376The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20377.next
20378The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20379.next
20380The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20381.next
20382The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20383.endlist
20384
20385The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20386
20387.ilist
20388The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20389.next
20390The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20391.endlist
20392
20393
20394If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20395value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20396directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20397
20398
20399
20400.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20401.vindex "&$domain$&"
20402.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20403.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20404Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20405variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20406deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20407at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20408other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20409never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20410and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20411.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20412.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20413.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20414
20415
20416
20417
20418
20419
20420
20421. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20422. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20423
20424.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20425.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20426.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20427.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20428The following generic options apply to all transports:
20429
20430
20431.option body_only transports boolean false
20432.cindex "transport" "body only"
20433.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20434.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20435If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20436mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20437or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20438&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20439automatically suppress them.
20440
20441
20442.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20443.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20444This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20445transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20446If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20447logged, and delivery is deferred.
20448
20449
20450.option disable_logging transports boolean false
20451If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20452deliveries by the transport or for any
20453transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20454what you are doing.
20455
20456
20457.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20458.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20459If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20460option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20461transport is run.
20462If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20463output, and Exim carries on processing.
20464This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20465so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20466option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20467variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20468one.
20469The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20470transport and the router that called it.
20471
20472.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20473.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20474If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20475This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20476header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20477requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20478safely be resent to other recipients.
20479
20480
20481.option driver transports string unset
20482This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20483There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20484
20485
20486.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20487.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20488If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20489This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20490delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20491configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20492address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20493header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20494its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20495resent to other recipients.
20496
20497
20498.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20499.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20500This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20501value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20502&%user%& (see below).
20503
20504
20505.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20506.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20507.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20508This option specifies a list of text headers,
20509.new
20510newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20511.wen
20512which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20513portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20514&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20515routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20516is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20517errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20518
20519Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20520for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20521
20522
20523.option headers_only transports boolean false
20524.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20525.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20526.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20527If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20528exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20529transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20530checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20531
20532
20533.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20534.cindex "header lines" "removing"
20535.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20536This option specifies a list of header names,
20537.new
20538colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20539.wen
20540these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20541in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20542routers.
20543Each list item is separately expanded.
20544If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20545is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20546errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20547
20548Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20549for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20550
20551&*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
20552items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
20553To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
20554
20555
20556
20557.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20558.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20559.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20560This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20561that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20562option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20563the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20564message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20565example,
20566.code
20567headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20568 x@y w@z
20569.endd
20570changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20571&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20572header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20573only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20574the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20575filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20576affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20577envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20578change envelope recipients at this time.
20579
20580
20581.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20582.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20583.vindex "&$home$&"
20584This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20585overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20586placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20587used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20588&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20589&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20590for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20591deferred.
20592
20593
20594.option initgroups transports boolean false
20595.cindex "additional groups"
20596.cindex "groups" "additional"
20597.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20598If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20599transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20600to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20601
20602
20603.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20604.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20605.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20606.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20607This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20608expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20609digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20610including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20611delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20612message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20613the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20614ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20615&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20616delivered.
20617
20618
20619
20620.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20621.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20622.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20623.cindex "local part" "prefix"
20624.cindex "local part" "suffix"
20625When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20626affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20627form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20628that contains
20629.code
20630local_part_prefix = *-
20631.endd
20632routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20633is delivered with
20634.code
20635RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20636.endd
20637This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20638recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20639whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20640deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20641&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20642
20643
20644.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20645.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20646When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20647in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20648is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20649deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20650part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20651temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20652deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20653
20654However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20655as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20656(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20657this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20658
20659For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20660the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20661on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20662
20663
20664.option return_path transports string&!! unset
20665.cindex "envelope sender"
20666.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20667.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20668If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20669the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20670that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20671designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20672SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20673only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20674header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20675
20676&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20677&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20678
20679.vindex "&$return_path$&"
20680The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20681either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20682&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20683replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20684option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20685section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20686
20687&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20688remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20689the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20690This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20691&%errors_to%& in a router.
20692
20693
20694
20695.option return_path_add transports boolean false
20696.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20697If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20698Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20699mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20700have easy access to it.
20701
20702RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20703the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20704header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20705option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20706incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20707recipients.
20708
20709
20710.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20711See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20712
20713
20714.option shadow_transport transports string unset
20715.cindex "shadow transport"
20716.cindex "transport" "shadow"
20717A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20718another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20719
20720Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20721&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20722string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20723passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20724expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20725cause a log line to be written.
20726
20727The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20728subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20729provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20730is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20731ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20732of the form
20733.code
20734ST=<shadow transport name>
20735.endd
20736If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20737parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20738purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20739provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20740headers that some sites insist on.
20741
20742
20743.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20744.cindex "transport" "filter"
20745.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20746This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20747at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20748individual users or via a system filter.
20749
20750When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20751&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20752the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20753input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20754command must be specified as an absolute path.
20755
20756The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20757terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20758SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20759lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20760settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20761&(pipe)& transports.
20762
20763The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20764standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20765destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20766filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20767are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20768
20769The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20770care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20771test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20772SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20773
20774.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20775A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20776at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20777message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20778a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20779not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20780
20781.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20782A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20783being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20784support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20785at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20786more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20787the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20788additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20789
20790.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20791The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20792the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20793parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20794Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20795section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20796to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20797of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20798an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20799&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20800
20801.vindex "&$host$&"
20802.vindex "&$host_address$&"
20803The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20804transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20805which the message is being sent. For example:
20806.code
20807transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20808 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20809.endd
20810
20811Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20812generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20813command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20814.ilist
20815If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20816part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20817expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20818example:
20819.code
20820transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20821.endd
20822This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20823&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20824stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20825the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20826&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20827Exim tried to expand the first one.
20828.next
20829Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20830expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20831arguments. Consider this example:
20832.code
20833transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20834 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20835.endd
20836The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20837if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20838.code
20839transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20840 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20841.endd
20842.endlist
20843
20844The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20845For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20846normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20847A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20848serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20849the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20850bounced from a transport filter.
20851
20852If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20853passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20854message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20855
20856
20857.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20858.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20859When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20860that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20861temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20862&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20863way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20864error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20865becomes a temporary error.
20866
20867
20868.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20869.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20870.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20871This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20872run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20873given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20874associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20875option is not set.
20876
20877For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20878specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20879&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20880
20881.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20882For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20883sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20884to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20885retry data.
20886.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20887.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20888.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20889
20890
20891
20892
20893
20894
20895. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20896. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20897
20898.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20899 "Address batching"
20900.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20901The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20902one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20903remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20904normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20905transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20906copy of the message is delivered each time.
20907
20908.cindex "batched local delivery"
20909.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20910.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20911In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20912local transport, for example:
20913
20914.ilist
20915In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20916delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20917recipients saves space.
20918.next
20919In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20920a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20921.next
20922In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20923to a scanner program or
20924to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20925acceptable.
20926.endlist
20927
20928These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20929(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20930repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20931
20932The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20933delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20934(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20935&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20936(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20937to certain conditions:
20938
20939.ilist
20940.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20941If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20942batching is possible.
20943.next
20944.vindex "&$domain$&"
20945If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20946addresses with the same domain are batched.
20947.next
20948.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20949If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20950addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20951customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20952including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20953from taking place.
20954.next
20955Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20956delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20957group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20958be the same.
20959.endlist
20960
20961In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20962both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20963is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20964course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20965option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20966&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20967&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20968.code
20969check_string = "."
20970escape_string = ".."
20971.endd
20972when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20973given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20974&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20975
20976.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20977If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20978&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20979that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20980transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20981addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20982
20983.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20984.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20985If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20986transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20987the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20988of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20989argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20990delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20991are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20992
20993
20994
20995
20996. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20997. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20998
20999.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21000.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21001.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21002.cindex "directory creation"
21003.cindex "creating directories"
21004The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21005file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21006files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21007format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21008University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21009being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21010to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21011delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21012supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21013directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21014
21015The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21016default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21017SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21018included.
21019
21020.cindex "quota" "system"
21021Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21022also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21023system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21024
21025If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21026partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21027modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21028creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21029
21030Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21031file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21032private options.
21033
21034The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21035users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21036putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21037&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21038option).
21039
21040
21041
21042.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21043The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21044the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21045the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21046normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21047
21048.vindex "&$address_file$&"
21049.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21050However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21051directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21052forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21053user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21054the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21055name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21056operation. There are two cases:
21057
21058.ilist
21059If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21060must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21061common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21062different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21063default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21064name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21065&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21066.next
21067If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21068used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21069contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21070.endlist
21071
21072
21073.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21074.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21075As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21076have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21077form:
21078.code
21079save folder23
21080.endd
21081or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21082.code
21083require "fileinto";
21084fileinto "folder23";
21085.endd
21086In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21087must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21088case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21089is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21090way of handling this requirement:
21091.code
21092file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21093 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21094 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21095 {$address_file} \
21096 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21097 }} \
21098 }
21099.endd
21100With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21101location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21102&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21103
21104&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21105&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21106the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21107you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21108&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21109path to the transport.
21110
21111&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21112the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21113
21114
21115
21116
21117.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21118.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21119
21120
21121
21122.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21123.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21124.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21125.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21126Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21127regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21128delivery is deferred.
21129
21130
21131.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21132.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21133.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21134By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21135that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21136are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21137what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21138are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21139
21140
21141.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21142See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21143However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21144happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21145file.
21146
21147
21148.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21149See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21150
21151
21152.option check_group appendfile boolean false
21153When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21154option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21155delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21156file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21157
21158
21159.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21160When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21161is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21162process is running.
21163
21164
21165.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21166.cindex "&""From""& line"
21167As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21168matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21169replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21170a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21171contains is significant.
21172
21173If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21174are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21175configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21176&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21177&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21178
21179The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21180suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21181&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21182if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21183.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21184.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21185.code
21186check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21187escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21188message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21189message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21190.endd
21191.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21192.cindex "directory creation"
21193When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21194directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21195is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21196
21197The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21198operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21199example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21200is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21201in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21202
21203
21204
21205.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21206This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21207by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21208directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21209delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21210beneath.
21211
21212The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21213&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21214set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21215given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21216names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21217by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21218&%file_must_exist%&.
21219
21220
21221.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21222This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21223or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21224redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21225
21226When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21227into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21228appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21229(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21230&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21231
21232
21233.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21234.cindex "base62"
21235.vindex "&$inode$&"
21236When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21237&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21238whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21239.code
21240q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21241.endd
21242This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21243inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21244option.
21245
21246
21247.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21248If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21249&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21250
21251
21252.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21253See &%check_string%& above.
21254
21255
21256.option file appendfile string&!! unset
21257This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21258&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21259of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21260specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21261&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21262&%file%&.
21263
21264.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21265.cindex "locking files"
21266.cindex "lock files"
21267If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21268mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21269
21270The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21271path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21272examples:
21273.code
21274file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21275file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21276file = $home/inbox
21277.endd
21278.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21279In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21280is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21281create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21282deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21283run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21284
21285
21286
21287.option file_format appendfile string unset
21288.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21289This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21290before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21291start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21292colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21293second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21294string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21295transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21296this added to it:
21297.code
21298file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21299 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21300.endd
21301Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21302a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21303to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21304to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21305is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21306match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21307delivery is deferred.
21308
21309
21310.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21311If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21312A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21313If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21314
21315
21316.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21317.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21318.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21319.cindex "locking files"
21320By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21321when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21322sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21323Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21324for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21325deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21326mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21327misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21328
21329On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21330not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21331is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21332and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21333
21334If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21335timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21336retries is
21337.code
21338(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21339.endd
21340rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21341which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21342&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21343
21344You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21345local deliveries because of errors of the form
21346.code
21347failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21348.endd
21349
21350.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21351This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21352&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21353&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21354
21355
21356.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21357This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21358for details of locking.
21359
21360
21361.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21362This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21363is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21364
21365
21366.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21367This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21368used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21369
21370
21371.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21372.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21373When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21374exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21375accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21376
21377
21378.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21379.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21380.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21381If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21382number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21383followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21384external source that maintains the data.
21385
21386
21387.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21388.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21389.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21390If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21391size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21392This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21393maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21394it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21395
21396
21397
21398.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21399.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21400If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21401file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21402transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21403&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21404&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21405directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21406SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21407&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21408
21409
21410.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21411.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21412.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21413This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21414a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21415directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21416calculation. The default value is:
21417.code
21418maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21419.endd
21420This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21421(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21422&_Trash_&
21423folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21424.code
21425maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21426.endd
21427This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21428directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21429calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21430directly into that directory.
21431
21432
21433.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21434This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21435&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21436
21437
21438.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21439This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21440section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21441
21442
21443.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21444.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21445The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21446If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21447creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21448quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21449value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21450&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21451
21452.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21453.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21454.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21455The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21456effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21457matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21458containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21459delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21460&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21461See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21462
21463
21464.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21465.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21466If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21467new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21468SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21469below for further details.
21470
21471
21472.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21473This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21474section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21475
21476
21477.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21478This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21479section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21480
21481
21482.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21483.cindex "locking files"
21484.cindex "file" "locking"
21485.cindex "file" "MBX format"
21486.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21487This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21488set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21489the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21490traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21491IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21492
21493&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21494automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21495empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21496combination:
21497.code
21498mbx_format = true
21499message_prefix =
21500message_suffix =
21501.endd
21502If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21503&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21504is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21505&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21506interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21507should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21508going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21509mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21510
21511If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21512the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21513(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21514append messages to it.
21515
21516
21517.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21518.cindex "&""From""& line"
21519The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21520The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21521in which case it is:
21522.code
21523message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21524 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21525.endd
21526&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21527&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21528
21529.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21530The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21531The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21532in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21533setting
21534.code
21535message_suffix =
21536.endd
21537&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21538&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21539
21540.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21541If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21542has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21543permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21544if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21545a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21546value, and this option is ignored.
21547
21548
21549.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21550This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21551mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21552true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21553continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21554
21555
21556.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21557If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21558successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21559on users about incoming mail.
21560
21561
21562.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21563.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21564This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21565or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21566is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21567all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21568individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21569&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21570have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21571
21572As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21573multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21574For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21575
21576A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21577may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21578If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21579become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21580Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21581the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21582
21583The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21584(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21585for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21586large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21587be handled.
21588
21589&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21590
21591The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21592the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21593be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21594fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21595system quota failures.
21596
21597By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21598mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21599last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21600during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21601refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21602message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21603changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21604for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21605continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21606delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21607
21608
21609.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21610This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21611into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21612called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21613delivery directory.
21614
21615
21616.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21617This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21618number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21619can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21620failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21621&"no quota"&.
21622
21623
21624.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21625See &%quota%& above.
21626
21627
21628.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21629This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21630for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21631these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21632If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21633captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21634file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21635
21636This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21637&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21638facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21639the file length to the file name. For example:
21640.code
21641maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21642quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21643.endd
21644An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21645number of lines in the message.
21646
21647The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21648file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21649sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21650
21651Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21652
21653
21654.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21655See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21656&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21657.code
21658quota_warn_message = "\
21659 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21660 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21661 This message is automatically created \
21662 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21663 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21664 a warning threshold that is\n\
21665 set by the system administrator.\n"
21666.endd
21667
21668
21669.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21670.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21671.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21672.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21673This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21674resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21675size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21676threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21677may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21678sign. For example:
21679.code
21680quota = 10M
21681quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21682.endd
21683If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21684percent sign is ignored.
21685
21686The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21687and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21688warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21689the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21690can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21691&'From:'& line, the default is:
21692.code
21693From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21694.endd
21695.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21696If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21697option.
21698
21699The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21700are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21701percentage.
21702
21703
21704.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21705.cindex "envelope sender"
21706If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21707format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21708you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21709so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21710for details of batch SMTP.
21711
21712
21713.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21714.cindex "carriage return"
21715.cindex "linefeed"
21716This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21717(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21718of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21719of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21720
21721&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21722(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21723in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21724carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21725have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21726changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21727
21728
21729.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21730This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21731exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21732&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21733that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21734&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21735
21736
21737.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21738This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21739the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21740&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21741each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21742
21743This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21744&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21745where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21746both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21747
21748.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21749Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21750have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21751&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21752the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21753error.
21754
21755&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21756is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21757
21758
21759.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21760If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21761appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21762&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21763sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21764&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21765delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21766
21767.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21768In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21769necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21770achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21771file corruption.
21772
21773The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21774It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21775except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21776
21777
21778.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21779This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21780set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21781locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21782of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21783are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21784the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21785rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21786does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21787
21788You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21789&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21790MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21791without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21792
21793
21794
21795
21796.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21797.cindex "appending to a file"
21798.cindex "file" "appending"
21799Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21800
21801.ilist
21802If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21803return is given.
21804
21805.next
21806.cindex "directory creation"
21807If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21808&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21809&%directory_mode%& option.
21810
21811.next
21812If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21813indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21814transport.
21815
21816.next
21817.cindex "file" "locking"
21818.cindex "locking files"
21819.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21820If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21821reliably over NFS, as follows:
21822
21823.olist
21824Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21825current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21826as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21827.next
21828Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21829.next
21830If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21831Unlink the hitching post name.
21832.next
21833Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21834then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21835of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21836restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21837.next
21838If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21839up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21840mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21841lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21842existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21843it before trying again.
21844.endlist olist
21845
21846.next
21847A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21848so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21849than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21850
21851.next
21852.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21853.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21854If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21855&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21856checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21857is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21858ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21859directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21860idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21861checked.
21862
21863.next
21864If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21865and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21866different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21867delivery is deferred.
21868
21869.next
21870If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21871If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21872is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21873permissions.
21874
21875.next
21876The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21877If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21878hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21879
21880.next
21881If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21882changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21883have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21884
21885.next
21886If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21887option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21888directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21889open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21890except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21891set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21892the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21893that prevents link following.
21894
21895.next
21896.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21897If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21898existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21899being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21900after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21901
21902.next
21903If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21904
21905.next
21906.cindex "file" "locking"
21907.cindex "locking files"
21908Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21909are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21910&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21911However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21912file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21913.code
21914/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21915.endd
21916using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21917the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21918the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21919
21920If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21921depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21922&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21923
21924If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21925&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21926to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21927delivery is deferred.
21928
21929If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21930&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21931waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21932immediately. It retries up to
21933.code
21934(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21935.endd
21936times (rounded up).
21937.endlist
21938
21939At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21940and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21941
21942
21943.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21944.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21945.cindex "&""From""& line"
21946When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21947delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21948activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21949&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21950router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21951configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21952ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21953
21954No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21955locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21956separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21957of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21958newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21959&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21960any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21961
21962If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21963the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21964different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21965deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21966
21967
21968.cindex "maildir format"
21969.cindex "mailstore format"
21970There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21971done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21972&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21973formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21974SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21975
21976.cindex "directory creation"
21977In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21978sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21979option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21980constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21981the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21982&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21983deferred.
21984
21985
21986
21987.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21988.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21989If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21990it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21991directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21992directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21993&_new_& subdirectory.
21994
21995In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21996<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21997Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21998before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21999file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22000opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22001Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22002
22003Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22004called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22005do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22006path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22007&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22008contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22009&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22010&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22011
22012These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22013and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22014folders. Consider this example:
22015.code
22016maildir_format = true
22017directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22018 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22019 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22020maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22021.endd
22022If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22023delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22024the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22025not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22026&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22027&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22028
22029However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22030delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22031does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22032&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22033directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22034
22035&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22036not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22037&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22038
22039.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22040.cindex "maildir++"
22041If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22042&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22043the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22044Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22045down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22046the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22047amount of space used.
22048
22049One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22050computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22051checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22052needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22053use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22054of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22055
22056
22057
22058
22059.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22060If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22061When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22062tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22063name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22064the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22065
22066
22067.vindex "&$message_size$&"
22068Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22069&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22070happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22071variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22072forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22073be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22074Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22075empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22076colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22077maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22078backwards compatibility).
22079
22080For one common implementation, you might set:
22081.code
22082maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22083.endd
22084but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22085
22086It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22087as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22088&[stat()]& each message file.
22089
22090
22091.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22092.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22093.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22094If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22095storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22096within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22097creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22098the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22099to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22100
22101The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22102messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22103in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22104value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22105is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22106need to know the quota.
22107
22108If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22109file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22110
22111A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22112maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22113See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22114details.
22115
22116
22117.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22118.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22119If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22120files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22121message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22122this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22123contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22124itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22125
22126During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22127&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22128&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22129mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22130file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22131the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22132
22133The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22134option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22135the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22136There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22137greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22138appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22139
22140If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22141failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22142configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22143&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22144
22145
22146.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22147If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22148file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22149messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22150section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22151.code
22152directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22153.endd
22154might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22155then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22156expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22157.ecindex IIDapptra1
22158.ecindex IIDapptra2
22159
22160
22161
22162
22163
22164
22165. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22166. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22167
22168.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22169.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22170.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22171The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22172the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22173automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22174&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22175to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22176
22177If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22178&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22179delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22180that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22181another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22182
22183
22184The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22185&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22186directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22187message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22188empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22189
22190The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22191by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22192passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22193transport is run as a consequence of a
22194&%mail%&
22195or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22196supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22197that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22198case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22199is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22200&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22201
22202&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22203command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22204gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22205&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22206
22207There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22208that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22209&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22210address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22211separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22212the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22213message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22214
22215Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22216message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22217immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22218the transport defers.
22219Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22220controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22221
22222If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22223&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22224of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22225&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22226
22227.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22228If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22229the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22230as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22231is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22232problems. They are just discarded.
22233
22234
22235
22236.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22237.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22238
22239.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22240This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22241message when the message is specified by the transport.
22242
22243
22244.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22245This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22246when the message is specified by the transport.
22247
22248
22249.option file autoreply string&!! unset
22250The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22251is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22252string comes first.
22253
22254
22255.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22256If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22257subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22258
22259
22260.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22261If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22262option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22263
22264
22265.option from autoreply string&!! unset
22266This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22267specified by the transport.
22268
22269
22270.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22271This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22272when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22273&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22274
22275
22276.option log autoreply string&!! unset
22277This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22278the message is specified by the transport.
22279
22280
22281.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22282If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22283used.
22284
22285
22286.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22287If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22288item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22289discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22290generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22291
22292
22293
22294.option once autoreply string&!! unset
22295This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22296recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22297This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22298
22299If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22300By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22301is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22302However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22303message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22304this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22305prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22306infinity.
22307
22308If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22309and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22310greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22311Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22312regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22313
22314In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22315which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22316be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22317means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22318unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22319file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22320
22321
22322.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22323See &%once%& above.
22324
22325
22326.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22327See &%once%& above.
22328After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22329
22330
22331.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22332This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22333specified by the transport.
22334
22335
22336.option return_message autoreply boolean false
22337If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22338message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22339configuration option.
22340
22341
22342.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22343This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22344specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22345automatic responses. For example:
22346.code
22347subject = Re: $h_subject:
22348.endd
22349There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22350subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22351bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22352non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22353small.
22354
22355
22356
22357.option text autoreply string&!! unset
22358This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22359message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22360the text comes first.
22361
22362
22363.option to autoreply string&!! unset
22364This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22365when the message is specified by the transport.
22366.ecindex IIDauttra1
22367.ecindex IIDauttra2
22368
22369
22370
22371
22372. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22373. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22374
22375.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22376.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22377.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22378.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22379.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22380The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22381specified command
22382or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22383This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22384transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22385implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22386to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22387has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22388.code
22389TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22390.endd
22391.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22392is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22393included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22394as follows:
22395
22396.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22397See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22398
22399
22400.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22401This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22402Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22403good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22404batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22405
22406
22407.option command lmtp string&!! unset
22408This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22409is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22410arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22411number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22412is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22413LMTP protocol.
22414
22415.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22416.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22417If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22418commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22419in its response to the LHLO command.
22420
22421.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22422This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22423be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22424delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22425
22426
22427.option timeout lmtp time 5m
22428The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22429respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22430is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22431LMTP transport:
22432.code
22433lmtp:
22434 driver = lmtp
22435 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22436 batch_max = 20
22437 user = exim
22438.endd
22439This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22440necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22441
22442
22443
22444. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22445. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22446
22447.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22448.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22449.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22450The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22451running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22452pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22453(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22454their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22455following ways:
22456
22457.ilist
22458.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22459A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22460transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22461contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22462is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22463.next
22464.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22465If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22466transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22467more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22468(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22469(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22470that are routed to the transport.
22471.next
22472.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22473A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22474alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22475pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22476&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22477(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22478this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22479.endlist
22480
22481
22482The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22483deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22484implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22485
22486In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22487&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22488other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22489transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22490directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22491details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22492for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22493
22494
22495.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22496If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22497delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22498any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22499write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22500
22501
22502
22503
22504.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22505.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22506If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22507have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22508the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22509in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22510later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22511logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22512&"local delivery failed"&.
22513
22514If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22515the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22516will be sent as normal.
22517
22518If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22519script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22520value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22521apply in this case.
22522
22523If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22524return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22525asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22526a non-existent command may be the problem.
22527
22528The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22529set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22530error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22531return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22532included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22533similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22534failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22535&%temp_errors%&.
22536
22537
22538
22539.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22540.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22541The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22542by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22543&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22544run.
22545
22546.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22547Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22548double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22549way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22550
22551String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22552traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22553expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22554For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22555quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22556.code
22557command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22558.endd
22559will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22560arguments. You have to write
22561.code
22562command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22563.endd
22564to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22565argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22566result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22567interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22568generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22569expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22570example:
22571.code
22572command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22573.endd
22574
22575.cindex "transport" "filter"
22576.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22577.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22578Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22579&`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22580place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22581transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22582inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22583avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22584&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22585
22586If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22587for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22588is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22589argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22590&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22591the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22592should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22593run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22594
22595After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22596in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22597message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22598standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22599read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22600may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22601control what is done with it.
22602
22603Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22604in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22605taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22606explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22607where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22608under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22609an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22610works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22611as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22612&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22613with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22614
22615
22616
22617.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22618.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22619.cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22620The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22621This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22622the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22623environment.
22624.display
22625&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22626&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22627&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22628&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22629&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22630&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22631&`LOGNAME `& see below
22632&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22633&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22634&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22635&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22636&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22637&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22638&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22639&`USER `& see below
22640.endd
22641When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22642router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22643called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22644the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22645removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22646LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22647same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22648
22649.cindex "HOST"
22650HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22651associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22652pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22653the router.
22654
22655.cindex "HOME"
22656If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22657for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22658by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22659user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22660
22661
22662.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22663.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22664
22665
22666
22667.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22668.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22669The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22670permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22671permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22672paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22673&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22674in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22675the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22676&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22677otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22678example, if
22679.code
22680allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22681.endd
22682and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22683&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22684&%use_shell%& is set.
22685
22686
22687.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22688See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22689
22690
22691.option batch_max pipe integer 1
22692This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22693See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22694
22695
22696.option check_string pipe string unset
22697As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22698&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22699by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22700&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22701any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22702of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22703the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22704ignored.
22705
22706
22707.option command pipe string&!! unset
22708This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22709obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22710set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22711the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22712Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22713&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22714
22715
22716.option environment pipe string&!! unset
22717.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22718.cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22719This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22720command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22721a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22722environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22723
22724
22725.option escape_string pipe string unset
22726See &%check_string%& above.
22727
22728
22729.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22730.cindex "exec failure"
22731.cindex "failure of exec"
22732.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22733Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22734any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22735is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22736frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22737
22738
22739.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22740.cindex "signal exit"
22741.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22742Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22743a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22744frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22745
22746
22747.option force_command pipe boolean false
22748.cindex "force command"
22749.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22750Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22751the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22752is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22753useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22754command. For example:
22755.code
22756command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22757force_command
22758.endd
22759
22760Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22761&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22762separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22763
22764.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22765If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22766run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22767Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22768from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22769&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22770
22771&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22772See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22773
22774.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22775.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22776If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22777one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22778and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
22779
22780
22781.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22782If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22783return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22784&%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22785written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22786Only one of them may be set.
22787
22788
22789
22790.option log_output pipe boolean false
22791If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22792output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22793&%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22794
22795
22796
22797.option max_output pipe integer 20K
22798This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22799standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22800process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22801catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22802the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22803&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22804exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22805
22806
22807.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22808The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22809The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22810.code
22811message_prefix = \
22812 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22813 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22814.endd
22815.cindex "Cyrus"
22816.cindex "&%tmail%&"
22817.cindex "&""From""& line"
22818This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22819However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22820or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22821setting
22822.code
22823message_prefix =
22824.endd
22825&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22826&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22827
22828
22829.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22830The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22831The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22832The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22833.code
22834message_suffix =
22835.endd
22836&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22837&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22838
22839
22840.option path pipe string "see below"
22841This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22842variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22843.code
22844/bin:/usr/bin
22845.endd
22846If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22847sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22848apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22849
22850
22851.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22852Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22853a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22854during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22855It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22856for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22857resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22858installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22859of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22860
22861
22862.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22863.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22864If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22865process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22866to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22867&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22868accept the message is used.
22869
22870
22871.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22872When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22873contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22874in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22875command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22876handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22877
22878
22879.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22880If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22881return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22882is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22883However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22884message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22885&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22886
22887
22888
22889.option return_output pipe boolean false
22890If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22891deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22892is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22893However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22894output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22895option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22896of them may be set.
22897
22898
22899
22900.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22901.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22902This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22903asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22904and &%return_output%& is not set,
22905and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22906temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22907numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22908codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22909defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22910compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22911and 73, respectively.
22912
22913
22914.option timeout pipe time 1h
22915If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22916causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22917specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22918command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22919and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22920if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22921
22922.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22923A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22924runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22925treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22926is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22927delivery to be deferred.
22928
22929.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22930This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22931
22932
22933.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22934.cindex "envelope sender"
22935If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22936SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22937commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22938you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22939&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22940
22941.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22942.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22943This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22944BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22945resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22946limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22947class database.
22948
22949
22950.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22951.cindex "carriage return"
22952.cindex "linefeed"
22953This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22954(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22955of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22956of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22957
22958The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22959written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22960are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22961&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22962values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22963
22964
22965.option use_shell pipe boolean false
22966.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22967If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22968instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22969&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22970where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22971modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22972&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22973command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22974its &%-c%& option.
22975
22976
22977
22978.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22979.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22980.cindex "&'procmail'&"
22981.cindex "external local delivery"
22982.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22983.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22984The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22985delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22986this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22987uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22988by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22989necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22990appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22991configuration for &%procmail%&:
22992.code
22993# transport
22994procmail_pipe:
22995 driver = pipe
22996 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22997 return_path_add
22998 delivery_date_add
22999 envelope_to_add
23000 check_string = "From "
23001 escape_string = ">From "
23002 umask = 077
23003 user = $local_part
23004 group = mail
23005
23006# router
23007procmail:
23008 driver = accept
23009 check_local_user
23010 transport = procmail_pipe
23011.endd
23012In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23013&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23014or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23015user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23016&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23017home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23018
23019&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23020.code
23021IFS=" "
23022.endd
23023as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23024use a shell to run pipe commands.
23025
23026.cindex "Cyrus"
23027The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23028deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23029.code
23030# transport
23031local_delivery_cyrus:
23032 driver = pipe
23033 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23034 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23035 user = cyrus
23036 group = mail
23037 return_output
23038 log_output
23039 message_prefix =
23040 message_suffix =
23041
23042# router
23043local_user_cyrus:
23044 driver = accept
23045 check_local_user
23046 local_part_suffix = .*
23047 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23048.endd
23049Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23050&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23051sender.
23052.ecindex IIDpiptra1
23053.ecindex IIDpiptra2
23054
23055
23056. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23057. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23058
23059.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23060.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23061.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23062The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23063or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23064that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23065explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23066&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23067
23068
23069.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23070The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23071two ways:
23072
23073.ilist
23074If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23075routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23076that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23077the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23078does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23079value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23080section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23081.next
23082.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23083When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23084looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23085connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23086for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23087process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23088process.
23089.endlist
23090
23091
23092For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23093incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23094no further messages are sent over that connection.
23095
23096
23097
23098.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23099.vindex "&$host$&"
23100.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23101At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23102&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23103passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23104specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23105&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23106that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23107&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23108
23109
23110.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23111.vindex &$tls_bits$&
23112.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23113.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23114.vindex &$tls_sni$&
23115At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23116&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23117are the values that were set when the message was received.
23118These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23119SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23120variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23121appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23122are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23123&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23124
23125These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23126and will be removed in a future release.
23127
23128
23129.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23130.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23131The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23132
23133
23134.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23135.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23136When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23137is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23138runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23139reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23140setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23141problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23142
23143.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23144.cindex "local host" "sending to"
23145.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23146When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23147to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23148deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23149the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23150configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23151configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23152
23153
23154.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23155.cindex "Cyrus"
23156When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23157is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23158overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23159forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23160to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23161ignored.
23162
23163The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23164started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23165&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23166particular connection.
23167
23168If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23169&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23170deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23171unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23172
23173This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23174deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23175&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23176.code
23177authenticated_sender = $local_part
23178.endd
23179This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23180allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23181
23182Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23183domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23184value.
23185
23186
23187.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23188If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23189is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23190authenticated as a client.
23191
23192
23193.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23194This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23195sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23196remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23197
23198
23199.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23200This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23201to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23202several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23203less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23204systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23205option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23206
23207
23208.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23209.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23210.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23211.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23212This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23213over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23214For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23215option.
23216
23217
23218.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23219This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23220the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23221of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23222
23223
23224.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23225This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23226domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23227cutoff times.
23228
23229In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23230them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23231Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23232retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23233a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23234unhappy at this prospect, so...
23235
23236If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23237addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23238IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23239none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23240delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23241addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23242continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23243&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23244to them.
23245
23246
23247.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23248If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23249and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23250the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23251in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23252
23253
23254.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23255If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23256&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23257See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23258details.
23259
23260
23261.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23262.cindex "MX record" "security"
23263.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23264.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23265.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23266DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23267the dnssec request bit set.
23268This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23269
23270
23271
23272.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23273.cindex "MX record" "security"
23274.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23275.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23276.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23277DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23278the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23279(AD bit) set wil be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23280This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23281
23282
23283
23284.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23285.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23286This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23287of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23288The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23289Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23290&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23291
23292The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23293(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23294that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23295equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23296Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23297
23298
23299.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23300.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23301String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23302colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23303port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23304&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23305item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23306in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23307
23308Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23309addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23310&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23311not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23312&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23313However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23314
23315If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23316the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23317transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23318address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23319list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23320
23321Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23322re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23323addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23324copy of the message is sent.
23325
23326The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23327&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23328both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23329from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23330fails"& facility.
23331
23332
23333.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23334This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23335line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23336zero.
23337
23338.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23339If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23340being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23341(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23342instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23343it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23344
23345.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23346This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23347server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23348implementations of TLS.
23349
23350.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23351.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23352.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23353.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23354The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23355been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23356command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23357option is:
23358.code
23359$primary_hostname
23360.endd
23361During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23362the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23363&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23364used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23365servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23366that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23367interface address, you could use this:
23368.code
23369helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23370 {$primary_hostname}}
23371.endd
23372The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23373callouts.
23374
23375.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23376Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23377finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23378&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23379email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23380all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23381
23382The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23383processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23384&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23385&%hosts_override%& is set.
23386
23387The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23388list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23389separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23390&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23391item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23392in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23393of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23394
23395If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23396the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23397well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23398address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23399&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23400&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23401that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23402address are used.
23403
23404During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23405unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23406
23407
23408.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23409.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23410.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23411.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23412.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23413This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23414example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23415matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23416start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23417facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23418
23419
23420.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23421.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23422Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23423that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23424
23425
23426.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23427.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23428Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23429matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23430
23431.new
23432.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23433.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23434Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23435or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23436to any host that matches this list.
23437.wen
23438
23439
23440.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23441.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23442.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23443.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23444.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23445This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23446delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23447&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23448
23449
23450.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23451This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23452tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23453why it exists.
23454
23455
23456
23457.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23458.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23459.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23460.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23461For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23462been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23463message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23464explanation of when this might be needed.
23465
23466
23467.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23468If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23469attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23470&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23471&%fallback_hosts%&.
23472
23473
23474.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23475.cindex "randomized host list"
23476.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23477.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23478If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23479&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23480were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23481router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23482is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23483list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23484
23485When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23486order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23487behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23488&`+`& in the host list. For example:
23489.code
23490hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23491.endd
23492The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23493randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23494If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23495
23496.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23497.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23498This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23499before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23500servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23501authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23502temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23503hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23504&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23505
23506
23507.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23508.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23509Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23510TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23511&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23512
23513.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23514.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23515Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23516TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23517&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23518
23519.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23520.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23521Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23522matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23523&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23524incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23525
23526.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23527.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23528This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23529authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23530connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23531unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23532&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23533
23534.new
23535.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23536.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23537This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23538PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23539for multi-recipient messages.
23540The option can usually be left as default.
23541.wen
23542
23543.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23544.cindex "bind IP address"
23545.cindex "IP address" "binding"
23546.vindex "&$host$&"
23547.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23548This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23549call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23550&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23551message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23552&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23553outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23554interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23555unknown.
23556
23557During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23558&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23559during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23560string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23561string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23562separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23563.code
23564interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23565.endd
23566The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23567connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23568&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23569interface to use if the host has more than one.
23570
23571
23572.option keepalive smtp boolean true
23573.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23574This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23575connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23576periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23577of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23578or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23579that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23580that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23581TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23582unreachable hosts.
23583
23584
23585.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23586.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23587If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23588string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23589has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23590
23591.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23592.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23593This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23594SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23595so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23596permits this.
23597
23598
23599.option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23600.vindex "&$domain$&"
23601When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23602addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23603to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23604handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23605&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23606is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23607
23608.new
23609It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23610&$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23611&$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23612.wen
23613
23614.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23615.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23616.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23617This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23618&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23619received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23620The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23621variable that contains an outgoing port.
23622
23623If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23624otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23625normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23626&"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23627is deferred.
23628
23629
23630
23631.option protocol smtp string smtp
23632.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23633.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23634.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23635.vindex "&$port$&"
23636If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23637the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23638protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23639deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23640over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23641
23642If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
23643changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23644connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23645The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23646
23647
23648.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23649Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23650constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23651means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23652tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23653addresses is not affected.
23654
23655However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23656each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23657the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23658Exim to use only the host name.
23659.new
23660Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23661.wen
23662
23663
23664.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23665.cindex "serializing connections"
23666.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23667Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23668host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23669the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23670slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23671Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23672&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23673
23674.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23675Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23676written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23677is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23678records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23679guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23680
23681If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23682relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23683start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23684may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23685are used for ETRN serialization.
23686
23687
23688.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23689.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23690.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23691.cindex "size" "of message"
23692.cindex "transport" "filter"
23693.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23694If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23695MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23696an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23697sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23698configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23699this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23700
23701Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23702the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23703
23704
23705.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23706.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23707.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23708.vindex "&$host$&"
23709.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23710The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23711client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23712connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23713address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23714details of TLS.
23715
23716&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23717certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23718name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23719assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23720client.
23721
23722
23723.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23724.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23725.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23726This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23727be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23728
23729
23730.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23731.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23732When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23733key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23734for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23735If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23736will fail.
23737
23738Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23739
23740
23741.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23742.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23743.vindex "&$host$&"
23744.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23745The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23746client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23747connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23748&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23749expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23750result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23751the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23752
23753
23754.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23755.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23756.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23757.vindex "&$host$&"
23758.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23759The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23760when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23761the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23762&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23763expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23764is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23765&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23766ciphers is a preference order.
23767
23768
23769
23770.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23771.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23772.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23773If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23774TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23775the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23776certificate and private key for the session.
23777
23778See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23779
23780Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23781TLS extensions.
23782
23783
23784
23785
23786.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23787.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23788When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23789setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23790to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23791current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23792option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23793response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23794TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23795unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23796in clear.
23797
23798
23799.new
23800.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
23801.wen
23802.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23803.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23804This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23805certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23806The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23807Note that unless the host is in this list
23808TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23809when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23810The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23811certificate verification succeeds.
23812
23813
23814.new
23815.option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
23816.cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
23817.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23818This option give a list of hosts for which,
23819while verifying the server certificate,
23820checks will be included on the host name
23821(note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
23822versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
23823limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
23824
23825There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
23826.wen
23827
23828
23829.new
23830.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
23831.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23832.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23833.vindex "&$host$&"
23834.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23835The value of this option must be either the
23836word "system"
23837or the absolute path to
23838a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
23839for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23840
23841The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
23842This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
23843is taken as empty and an explicit location
23844must be specified.
23845
23846The use of a directory for the option value is not avilable for GnuTLS versions
23847preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
23848.wen
23849
23850With OpenSSL the certificates specified
23851explicitly
23852either by file or directory
23853are added to those given by the system default location.
23854
23855The values of &$host$& and
23856&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23857expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23858
23859For back-compatability,
23860if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23861(a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
23862and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23863
23864
23865.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23866.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23867.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23868This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23869certificate verification must succeed.
23870The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23871If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23872operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23873
23874
23875
23876
23877.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23878 "SECTvalhosmax"
23879.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23880.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23881There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23882tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23883&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23884
23885
23886The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23887for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23888option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23889multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23890retrying.
23891
23892Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23893multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23894created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23895
23896Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23897several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23898problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23899&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23900delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23901
23902Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23903arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23904limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23905some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23906&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23907that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23908see below for an exception).
23909
23910Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23911list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23912If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23913but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23914that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23915
23916Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23917higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23918hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23919which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23920tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23921reached their retry times.
23922
23923However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23924large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23925Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23926of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23927time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23928without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23929all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23930there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23931the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23932every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23933reached.
23934
23935The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23936particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23937out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23938reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23939been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23940take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23941
23942The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23943Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23944and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23945possible IP addresses have been tried.
23946.ecindex IIDsmttra1
23947.ecindex IIDsmttra2
23948
23949
23950
23951
23952
23953. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23954. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23955
23956.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23957.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23958There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23959addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23960(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23961abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23962
23963Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23964messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23965&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23966appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23967locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23968unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23969lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23970
23971One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23972when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23973such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23974do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23975
23976
23977.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23978This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23979main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23980&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23981
23982Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23983Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23984facility; you do not have to use it.
23985
23986The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23987configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23988addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23989address to which it applies.
23990
23991Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23992the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23993rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23994those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23995by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23996are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23997rules.
23998
23999Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24000applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24001well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24002headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24003
24004
24005In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24006legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24007in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24008used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24009Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24010discouraged.
24011
24012There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24013illustrated by these examples:
24014
24015.ilist
24016The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24017exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24018gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24019&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24020.next
24021A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24022&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24023.endlist
24024
24025
24026
24027.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24028.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24029.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24030Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24031message's processing.
24032
24033.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24034At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24035by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24036ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24037is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24038rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24039rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24040RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24041rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24042
24043.vindex "&$domain$&"
24044.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24045Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24046may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24047rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24048from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24049for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24050value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24051as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24052SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24053
24054As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24055recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24056the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24057any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24058.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24059before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24060
24061When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24062rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24063redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24064
24065.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24066.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24067.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24068At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24069specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24070This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24071section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24072header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24073applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24074
24075The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24076transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24077transport time.
24078
24079
24080
24081
24082.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24083.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24084.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24085Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24086configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24087&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
240882822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24089transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24090appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24091envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24092.code
24093exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24094.endd
24095might produce the output
24096.code
24097sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24098from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24099to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24100cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24101bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24102reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24103env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24104env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24105.endd
24106which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24107the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24108present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24109set for a particular transport.
24110
24111
24112.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24113.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24114The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24115rules in the form
24116.display
24117<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24118.endd
24119Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24120transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24121takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24122any colons must be doubled, of course).
24123
24124The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24125Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24126case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24127characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24128ignored.
24129
24130For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24131order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24132replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24133
24134The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24135releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24136received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24137lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24138address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24139(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24140that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24141
24142.vindex "&$domain$&"
24143.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24144The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24145string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24146rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24147.code
24148*@* ${lookup ...
24149.endd
24150where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24151refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24152
24153
24154.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24155.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24156.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24157The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24158address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24159single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24160against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24161you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24162facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24163
24164Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24165case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24166can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24167
24168.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24169After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24170depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24171replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24172refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24173numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24174of pattern they are set as follows:
24175
24176.ilist
24177If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24178refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24179the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24180pattern
24181.code
24182*queen@*.fict.example
24183.endd
24184is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24185.code
24186$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24187$1 = hearts-
24188$2 = wonderland
24189.endd
24190Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24191does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24192
24193.next
24194If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24195of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24196for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24197rewriting rule of the form
24198.display
24199&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24200.endd
24201and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24202.code
24203$1 = foo
24204$2 = bar
24205$3 = baz.example
24206.endd
24207If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24208wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24209&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24210partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24211whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24212.endlist
24213
24214
24215.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24216.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24217If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24218match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24219rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24220.code
24221hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24222.endd
24223specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24224&'From:'& headers.
24225
24226.vindex "&$domain$&"
24227.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24228If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24229yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24230&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24231Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24232cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24233matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24234the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24235current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24236expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24237entry written to the panic log.
24238
24239
24240
24241.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24242There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24243
24244.ilist
24245Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24246c, f, h, r, s, t.
24247.next
24248A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24249.next
24250Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24251.endlist
24252
24253For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24254E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24255
24256
24257
24258.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24259 "SECID154"
24260.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24261If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24262&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24263and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24264transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24265rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24266.display
24267&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24268&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24269&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24270&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24271&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24272&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24273&`h`& rewrite all headers
24274&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24275&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24276&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24277.endd
24278"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24279individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24280other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24281
24282You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24283restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24284
24285
24286.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24287.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24288.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24289.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24290The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24291SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24292before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24293required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24294data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24295
24296.vindex "&$domain$&"
24297.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24298This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24299compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24300input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24301the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24302expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24303original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24304
24305
24306.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24307There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24308take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24309correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24310
24311.ilist
24312If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24313unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24314absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24315.next
24316If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24317even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24318expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24319(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24320.next
24321The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24322address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24323rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24324.next
24325.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24326When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24327to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24328left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24329.code
24330From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24331.endd
24332into
24333.code
24334From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24335.endd
24336.cindex "RFC 2047"
24337Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24338done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24339causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24340replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
243412822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24342brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24343(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24344is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
24345
24346When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24347rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24348.endlist
24349
24350
24351.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24352Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24353.code
24354*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24355*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24356 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24357.endd
24358Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24359the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24360has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24361consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24362present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24363explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24364at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24365error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24366
24367The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24368domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24369.code
24370root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24371.endd
24372were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24373local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24374
24375Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24376&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24377messages that originate outside the local host:
24378.code
24379*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24380 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24381.endd
24382The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24383space.
24384
24385.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24386.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24387Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24388an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24389the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24390remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24391sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24392components. For example, the rule
24393.code
24394\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24395.endd
24396rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24397&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24398a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24399method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24400to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24401use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24402can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24403.ecindex IIDaddrew
24404
24405
24406
24407
24408
24409. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24410. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24411
24412.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24413.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24414.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24415The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24416retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24417be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24418empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24419errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24420general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24421line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24422address, domain and error.
24423
24424The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24425host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24426Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24427address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24428been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24429tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24430log selector is set, the message
24431.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24432&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24433skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24434the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24435
24436Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24437in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24438actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24439failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24440the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24441added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24442same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24443domain are maintained independently.
24444
24445When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24446receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24447always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24448behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24449quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24450suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24451subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24452the local address is reached.
24453
24454.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24455If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24456whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24457files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24458always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24459
24460The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24461rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24462record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24463timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24464and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24465messages that it should now be retaining.
24466
24467
24468
24469.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24470.cindex "retry" "rules"
24471Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24472separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24473addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24474enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24475in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24476present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24477message's sender, respectively.
24478
24479
24480The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24481&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24482which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24483has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24484list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24485which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24486example,
24487.code
24488lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24489.endd
24490provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24491whereas
24492.code
24493alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24494.endd
24495applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24496In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24497part.
24498
24499.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24500&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24501must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24502expressions work in address lists.
24503.display
24504&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24505&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24506.endd
24507
24508
24509.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24510When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24511example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24512against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24513router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24514regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24515A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24516&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24517&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24518
24519Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24520failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24521configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24522&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24523local transports).
24524
24525.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24526However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24527suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24528whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24529rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24530failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24531recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24532reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24533&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24534lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24535commands.
24536
24537
24538
24539.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24540 "SECID160"
24541For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24542example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24543twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24544&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24545the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24546suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24547.code
24548a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24549 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24550 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24551.endd
24552and the retry rules are
24553.code
24554p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24555a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24556.endd
24557and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24558first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24559rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24560to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24561tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24562first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24563
24564In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24565first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24566&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24567routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24568
24569&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24570However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24571host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24572.code
24573route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24574.endd
24575then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24576textual form of the IP address.
24577
24578.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24579.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24580The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24581asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24582
24583.vlist
24584.vitem &%auth_failed%&
24585Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24586&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24587
24588.vitem &%data_4xx%&
24589A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24590after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24591
24592.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24593A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24594
24595.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24596A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24597.endlist
24598
24599For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24600as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24601recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24602and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24603retry rule of this form:
24604.code
24605the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24606.endd
24607These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24608LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24609
24610.vlist
24611.vitem &%lost_connection%&
24612A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24613legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24614for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24615
24616.new
24617.vitem &%lookup%&
24618A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24619Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24620its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24621Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24622its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24623.wen
24624
24625.vitem &%refused_MX%&
24626A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24627
24628.vitem &%refused_A%&
24629A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24630
24631.vitem &%refused%&
24632A connection was refused.
24633
24634.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24635A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24636
24637.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24638A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24639
24640.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24641A connection attempt timed out.
24642
24643.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24644There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24645obtained from an MX record.
24646
24647.vitem &%timeout_A%&
24648There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24649obtained from an MX record.
24650
24651.vitem &%timeout%&
24652There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24653
24654.vitem &%tls_required%&
24655The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24656&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24657to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24658
24659.vitem &%quota%&
24660A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24661transport.
24662
24663.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24664.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24665.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24666A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24667transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24668&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24669for four days.
24670.endlist
24671
24672.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24673The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24674timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24675it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24676However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24677heuristic rules:
24678
24679.ilist
24680If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24681used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24682quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24683.next
24684.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24685For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24686subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24687the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24688change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24689MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24690time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24691.next
24692For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24693obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24694.endlist
24695
24696The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24697mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24698when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24699error).
24700
24701
24702
24703.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24704.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24705You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24706specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24707apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24708form:
24709.display
24710&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24711.endd
24712The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24713.code
24714* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24715.endd
24716matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24717host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24718For example:
24719.code
24720a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24721.endd
24722&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24723(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24724only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24725its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24726all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24727
24728When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24729&%-f%& command line option, like this:
24730.code
24731exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24732.endd
24733If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24734list is never matched.
24735
24736
24737
24738
24739
24740.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24741.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24742The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24743sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24744.display
24745<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24746.endd
24747The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24748time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24749arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24750time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24751relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24752
24753.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24754.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24755.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24756.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24757The available algorithms are:
24758
24759.ilist
24760&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24761the interval.
24762.next
24763&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24764specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24765is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24766.next
24767&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24768retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24769maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24770the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24771rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24772members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24773queue processing times.
24774.endlist
24775
24776When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24777order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24778used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24779case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24780current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24781computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24782interval is found. The main configuration variable
24783.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24784.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24785.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24786&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24787cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24788
24789A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24790host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24791basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24792for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24793generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24794time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24795time.
24796
24797.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24798Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24799run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24800starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24801new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24802If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24803occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24804messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24805processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24806your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24807number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24808sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24809
24810The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24811&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24812&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24813&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24814are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24815deliveries that have been deferred.
24816
24817
24818.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24819Here are some example retry rules:
24820.code
24821alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24822wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24823wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24824lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24825* refused_A F,2h,20m;
24826* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24827.endd
24828The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24829&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24830mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24831hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24832parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24833effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24834fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24835days.
24836
24837The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24838happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24839intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24840first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24841so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24842
24843The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24844They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24845all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24846were not obtained from an MX record.
24847
24848The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24849first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24850not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24851hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
248521.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24853
24854
24855
24856.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24857.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24858.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24859.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24860.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24861Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24862consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24863set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24864been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24865arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24866failing for the first time.
24867
24868This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24869backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24870Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24871down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24872
24873If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24874every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24875message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24876
24877
24878
24879
24880.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24881.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24882.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24883Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24884that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24885default retry rule:
24886.code
24887* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24888.endd
24889the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24890long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24891failure for the recipient address that counts.
24892
24893When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24894addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24895causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24896In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24897time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24898
24899For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24900messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24901post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24902
24903If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24904.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24905&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24906default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24907reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24908attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24909those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24910the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24911
24912In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24913for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24914times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24915behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24916to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24917notice.
24918
24919If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24920addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24921addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24922no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24923words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24924addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24925If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24926&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24927deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24928true.
24929
24930.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24931.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24932Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24933intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24934its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24935because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24936host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24937failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24938reached.
24939
24940Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24941applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24942Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24943examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24944commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24945time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24946is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24947time out the address.
24948
24949The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24950the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24951given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24952time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24953not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24954considered immediately.
24955.ecindex IIDretconf1
24956.ecindex IIDregconf2
24957
24958
24959
24960
24961
24962
24963. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24964. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24965
24966.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24967.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24968.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24969The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24970with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24971described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24972to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24973permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24974transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24975other.
24976
24977.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24978Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24979
24980.ilist
24981The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24982the client's EHLO command.
24983.next
24984The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24985may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24986.next
24987The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24988appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24989just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24990any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24991with the AUTH command.
24992.next
24993The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24994.next
24995If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24996option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24997mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24998connection.
24999.next
25000If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25001authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25002unauthenticated connection.
25003.endlist
25004
25005If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25006mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25007SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25008includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25009.display
25010&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25011&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25012&`Connected to server.example.`&
25013&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25014&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25015&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25016&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25017&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25018&`250-PIPELINING`&
25019&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25020&`250 HELP`&
25021.endd
25022The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25023authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25024mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25025routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25026controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25027included by setting
25028.code
25029AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25030AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25031AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25032AUTH_GSASL=yes
25033AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25034AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25035AUTH_SPA=yes
25036AUTH_TLS=yes
25037.endd
25038in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25039authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25040the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25041The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25042work via a socket interface.
25043The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25044provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25045The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25046supporting setting a server keytab.
25047The sixth can be configured to support
25048the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25049not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25050supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25051.new
25052The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25053instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25054.wen
25055
25056The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25057section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25058authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25059authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25060is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25061messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25062options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25063
25064To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25065&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25066either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25067functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25068to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25069both sets of options, is required. For example:
25070.code
25071cram:
25072 driver = cram_md5
25073 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25074 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25075 client_name = ph10
25076 client_secret = secret2
25077.endd
25078The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25079&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25080
25081Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25082The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25083authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25084in Exim.
25085
25086&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25087per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25088account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25089authenticating data.
25090
25091Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25092&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25093and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25094Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25095used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25096second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25097user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25098configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25099&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25100as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25101choose to honour.
25102
25103A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25104to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25105mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25106typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25107
25108
25109
25110.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25111.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25112.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25113
25114.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25115When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25116&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25117used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25118encrypted by a setting such as:
25119.code
25120client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25121.endd
25122
25123
25124.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25125When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25126result is used in the log lines for outbound messasges.
25127Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25128
25129
25130.option driver authenticators string unset
25131This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25132authenticators is to be used.
25133
25134
25135.option public_name authenticators string unset
25136This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25137implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25138contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25139but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25140defaults to the driver's instance name.
25141
25142
25143.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25144When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25145is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25146mechanism is not advertised.
25147If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25148forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25149See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25150
25151
25152.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25153This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25154is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25155for details.
25156
25157For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25158mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25159
25160For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25161authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25162authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25163authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25164to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25165error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25166string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25167expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25168other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25169the error text.
25170
25171
25172.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25173If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25174command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25175output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25176out the values of variables.
25177If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25178output, and Exim carries on processing.
25179
25180
25181.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25182.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25183When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25184expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25185messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25186lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25187configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25188refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25189If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25190
25191
25192.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25193This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25194as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25195driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25196as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25197remembered for later use.
25198How it is used is described in the following section.
25199
25200
25201
25202
25203
25204.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25205.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25206.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25207When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25208the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25209message:
25210
25211.ilist
25212If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25213than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25214.next
25215If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25216.next
25217.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25218If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25219running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25220from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25221&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25222return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25223given for the MAIL command.
25224.next
25225If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25226is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25227authenticated.
25228.next
25229If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25230the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25231&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25232valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25233fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25234&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25235the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25236message.
25237.endlist
25238
25239
25240When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25241hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25242&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25243process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25244
25245.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25246Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25247MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25248therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25249value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25250ACL is run.
25251
25252
25253
25254.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25255.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25256When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25257authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25258conditions:
25259
25260.ilist
25261The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25262.next
25263It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25264yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25265.endlist
25266
25267The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25268the mechanisms are advertised.
25269
25270Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25271provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25272even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25273set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25274You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25275For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25276that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25277.code
25278auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25279.endd
25280so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25281
25282The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25283authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25284advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25285such as:
25286.code
25287server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25288.endd
25289.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25290If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25291yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25292
25293When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25294immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25295command. This is the case if
25296
25297.ilist
25298The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25299.next
25300No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25301.next
25302Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25303server authenticators.
25304.endlist
25305
25306
25307Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25308to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25309AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25310
25311If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25312server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25313that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25314the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25315fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25316rejected with a 504 error.
25317
25318.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25319.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25320When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25321&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25322or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25323public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25324client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25325no successful authentication.
25326
25327
25328
25329
25330.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25331.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25332.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25333.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25334Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25335configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25336encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25337script:
25338.code
25339use MIME::Base64;
25340printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25341.endd
25342.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25343This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25344interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25345some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25346command line to run this script on such data might be
25347.code
25348encode '\0user\0password'
25349.endd
25350Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25351backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25352whose code value is zero.
25353
25354&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25355digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25356you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25357interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25358
25359&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25360specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25361example, a command such as
25362.code
25363encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25364.endd
25365gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25366
25367If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25368base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25369.code
25370echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25371.endd
25372The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25373in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25374output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25375should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25376
25377
25378
25379.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25380.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25381The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25382&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25383announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25384of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25385
25386.ilist
25387For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25388they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25389mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25390of the authenticator.
25391.next
25392.vindex "&$host$&"
25393.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25394When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25395variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25396that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25397any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25398Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25399delivery to be deferred.
25400.next
25401If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25402Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25403try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25404usual way.
25405.next
25406If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25407carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25408possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25409no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25410what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25411&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25412delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25413turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25414deliver the message unauthenticated.
25415.endlist
25416
25417.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25418When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25419parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25420the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25421is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25422incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25423allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25424to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25425&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25426&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25427the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25428.ecindex IIDauthconf1
25429.ecindex IIDauthconf2
25430
25431
25432
25433
25434
25435
25436. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25437. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25438
25439.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25440.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25441.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25442The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25443LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25444plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25445security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25446(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25447use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25448connections as you do for login accounts.
25449
25450.section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25451.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25452When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25453
25454.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25455This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25456configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25457
25458.option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25459The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25460prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25461given.
25462
25463.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25464.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25465.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25466.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25467 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25468.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25469.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25470
25471When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25472expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25473response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25474values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25475a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25476are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25477(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25478
25479For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25480the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25481variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25482string expansions that also use them for other things.
25483
25484If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25485supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25486data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25487
25488.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25489Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25490&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25491authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25492to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25493&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25494expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25495generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25496For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25497string as the error text
25498
25499&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25500password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25501There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25502
25503
25504
25505.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25506.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25507.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25508.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25509The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25510sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25511separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25512subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25513
25514The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25515Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25516configured as follows:
25517.code
25518fixed_plain:
25519 driver = plaintext
25520 public_name = PLAIN
25521 server_prompts = :
25522 server_condition = \
25523 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25524 server_set_id = $auth2
25525.endd
25526Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25527are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25528password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25529or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25530
25531The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25532the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25533AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25534authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25535.code
25536250-AUTH PLAIN
25537.endd
25538and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25539.code
25540AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25541.endd
25542As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25543data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25544.code
25545AUTH PLAIN
25546.endd
25547to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25548prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25549
25550The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25551when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25552represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25553is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25554second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25555
25556Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25557realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25558authenticating clients it could make sense.
25559
25560A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25561&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25562comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25563this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25564This is an incorrect example:
25565.code
25566server_condition = \
25567 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25568.endd
25569The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25570which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25571incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25572non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25573strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25574the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25575name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25576.code
25577server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25578 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25579.endd
25580In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25581fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25582used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25583always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25584writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25585
25586
25587.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25588.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25589.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25590The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25591in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25592user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25593plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25594.code
25595fixed_login:
25596 driver = plaintext
25597 public_name = LOGIN
25598 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25599 server_condition = \
25600 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25601 server_set_id = $auth1
25602.endd
25603Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25604with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25605if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25606strings are used to obtain two data items.
25607
25608Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25609example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25610&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25611strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25612name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25613.code
25614login:
25615 driver = plaintext
25616 public_name = LOGIN
25617 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25618 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25619 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25620 ldapauth{\
25621 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25622 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25623 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25624 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25625.endd
25626We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25627does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25628operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25629&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25630correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25631the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25632uninterpreted string.
25633
25634
25635.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25636A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25637interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25638traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25639Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25640&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25641
25642
25643
25644
25645.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25646.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25647The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25648
25649.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25650If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25651authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25652the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25653usual.
25654
25655.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25656The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25657string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25658string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25659to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25660most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25661with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25662way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25663(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25664so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25665&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25666&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25667
25668&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25669splitting takes priority and happens first.
25670
25671Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25672the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25673there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25674NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25675the string.
25676
25677This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25678authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25679.code
25680fixed_plain:
25681 driver = plaintext
25682 public_name = PLAIN
25683 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25684.endd
25685The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25686command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25687that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25688.code
25689fixed_login:
25690 driver = plaintext
25691 public_name = LOGIN
25692 client_send = : username : mysecret
25693.endd
25694The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25695the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25696prompts.
25697.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25698.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25699
25700
25701
25702
25703. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25704. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25705
25706.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25707.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25708.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25709.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25710.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25711The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25712sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25713name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25714string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25715is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25716secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25717available in plain text at either end.
25718
25719
25720.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25721.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25722This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25723authenticator as a server:
25724
25725.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25726.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25727When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25728the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25729obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25730that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25731string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25732fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25733returned to the client.
25734
25735For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25736in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25737deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25738numeric variables for other things.
25739
25740For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25741client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25742user name, authentication fails.
25743.code
25744fixed_cram:
25745 driver = cram_md5
25746 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25747 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25748 server_set_id = $auth1
25749.endd
25750.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25751If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25752name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25753secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25754.code
25755lookup_cram:
25756 driver = cram_md5
25757 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25758 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25759 {$value}fail}
25760 server_set_id = $auth1
25761.endd
25762Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25763because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25764
25765As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25766using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25767lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25768realm, with:
25769.code
25770cyrusless_crammd5:
25771 driver = cram_md5
25772 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25773 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25774 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25775 server_set_id = $auth1
25776.endd
25777
25778.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25779.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25780When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25781
25782
25783
25784.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25785This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25786computing the response to the server's challenge.
25787
25788
25789.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25790This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25791expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25792
25793
25794.vindex "&$host$&"
25795.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25796Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25797to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25798expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25799prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25800authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25801send the message to the current server.
25802
25803A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25804strings, is:
25805.code
25806fixed_cram:
25807 driver = cram_md5
25808 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25809 client_name = ph10
25810 client_secret = secret
25811.endd
25812.ecindex IIDcramauth1
25813.ecindex IIDcramauth2
25814
25815
25816
25817. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25818. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25819
25820.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25821.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25822.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25823.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25824.cindex "Kerberos"
25825The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25826Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25827
25828The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25829library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25830Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25831including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25832directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25833
25834The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25835the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25836then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25837name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25838
25839Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25840or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25841user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25842by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25843depending on the driver you are using.
25844
25845The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25846be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25847Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25848changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25849layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25850implementation.
25851
25852For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25853may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25854variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25855Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25856With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25857environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25858is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25859the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25860
25861
25862.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25863The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25864(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25865previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25866use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25867confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25868things.
25869
25870
25871.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25872This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25873library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25874SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25875
25876
25877.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25878This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25879default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25880you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25881example:
25882.code
25883sasl:
25884 driver = cyrus_sasl
25885 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25886 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25887 server_set_id = $auth1
25888.endd
25889
25890.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25891This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25892
25893
25894.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25895This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25896
25897
25898For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25899private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25900the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25901PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25902.code
25903sasl_cram_md5:
25904 driver = cyrus_sasl
25905 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25906 server_set_id = $auth1
25907
25908sasl_plain:
25909 driver = cyrus_sasl
25910 public_name = PLAIN
25911 server_set_id = $auth2
25912.endd
25913Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25914not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25915but it is present in many binary distributions.
25916.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25917.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25918
25919
25920
25921
25922. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25923. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25924.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25925.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25926.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25927This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25928Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25929Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25930If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25931to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25932authenticator only. There is only one option:
25933
25934.option server_socket dovecot string unset
25935
25936This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25937authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25938mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25939authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25940.code
25941dovecot_plain:
25942 driver = dovecot
25943 public_name = PLAIN
25944 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25945 server_set_id = $auth1
25946
25947dovecot_ntlm:
25948 driver = dovecot
25949 public_name = NTLM
25950 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25951 server_set_id = $auth1
25952.endd
25953If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25954&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25955option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25956connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25957option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25958who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25959.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25960.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25961
25962
25963. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25964. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25965.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25966.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25967.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25968.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25969.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25970.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25971.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25972.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25973.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25974.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25975.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25976.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25977The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25978library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25979and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25980scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25981made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25982without code changes in Exim.
25983
25984
25985.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25986Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25987of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25988authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25989ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25990context.
25991
25992This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25993as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25994see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25995
25996This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25997only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25998writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25999
26000This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26001this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26002of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26003
26004
26005.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26006This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26007library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26008Some mechanisms will use this data.
26009
26010
26011.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26012This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26013default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26014you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26015example:
26016.code
26017sasl:
26018 driver = gsasl
26019 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26020 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26021 server_set_id = $auth1
26022.endd
26023
26024
26025.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26026Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26027that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26028the password itself.
26029
26030The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26031In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26032The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26033if available, else the empty string.
26034The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26035else the empty string.
26036
26037A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26038
26039If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26040option to be simply "true".
26041
26042
26043.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26044This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26045Some mechanisms will use this data.
26046
26047
26048.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26049This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26050&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26051(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26052
26053
26054.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26055This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26056&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26057(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26058
26059
26060.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26061This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26062Some mechanisms will use this data.
26063
26064
26065.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26066.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26067These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26068They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26069
26070Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26071meanings for these variables:
26072
26073.ilist
26074.vindex "&$auth1$&"
26075&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26076.next
26077.vindex "&$auth2$&"
26078&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26079.next
26080.vindex "&$auth3$&"
26081&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26082.endlist
26083
26084On a per-mechanism basis:
26085
26086.ilist
26087.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26088EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26089the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26090.next
26091.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26092ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26093the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26094.next
26095.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26096GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26097&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26098the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26099.endlist
26100
26101An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26102identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26103email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26104
26105
26106An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26107and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26108.code
26109gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26110 driver = gsasl
26111 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26112 server_realm = imap.example.org
26113 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26114 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26115 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26116 server_condition = yes
26117.endd
26118
26119
26120. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26121. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26122
26123.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26124.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26125.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26126.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26127.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26128The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26129Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26130reliably.
26131
26132.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26133This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26134for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26135identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26136
26137.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26138If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26139&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26140The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26141
26142.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26143This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26144&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
26145from the keytab.
26146
26147
26148.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26149Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26150to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26151not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26152
26153The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26154Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26155Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26156role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26157
26158.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26159.ilist
26160.vindex "&$auth1$&"
26161&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26162.next
26163.vindex "&$auth2$&"
26164&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26165authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26166GSS Display Name.
26167.endlist
26168
26169
26170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26171. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26172
26173.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26174.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26175.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26176.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26177.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26178.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26179.cindex "NTLM authentication"
26180The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26181Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26182which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26183this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26184taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26185server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26186follows:
26187
26188.ilist
26189After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26190authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26191.next
26192The server sends back a challenge.
26193.next
26194The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26195and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26196.endlist
26197
26198Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26199
26200
26201
26202.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26203.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26204The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26205
26206.option server_password spa string&!! unset
26207.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26208This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26209authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26210compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26211&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26212it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26213for other things. For example:
26214.code
26215spa:
26216 driver = spa
26217 public_name = NTLM
26218 server_password = \
26219 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26220.endd
26221If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26222failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26223
26224
26225
26226
26227
26228.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26229.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26230The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26231
26232
26233
26234.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26235This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26236
26237
26238.option client_password spa string&!! unset
26239This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26240
26241
26242.option client_username spa string&!! unset
26243This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26244configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26245&'msn.com'&:
26246.code
26247msn:
26248 driver = spa
26249 public_name = MSN
26250 client_username = msn/msn_username
26251 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26252 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26253.endd
26254.ecindex IIDspaauth1
26255.ecindex IIDspaauth2
26256
26257
26258
26259
26260
26261. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26262. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26263
26264.new
26265.chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26266.scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26267.scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26268.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26269.cindex "authentication" "X509"
26270.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26271The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26272authentication based on client certificates.
26273
26274It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26275advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26276It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26277the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26278by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26279the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26280
26281The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26282for which it must have been requested via the
26283&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26284(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26285
26286If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26287run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26288and can authenticate the connection.
26289If it does, SMTP suthentication is not offered.
26290
26291A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26292
26293
26294.cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26295The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26296
26297.option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26298.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26299This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26300the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26301If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26302failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26303
26304.option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26305.option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26306As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26307
26308&%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26309
26310
26311Example:
26312.code
26313tls:
26314 driver = tls
26315 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26316 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26317 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26318 {!= {0} \
26319 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26320 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26321 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26322 } } } }
26323 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26324.endd
26325.ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26326.ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26327.wen
26328
26329
26330Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26331the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26332a connect- or helo-ACL.
26333
26334
26335
26336. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26337. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26338
26339.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26340 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26341.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26342.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26343.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26344.cindex "OpenSSL"
26345.cindex "GnuTLS"
26346Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26347Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26348GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26349cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26350order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26351version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26352You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26353level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26354certificates are used.
26355
26356RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26357connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26358server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26359mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26360between them is encrypted.
26361
26362Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26363and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26364certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26365possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26366encryption state.
26367
26368&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26369disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26370in order to get TLS to work.
26371
26372
26373
26374.section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26375 "SECID284"
26376.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26377.cindex "smtps protocol"
26378.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26379.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26380Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26381SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26382waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26383port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26384allocated for this purpose.
26385
26386This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26387still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26388the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26389numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26390.code
26391tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26392.endd
26393The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26394via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26395the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26396the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26397an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26398defined elsewhere.
26399
26400There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26401&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26402
26403
26404
26405
26406
26407
26408.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26409.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26410The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26411followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26412to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26413.code
26414USE_GNUTLS=yes
26415.endd
26416in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26417.code
26418SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26419.endd
26420You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26421include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26422
26423There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26424
26425.ilist
26426The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26427cannot be the path of a directory
26428for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26429(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26430.next
26431The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26432.next
26433.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26434.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26435Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26436separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26437affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26438.next
26439OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26440DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26441RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26442in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26443for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26444to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26445&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26446option).
26447.next
26448The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26449sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26450.next
26451The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26452When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26453(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26454let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26455.next
26456Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26457This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26458explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26459implementation, then patches are welcome.
26460.endlist
26461
26462
26463.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26464This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26465an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26466but not the chosen filename.
26467By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26468See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26469
26470GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26471to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26472Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26473&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26474of bits requested.
26475The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26476its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26477parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26478that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26479renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26480this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26481place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26482
26483For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26484recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26485If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26486are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26487not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26488
26489Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26490values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26491parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26492If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26493until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26494a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26495
26496The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26497in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26498generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26499
26500To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26501and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26502&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26503renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26504.code
26505# ls
26506[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26507# rm -f new-params
26508# touch new-params
26509# chown exim:exim new-params
26510# chmod 0600 new-params
26511# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26512# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26513[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26514 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26515 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26516# chmod 0400 new-params
26517# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26518.endd
26519If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26520stalling is removed.
26521
26522The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26523Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26524the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26525a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26526and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26527failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26528of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26529which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26530GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26531to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26532limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26533
26534The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26535value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26536&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
265372432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26538
26539In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26540increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26541bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26542procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26543the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26544
26545
26546.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26547.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26548.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26549There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26550suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26551are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26552DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26553directly to this function call.
26554Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26555&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26556The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26557documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26558
26559.ilist
26560It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26561.next
26562It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26563or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26564ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26565SSL v3 algorithms.
26566.next
26567Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26568the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26569SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26570algorithms.
26571.endlist
26572
26573Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26574&`-`& or &`+`&.
26575.ilist
26576If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26577ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26578stated.
26579.next
26580If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26581of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26582.next
26583If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26584option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26585.endlist
26586
26587If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26588a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26589includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26590not be moved to the end of the list.
26591.endlist
26592
26593The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26594string:
26595.code
26596# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26597$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26598.endd
26599
26600This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26601there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26602submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26603choice of clients used:
26604.code
26605# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26606tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26607 {DEFAULT}\
26608 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26609.endd
26610
26611
26612
26613.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26614 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26615.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26616.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26617.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26618.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26619.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26620.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26621.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26622The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26623as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26624ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26625
26626The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26627and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26628
26629The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26630controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26631&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26632the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26633the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26634aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26635
26636Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26637"Priority strings". This is online as
26638&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26639but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26640installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26641&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26642on that site can be used to test a given string.
26643
26644For example:
26645.code
26646# Disable older versions of protocols
26647tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26648.endd
26649
26650Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26651additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26652"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26653
26654This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26655there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26656by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26657where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26658used:
26659.code
26660# GnuTLS variant
26661tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26662 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26663 {SECURE128}}
26664.endd
26665
26666
26667.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26668.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26669When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26670the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26671but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26672that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26673need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26674sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26675
26676If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26677problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26678persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26679with the error
26680.code
26681554 Security failure
26682.endd
26683If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26684rejected with a 554 error code.
26685
26686To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26687match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26688However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26689without some further configuration at the server end.
26690
26691It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26692encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26693.code
26694tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26695tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26696.endd
26697These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26698the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26699contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26700that goes with it. These files need to be
26701PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26702always be given as full path names.
26703The key must not be password-protected.
26704They can be the same file if both the
26705certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26706set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26707is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26708certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26709the server's certificate.
26710
26711If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26712source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26713few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26714
26715&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26716they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26717Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26718transport.
26719
26720With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26721require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26722this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26723.code
26724tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26725.endd
26726is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26727with the parameters contained in the file.
26728Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26729available:
26730.code
26731tls_dhparam = none
26732.endd
26733This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26734DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26735used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26736documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26737
26738See the command
26739.code
26740openssl dhparam
26741.endd
26742for a way of generating file data.
26743
26744The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26745host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26746for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26747in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26748forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26749
26750.cindex "cipher" "logging"
26751.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26752.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26753The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26754an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26755incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26756also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26757&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26758condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26759
26760Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26761can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26762cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26763example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26764contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26765documentation for more details.
26766
26767For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26768(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26769
26770
26771.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26772.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26773.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26774If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26775session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26776&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26777apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26778Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26779contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26780expected certificates.
26781.new
26782These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26783.wen
26784an explicit file or,
26785depending on library version, a directory, identified by
26786&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26787
26788A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26789directory is used
26790(OpenSSL only),
26791each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26792of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26793certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26794.code
26795openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26796.endd
26797where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26798
26799The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26800what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26801does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26802&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26803attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26804dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26805session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26806fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26807example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26808relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26809
26810.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26811When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26812the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26813&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26814
26815.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26816Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26817&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26818&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26819&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26820certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26821
26822
26823.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26824.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26825.cindex "revocation list"
26826.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26827.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26828Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26829certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26830server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26831an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26832of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26833CRL in PEM format.
26834The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26835file from every certificate authority they know of.
26836
26837The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26838Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26839against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26840usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26841private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26842is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26843
26844The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26845comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26846connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26847re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26848
26849The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26850issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26851the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26852negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26853CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26854resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26855starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26856proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26857
26858Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26859or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.1.3,
26860support for OCSP stapling is included.
26861
26862There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26863The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26864an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26865option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26866contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26867
26868Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26869proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26870Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26871contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26872on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26873next connection.
26874
26875When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26876in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26877ignored.
26878
26879For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26880also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26881certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26882of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26883intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26884file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26885
26886Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26887not any of the chain from CA to it.
26888
26889There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26890
26891.code
26892 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26893 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26894 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26895
26896 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26897 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26898 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26899.endd
26900
26901
26902
26903
26904.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26905.cindex "cipher" "logging"
26906.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26907.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26908.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26909The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26910deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26911server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26912within the &(smtp)& transport.
26913
26914It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26915transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26916server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26917this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26918transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26919
26920If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26921to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26922&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26923those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26924set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26925usual way.
26926
26927When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26928the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26929a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26930session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26931&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26932delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26933it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26934STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26935negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26936unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26937unencrypted.
26938
26939The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26940transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26941if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26942&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26943
26944If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26945specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
26946.new
26947These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26948.wen
26949a file or,
26950depnding on liibrary version, a directory,
26951must name a file or,
26952for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
26953The client verifies the server's certificate
26954against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26955in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26956Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26957&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26958
26959The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26960certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26961or need not succeed respectively.
26962
26963The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26964&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26965is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26966value is empty.
26967&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26968a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26969value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26970otherwise.
26971
26972The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26973&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26974for OCSP to be relevant.
26975
26976If
26977&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26978list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26979the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26980alternative hosts, if any.
26981
26982 &*Note*&:
26983These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26984is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26985by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26986client.
26987
26988.vindex "&$host$&"
26989.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26990All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26991&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26992which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26993behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26994
26995.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26996.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26997.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26998.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26999Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27000&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27001variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27002that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27003successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27004outgoing connection.
27005
27006
27007
27008.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27009.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27010.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27011.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27012With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27013information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27014extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27015&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27016client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27017within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27018for this session.
27019
27020This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27021which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27022address.
27023
27024With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27025against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27026provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27027be of limited use in that environment.
27028
27029With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27030connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27031choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27032wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27033different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27034
27035The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27036if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27037nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27038only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27039for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27040
27041Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27042received from a client.
27043It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27044
27045If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27046option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27047during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27048
27049.ilist
27050.vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27051&%tls_certificate%&
27052.next
27053.vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27054&%tls_crl%&
27055.next
27056.vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27057&%tls_privatekey%&
27058.next
27059.vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27060&%tls_verify_certificates%&
27061.next
27062.vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27063&%tls_ocsp_file%&
27064.endlist
27065
27066Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27067attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27068can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
27069arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27070
27071The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27072are re-expanded.
27073
27074When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27075for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27076enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27077see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27078
27079When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
270800.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27081built, then you have SNI support).
27082
27083
27084
27085.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27086 "SECTmulmessam"
27087.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27088.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27089Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27090an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27091one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27092of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27093connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27094to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
27095session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27096try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27097if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27098
27099The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27100after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27101just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27102reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27103successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27104SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27105should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27106subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27107and delay other deliveries to that host.
27108
27109To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27110closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27111closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27112information is recorded.
27113
27114There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27115&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27116connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27117
27118
27119
27120
27121.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27122.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27123In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27124certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27125place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27126myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27127to Apache, currently at
27128.display
27129&url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27130.endd
27131Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27132links to further files.
27133Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
271340-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27135Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27136.display
27137&url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27138.endd
27139
27140
27141.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27142The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27143certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27144sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27145not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27146First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27147certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27148intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27149certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27150The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27151validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27152root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27153install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27154
27155Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27156even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27157server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27158diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27159
27160
27161
27162.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27163.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27164You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27165with OpenSSL, like this:
27166. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27167. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27168.code
27169openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27170 -days 9999 -nodes
27171.endd
27172&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27173delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27174specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27175important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27176that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27177prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27178this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27179
27180. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27181. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27182. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27183. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27184. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27185. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27186. ==== -pdp, 2012
27187NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27188epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27189the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27190the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27191of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27192writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27193progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27194be a sensible resolution).
27195
27196A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27197may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27198encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27199
27200However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27201user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27202certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27203must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27204authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27205signed with that self-signed certificate.
27206
27207For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27208user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27209Open-source PKI book, available online at
27210&url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27211.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27212.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27213
27214
27215
27216. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27217. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27218
27219.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27220.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27221.cindex "control of incoming mail"
27222.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27223.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27224Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27225configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27226name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27227one very small ACL:
27228.code
27229begin acl
27230small_acl:
27231 accept hosts = one.host.only
27232.endd
27233You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27234which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27235
27236The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27237certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27238when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27239option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27240in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27241local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27242a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27243&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27244
27245
27246.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27247The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27248configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27249The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
27250relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
27251
27252
27253
27254.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27255.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27256In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27257options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27258.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27259.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27260.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27261.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27262.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27263.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27264.cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27265.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27266.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27267.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27268.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27269.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27270.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27271.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27272.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27273.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27274
27275.table2 140pt
27276.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27277.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27278.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27279.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27280.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27281.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27282.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27283.irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27284.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27285.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27286.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27287.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27288.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27289.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27290.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27291.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27292.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27293.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27294.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27295.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27296.endtable
27297
27298For example, if you set
27299.code
27300acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27301.endd
27302the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27303in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27304done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27305sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27306command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27307trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27308testing as possible at RCPT time.
27309
27310
27311.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27312.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27313The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27314apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27315really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27316the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27317relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27318are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27319&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27320&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27321in any of these ACLs.
27322
27323The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27324non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27325analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27326batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27327result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27328really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27329on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27330controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27331.code
27332control = suppress_local_fixups
27333.endd
27334This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27335run, it is too late.
27336
27337The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27338content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27339
27340The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27341kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27342temporary error for these kinds of message.
27343
27344
27345.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27346.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27347.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27348The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27349session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27350an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27351accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27352the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27353&%smtp_banner%& option.
27354
27355
27356.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27357.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27358.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27359The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27360EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27361&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27362Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27363session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27364setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27365
27366If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27367modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27368at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27369affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27370an EHLO response.
27371
27372
27373.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27374.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27375Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27376command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27377When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27378is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27379the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27380response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27381added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27382are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27383
27384You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27385in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27386tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27387received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27388the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27389associated with the DATA command.
27390
27391For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27392error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27393MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27394before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27395and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27396your resources.
27397
27398The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27399the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27400the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27401and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27402
27403.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27404The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27405enabled (which is the default).
27406
27407The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27408received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27409otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27410
27411This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27412
27413For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27414
27415
27416.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27417The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27418content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27419
27420This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27421
27422
27423.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27424.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27425.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27426The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27427with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27428It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27429client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27430has been accepted.
27431
27432The ACL test specfied by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27433has been recieved, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27434with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27435The test may accept, defer or deny for inividual recipients.
27436The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27437can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27438for some or all recipients.
27439
27440PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27441one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27442content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27443for this can be disabled when the MAIL-time $smtp_command included
27444"PRDR". Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27445ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27446will avoid doing so in some situations (eg. single-recipient mails).
27447
27448See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27449and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27450
27451This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27452If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27453the feature was not requested by the client.
27454
27455.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27456.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27457The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27458does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27459does not in fact control any access.
27460.new
27461For this reason, it may only accept
27462or warn as its final result.
27463.wen
27464
27465This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27466session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27467messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27468more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27469
27470&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27471the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27472
27473You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27474&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27475response to QUIT.
27476
27477This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27478failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27479because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27480client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27481connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27482
27483
27484.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27485.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27486The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27487an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27488trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27489because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27490situation even worse.
27491
27492Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27493logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27494modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27495and &%warn%&.
27496
27497.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27498When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27499to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27500connection. The possible values are:
27501.table2
27502.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27503.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27504.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27505.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27506.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27507.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27508.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27509.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27510.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27511.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27512.endtable
27513In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27514Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27515With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27516overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27517&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27518used.
27519
27520
27521.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27522.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27523The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27524you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27525.code
27526acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27527 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27528.endd
27529In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27530providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27531non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27532expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27533more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27534
27535The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27536configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27537string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27538
27539.ilist
27540If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27541contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27542Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27543lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27544If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27545causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27546.code
27547acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27548 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27549 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27550.endd
27551This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27552back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27553file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27554can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27555.next
27556If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27557Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27558matches the string.
27559.next
27560If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27561the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27562want to have something like
27563.code
27564acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27565.endd
27566in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27567newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27568.endlist
27569
27570
27571
27572
27573.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27574.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27575Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27576section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27577&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27578database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27579return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27580&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27581This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27582
27583For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27584&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27585submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27586
27587
27588ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27589has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27590individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27591blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27592
27593If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27594ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27595RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27596recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27597run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27598remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27599&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27600
27601
27602.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27603The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27604recipients; it may create new recipients.
27605
27606
27607
27608.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27609.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27610The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27611all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27612not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27613reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27614
27615For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27616these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27617used to accept or reject anything.
27618
27619For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27620&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27621&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27622when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27623
27624For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27625&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27626This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27627messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27628configuration file.
27629
27630
27631
27632
27633.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27634.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27635.vindex &$domain$&
27636.vindex &$local_part$&
27637.vindex &$sender_address$&
27638.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27639.vindex &$smtp_command$&
27640When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27641that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27642&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27643statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27644&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27645is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27646
27647When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27648contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27649set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27650how it is used.
27651
27652.vindex "&$message_size$&"
27653The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27654the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27655that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27656the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27657received).
27658
27659.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27660.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27661The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27662The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27663accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27664of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27665&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27666&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27667
27668
27669
27670
27671
27672.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27673.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27674.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27675.vindex &$smtp_command$&
27676When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27677the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27678and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27679These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27680here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27681encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27682does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27683unencrypted connections.
27684.code
27685acl_check_auth:
27686 accept encrypted = *
27687 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27688 {CRAM-MD5}}
27689 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27690.endd
27691(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27692that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27693encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27694option to do this.)
27695
27696
27697
27698.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27699.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27700.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27701An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27702with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27703Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27704set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27705
27706If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27707used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27708provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27709example:
27710.code
27711deny dnslists = list1.example
27712dnslists = list2.example
27713.endd
27714If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27715the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27716happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27717all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27718test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27719
27720
27721.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27722The ACL verbs are as follows:
27723
27724.ilist
27725.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27726&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27727of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27728appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27729is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27730after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27731check a RCPT command:
27732.code
27733accept domains = +local_domains
27734endpass
27735verify = recipient
27736.endd
27737If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27738passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27739the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27740fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27741&%endpass%&.
27742
27743The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27744use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27745that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27746configuration.
27747
27748.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27749If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27750depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27751(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27752statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27753SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27754.display
27755&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27756&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27757.endd
27758You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27759response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27760same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27761
27762If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27763an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27764for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27765of &%endpass%&.
27766
27767
27768.next
27769.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27770&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27771an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27772&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27773temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27774&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27775be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27776
27777
27778.next
27779.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27780&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27781the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27782example,
27783.code
27784deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27785.endd
27786rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27787
27788
27789.next
27790.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27791&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27792&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27793that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27794the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27795recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27796recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27797message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27798do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27799
27800If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27801its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27802The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27803
27804
27805.next
27806.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27807&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27808forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27809.code
27810drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27811 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27812.endd
27813There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27814The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27815
27816.next
27817.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27818&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27819statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27820example, when checking a RCPT command,
27821.code
27822require message = Sender did not verify
27823 verify = sender
27824.endd
27825passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27826verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27827&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27828discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27829
27830.next
27831.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27832&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27833&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27834to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27835written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27836message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27837duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27838
27839If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27840and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27841&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27842first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27843&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27844
27845If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27846some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27847This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27848is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27849conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27850is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27851onwards.
27852
27853
27854.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27855When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27856text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27857want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27858.code
27859warn !verify = sender
27860 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27861.endd
27862.endlist
27863
27864At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27865
27866As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27867written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27868subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27869continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27870mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27871
27872
27873
27874.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27875.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27876There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27877can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27878of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27879transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27880variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27881an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27882alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27883the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27884.ilist
27885The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27886throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27887while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27888on the same SMTP connection.
27889.next
27890The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27891while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27892reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27893.endlist
27894
27895When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27896preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27897time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27898.code
27899accept hosts = whatever
27900 set acl_m4 = some value
27901accept authenticated = *
27902 set acl_c_auth = yes
27903.endd
27904&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27905be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27906&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27907
27908.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27909What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27910referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27911false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27912error is generated.
27913
27914Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27915their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27916
27917
27918.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27919.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27920.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27921An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27922.code
27923deny domains = *.dom.example
27924 !verify = recipient
27925.endd
27926causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27927&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27928negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27929two statements are equivalent:
27930.code
27931deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27932deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27933.endd
27934However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27935side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27936
27937The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27938of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27939condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27940.code
27941accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27942 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27943accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27944 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27945.endd
27946Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27947the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27948different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27949condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27950therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27951the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27952and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27953
27954ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27955specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27956others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27957warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27958message is handled.
27959
27960The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27961processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27962modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27963consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27964.code
27965require message = Can't verify sender
27966 verify = sender
27967 message = Can't verify recipient
27968 verify = recipient
27969 message = This message cannot be used
27970.endd
27971If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27972&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27973so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27974recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27975verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27976because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27977
27978For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27979modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27980happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27981the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27982.code
27983deny hosts = ...
27984 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27985 message = Invalid sender from client host
27986.endd
27987The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27988by which time Exim has set up the message.
27989
27990
27991
27992.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27993.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27994The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27995
27996.vlist
27997.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27998This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
27999incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28000accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28001
28002.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28003.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28004.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28005This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28006continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28007the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28008update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28009write rather ugly lines like this:
28010.display
28011&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28012.endd
28013Instead, all you need is
28014.display
28015&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28016.endd
28017
28018.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28019.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28020This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28021incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28022lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28023lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28024controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28025even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28026
28027As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28028separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28029in several different ways. For example:
28030
28031. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28032. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28033. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28034. ==== way.
28035
28036.ilist
28037It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28038.code
28039 accept ...some conditions
28040 control = queue_only
28041.endd
28042In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28043other words, when the conditions are all true.
28044
28045.next
28046It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28047.code
28048 accept ...some conditions...
28049 control = queue_only
28050 ...some more conditions...
28051.endd
28052If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28053statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28054In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28055to be relevant.
28056
28057.next
28058It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28059decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28060example:
28061.code
28062 warn ...some conditions...
28063 control = freeze
28064 accept ...
28065.endd
28066This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28067&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28068log entry.
28069
28070.next
28071If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28072&%require%& verb. For example:
28073.code
28074 require control = no_multiline_responses
28075.endd
28076.endlist
28077
28078.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28079.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28080.oindex "&%-bh%&"
28081This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28082the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28083&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28084output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28085happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28086output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28087
28088Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28089example:
28090.code
28091deny ...some conditions...
28092 delay = 30s
28093.endd
28094The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28095&"deny"&. Compare this with:
28096.code
28097deny delay = 30s
28098 ...some conditions...
28099.endd
28100which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28101can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28102.code
28103warn ...some conditions...
28104 delay = 2m
28105 control = freeze
28106accept ...
28107.endd
28108
28109If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28110responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28111they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28112delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28113appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28114unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28115using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28116
28117
28118.vitem &*endpass*&
28119.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28120This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28121&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28122failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28123failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28124confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28125&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28126
28127
28128.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28129.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28130This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28131ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28132.code
28133require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28134 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28135.endd
28136&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28137example:
28138.display
28139&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28140&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28141.endd
28142When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28143that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28144recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28145message.
28146
28147The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28148the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28149denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28150available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28151variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28152&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28153ignored.
28154
28155.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28156If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28157verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28158error message.
28159
28160If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28161the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28162more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28163actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28164of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28165is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28166
28167If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28168example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28169the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28170logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28171both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28172logging rejections.
28173
28174
28175.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28176.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28177.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28178This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28179about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28180be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28181may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28182ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28183.display
28184&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28185&` log_reject_target =`&
28186.endd
28187This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28188permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28189current ACL.
28190
28191
28192.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28193.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28194.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28195This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28196processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28197&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28198access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28199ACLs. For example:
28200.display
28201&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28202&` control = freeze`&
28203&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28204.endd
28205By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28206with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28207another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28208example:
28209.code
28210logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28211logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28212.endd
28213
28214
28215.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28216.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28217This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28218message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28219or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28220there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28221&%accept%& for details.)
28222
28223The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28224to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28225generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28226&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28227the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28228.code
28229require message = Host not recognized
28230 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28231.endd
28232(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28233processed.)
28234
28235.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28236.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28237For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28238of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28239is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28240is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28241overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28242accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28243truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28244EHLO options.
28245
28246When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28247consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28248of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28249.code
28250deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28251 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28252.endd
28253The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28254by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28255access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
282562&'xx'&.
28257
28258Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28259the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28260
28261The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28262literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28263anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28264response.
28265
28266.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28267For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28268stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28269
28270If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28271specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28272However, the original message is available in the variable
28273&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28274wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28275routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28276use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28277
28278For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28279is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28280modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28281all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28282&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28283&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28284effect.
28285
28286
28287.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28288This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28289 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28290the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28291
28292
28293.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28294.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28295This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28296&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28297
28298
28299.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28300This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28301collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28302the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28303of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28304server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28305separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28306example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28307when:
28308.code
28309udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28310 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28311.endd
28312.endlist
28313
28314
28315
28316
28317.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28318.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28319The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28320
28321.vlist
28322.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28323This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28324has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28325apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28326HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28327really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28328not work without it. For example:
28329.code
28330warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28331 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28332.endd
28333Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28334the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28335matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28336mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28337by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28338
28339
28340.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28341 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28342.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28343.cindex "case of local parts"
28344.vindex "&$local_part$&"
28345These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28346(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28347are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28348any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28349for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28350is encountered.
28351
28352These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28353local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28354in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28355handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28356configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28357
28358This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28359containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28360spam score:
28361.code
28362warn control = caseful_local_part
28363 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28364 $acl_m4 + \
28365 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28366 }
28367 control = caselower_local_part
28368.endd
28369Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28370is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28371
28372
28373.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28374.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28375.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28376This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28377
28378The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28379If enabled for a message recieved via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28380.new
28381and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28382is used for all recipients of the message,
28383.wen
28384then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28385and data is copied from one to the other.
28386
28387An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28388for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28389If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28390requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28391.new
28392any subsequent receipients and the data,
28393.wen
28394otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28395
28396Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28397and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28398Note also that headers cannot be
28399modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28400Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28401
28402Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28403of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28404before the entire message has been received from the source.
28405.new
28406It is not supported for messages recieved with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28407.wen
28408
28409Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28410a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28411If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28412usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28413the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28414before the acceptance "<=" line.
28415
28416Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28417(possibly faked)
28418sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28419
28420
28421.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28422.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28423.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28424This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28425with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28426&'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28427may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28428the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28429option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28430contexts):
28431.code
28432 control = debug
28433 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28434 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28435 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28436.endd
28437
28438
28439.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28440.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28441.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28442This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28443the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28444
28445
28446.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28447.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28448.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28449This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28450connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28451strings or to numeric value.
28452The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28453Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28454&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28455
28456The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28457(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28458that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28459equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28460Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28461
28462
28463.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28464 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28465.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28466.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28467These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28468is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28469state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28470in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28471
28472The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28473connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28474messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28475&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28476before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28477synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28478work with.
28479
28480
28481.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28482.cindex "fake defer"
28483.cindex "defer, fake"
28484This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28485except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28486550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28487messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28488use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28489
28490.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28491.cindex "fake rejection"
28492.cindex "rejection, fake"
28493This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28494words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28495message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28496However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28497only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28498the same SMTP connection.
28499
28500The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28501message is supplied, the following is used:
28502.code
28503550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28504550-kept for evaluation.
28505550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28506550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28507.endd
28508This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28509
28510.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28511.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28512This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28513other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28514it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28515current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28516SMTP connection.
28517
28518This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28519&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28520is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28521are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28522
28523.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28524.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28525Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28526avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28527use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28528disables such output flushing.
28529
28530.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28531.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28532Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28533avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28534use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28535that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28536
28537.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28538This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28539extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28540of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28541or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28542needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28543only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28544the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28545to be useful in production.
28546
28547.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28548.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28549This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28550It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28551SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28552
28553If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28554suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28555one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28556(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28557responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28558sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28559
28560.ilist
28561Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28562sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28563verification failed"&) is sent.
28564.next
28565If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28566line is output.
28567.endlist
28568
28569The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28570calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28571
28572.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28573.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28574This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28575the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28576response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28577controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28578&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28579
28580.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28581.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28582.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28583This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28584other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28585it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28586runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28587effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28588to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28589same SMTP connection.
28590
28591.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28592.cindex "message" "submission"
28593.cindex "submission mode"
28594This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28595latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28596the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28597operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28598necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28599This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28600late (the message has already been created).
28601
28602Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28603messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28604submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28605The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28606that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28607
28608.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28609.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28610This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28611complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28612normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28613
28614.ilist
28615Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28616dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28617.next
28618No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28619.next
28620There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28621.endlist ilist
28622
28623This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28624passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28625used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28626and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28627data is read.
28628
28629&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28630that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28631.endlist vlist
28632
28633
28634.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28635All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28636
28637.ilist
28638Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28639.next
28640Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28641&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28642.next
28643Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28644.next
28645Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28646.endlist
28647
28648
28649
28650.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28651.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28652.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28653.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28654The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28655to an incoming message, as in this example:
28656.code
28657warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28658 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28659 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28660.endd
28661The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28662MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28663receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28664&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28665any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28666RCPT ACL).
28667
28668Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28669DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28670
28671Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28672the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28673contains one or more newlines that
28674are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28675lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28676front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28677
28678Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28679They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28680However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28681is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28682during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28683with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28684lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28685In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28686non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28687message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28688are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28689
28690.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28691Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28692of message headers
28693until they are added to the
28694message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28695ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28696header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28697ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28698passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28699this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28700&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28701
28702The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28703
28704The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28705processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28706.display
28707&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28708&` `&<&'some condition'&>
28709
28710&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28711&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28712.endd
28713In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28714condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28715condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28716ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28717honoured.
28718
28719.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28720For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28721&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28722effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28723them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28724usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28725are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28726specifications.
28727
28728By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28729header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28730be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28731after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28732that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28733
28734This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28735&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28736header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28737to be a header name first.) For example:
28738.code
28739warn add_header = \
28740 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28741.endd
28742If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28743each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28744you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28745up in reverse order.
28746
28747&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28748added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28749system filter or in a router or transport.
28750
28751
28752
28753.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28754.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28755.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28756.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28757The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28758from an incoming message, as in this example:
28759.code
28760warn message = Remove internal headers
28761 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28762.endd
28763The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28764MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28765receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28766&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28767with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28768any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28769
28770Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28771DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28772
28773More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28774list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28775not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28776create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28777are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28778.code
28779warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28780 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28781warn message = Remove internal headers
28782 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28783.endd
28784Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28785They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28786There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28787a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28788during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28789if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28790accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28791all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28792ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28793would have been removed.
28794
28795.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28796Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28797is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28798not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28799removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28800this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28801passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28802you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28803&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28804
28805The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28806processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28807.display
28808&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28809&` `&<&'some condition'&>
28810
28811&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28812&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28813.endd
28814In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28815condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28816condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28817same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28818are honoured.
28819
28820&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28821present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28822in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28823
28824
28825
28826
28827.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28828.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28829Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28830compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28831for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28832content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28833
28834Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28835senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28836result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28837done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28838can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28839same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28840The conditions are as follows:
28841
28842
28843.vlist
28844.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28845.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28846.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28847.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28848.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28849The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28850&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28851&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28852false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28853condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28854condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28855ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28856
28857If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28858can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28859and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28860Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28861The name and values are expanded separately.
28862Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28863will act as argument separators.
28864
28865If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28866the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28867&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28868conditions are tested.
28869
28870ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28871loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28872circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28873for different local users or different local domains.
28874
28875.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28876.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28877.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28878.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28879If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28880the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28881authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28882.code
28883authenticated = *
28884.endd
28885
28886.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28887.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28888.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28889.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28890.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28891This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28892expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28893&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28894number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28895any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28896&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28897ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28898negative.
28899
28900.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28901.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28902This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28903content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28904&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28905If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28906problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28907chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28908
28909.vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28910.cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28911This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28912content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28913&<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28914
28915.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28916.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28917.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28918.cindex "black list (DNS)"
28919.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28920This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28921&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28922use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28923different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28924&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28925
28926.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28927.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28928.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28929.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28930.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28931This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28932of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28933enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28934lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28935&%domains%& test.
28936
28937&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28938use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28939
28940
28941.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28942.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28943.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28944.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28945If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28946name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28947encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28948.code
28949encrypted = *
28950.endd
28951
28952
28953.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28954.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28955.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28956.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28957This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28958name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28959you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28960.code
28961accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28962.endd
28963The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28964the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28965and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28966
28967The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28968Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28969but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28970find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28971opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28972found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28973
28974If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28975address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28976.code
28977accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28978accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28979.endd
28980The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28981is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28982statement can then check the IP address.
28983
28984.vindex "&$host_data$&"
28985If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28986of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28987allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28988.code
28989deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28990message = $host_data
28991.endd
28992which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28993
28994.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28995.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28996.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28997.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28998.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28999This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
29000part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
29001enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
29002result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
29003the next &%local_parts%& test.
29004
29005.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
29006.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
29007.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
29008.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29009This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29010content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29011viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29012
29013.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29014.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29015.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29016This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29017content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29018&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29019with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29020&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29021
29022.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29023.cindex "rate limiting"
29024This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29025messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29026
29027.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29028.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29029.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29030.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29031This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29032recipient address against a list of recipients.
29033
29034.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29035.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29036.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29037This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29038content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29039non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29040any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29041
29042.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29043.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29044.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29045.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29046.vindex "&$domain$&"
29047.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29048This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29049domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29050&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29051of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29052lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29053RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29054influence the sender checking.
29055
29056&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29057relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29058
29059.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29060.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29061.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29062.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29063This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29064for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29065.code
29066senders = :
29067.endd
29068&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29069relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29070
29071.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29072.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29073.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29074This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29075content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29076SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29077
29078.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29079.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29080.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29081.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29082.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29083.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29084This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29085certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29086server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29087or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29088
29089.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29090.cindex "CSA verification"
29091This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29092send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29093&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29094
29095.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29096.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29097.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29098.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29099.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29100This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29101received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29102&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29103there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29104allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29105
29106Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29107problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29108detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29109
29110.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29111.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29112.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29113.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29114.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29115.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29116This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29117received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29118&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29119of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29120is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29121However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29122that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29123to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29124might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29125
29126Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29127section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29128&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29129condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29130.code
29131deny senders = :
29132 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29133 !verify = header_sender
29134.endd
29135
29136.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29137.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29138.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29139.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29140.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29141This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29142received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29143&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29144lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29145and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29146permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29147&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29148appropriate.
29149
29150Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29151ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29152.code
29153To: @
29154.endd
29155and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29156common as they used to be.
29157
29158.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29159.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29160.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29161.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29162.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29163.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29164.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29165This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29166client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29167attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29168condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29169&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29170independently of this condition.
29171
29172For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29173option), this condition is always true.
29174
29175
29176.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29177.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29178.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29179This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29180Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29181&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29182case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29183&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29184used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29185
29186There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29187recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29188
29189
29190.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29191.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29192.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29193.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29194.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29195.vindex "&$address_data$&"
29196This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29197recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29198&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29199of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29200This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29201verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29202address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29203value for the child address.
29204
29205.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29206.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29207.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29208.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29209This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29210address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29211was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29212Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29213one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29214original IP address.
29215
29216.new
29217There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29218DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29219.wen
29220
29221If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29222is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29223
29224.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29225.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29226.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29227.cindex "sender" "verifying"
29228.cindex "verifying" "sender"
29229This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29230message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29231the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29232condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29233
29234.vindex "&$address_data$&"
29235.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29236If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29237value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29238value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29239statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29240want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29241
29242Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29243&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29244to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29245
29246.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29247.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29248This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29249verified as a sender.
29250.endlist
29251
29252
29253
29254.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29255.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29256.cindex "black list (DNS)"
29257.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29258In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29259is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29260address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29261domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29262special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29263address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29264.code
29265deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29266 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29267.endd
29268the following records are looked up:
29269.code
2927043.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
2927143.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29272.endd
29273As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29274Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29275to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29276use two separate conditions:
29277.code
29278deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29279 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29280.endd
29281If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29282behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29283record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29284processed.
29285
29286This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29287(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29288blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29289following special items in the list:
29290.display
29291&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29292&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29293&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29294.endd
29295.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29296.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29297.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29298Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29299.code
29300deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29301.endd
29302Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29303warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29304.code
29305deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29306warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29307 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29308.endd
29309DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
29310so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29311connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29312connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29313
29314
29315
29316.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29317.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29318By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29319of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29320after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29321.code
29322deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29323.endd
29324This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29325use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29326MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29327&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29328
29329
29330
29331
29332.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29333.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29334There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29335addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29336&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29337with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29338listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29339.code
29340deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29341 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29342.endd
29343This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29344RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29345example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29346up by this example is
29347.code
29348tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29349.endd
29350A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29351addresses. For example:
29352.code
29353deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29354 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29355.endd
29356The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29357name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29358
29359
29360
29361
29362.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29363.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29364The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29365names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29366name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29367As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29368this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29369either to double the separators like this:
29370.code
29371dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29372.endd
29373or to change the separator character, like this:
29374.code
29375dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29376.endd
29377If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29378blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29379occurs. Consider this condition:
29380.code
29381dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29382.endd
29383The DNS lookups that occur are:
29384.code
293852.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29386a.domain.black.list.tld
29387.endd
29388Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29389address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29390are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29391or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29392only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29393successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29394error for a previous item.
29395
29396The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29397syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29398.code
29399dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29400dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29401.endd
29402However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29403is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29404.code
29405deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29406 $sender_address_domain \
29407 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29408 see $dnslist_text.
29409 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29410 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29411 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29412.endd
29413Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29414multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29415and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29416of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29417.code
29418dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29419.endd
29420Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29421domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29422
29423The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29424&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29425
29426
29427
29428
29429.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29430.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29431DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29432just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29433RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29434The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29435.display
29436127.1.0.1 RBL
29437127.1.0.2 DUL
29438127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29439127.1.0.4 RSS
29440127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29441127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29442127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29443.endd
29444Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29445different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29446see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29447
29448
29449.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29450.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29451.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29452.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29453.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29454.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29455.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29456When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29457the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29458&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29459(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29460the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29461&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29462cases, for example:
29463.code
29464deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29465.endd
29466the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29467&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29468For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29469might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29470.code
29471deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29472.endd
29473If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29474&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29475
29476If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29477addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29478The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29479record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29480very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29481information.
29482
29483You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29484&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29485expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29486.code
29487deny hosts = !+local_networks
29488 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29489 at $dnslist_domain
29490 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29491.endd
29492
29493
29494
29495.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29496.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29497You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29498in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29499For example,
29500.code
29501deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29502.endd
29503rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29504any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29505that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29506describes how multiple records are handled.
29507
29508More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29509separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29510&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29511.code
29512deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29513.endd
29514If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29515addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29516first. For example:
29517.code
29518deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29519 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29520.endd
29521
29522If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29523listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29524In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29525true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29526tested. For example:
29527.code
29528dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29529.endd
29530matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29531want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29532being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29533.code
29534dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29535.endd
29536matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29537an odd number.
29538
29539
29540
29541.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29542You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29543condition. Whereas
29544.code
29545deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29546.endd
29547means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29548IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29549.code
29550deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29551.endd
29552means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29553IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29554words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29555the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29556
29557&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29558host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29559
29560If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29561previous example is precisely equivalent to
29562.code
29563deny dnslists = a.b.c
29564 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29565.endd
29566However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29567Consider this example:
29568.code
29569deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29570 list.dsbl.org : \
29571 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29572 relays.ordb.org
29573.endd
29574Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29575.code
29576deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29577 list.dsbl.org
29578deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29579 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29580deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29581.endd
29582which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29583
29584
29585
29586
29587.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29588A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29589thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29590is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29591the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29592the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29593.code
29594dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29595.endd
29596What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29597127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29598condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29599because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29600affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29601additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29602
29603.ilist
29604If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29605IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29606condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29607.next
29608If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29609looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29610changed to:
29611.code
29612dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29613.endd
29614and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29615false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29616.code
29617dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29618.endd
29619for the condition to be true.
29620.endlist
29621
29622When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29623the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29624.ilist
29625If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29626addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29627.code
29628dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29629.endd
29630If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29631false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29632.next
29633If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29634looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29635.code
29636dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29637.endd
29638If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29639true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29640.code
29641dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29642.endd
29643for the condition to be false.
29644.endlist
29645When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29646between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29647
29648
29649
29650
29651.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29652.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29653When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29654the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29655the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29656address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29657only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29658can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29659in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29660lists.
29661
29662A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29663two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29664do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29665If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29666restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29667a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29668domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29669.code
29670reject message = \
29671 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29672 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29673 dnslists = \
29674 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29675 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29676.endd
29677For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29678&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29679match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29680value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29681record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29682The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29683
29684If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29685given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29686the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29687.code
29688reject dnslists = \
29689 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29690 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29691 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29692 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29693.endd
29694In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29695values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29696done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29697
29698
29699
29700.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29701.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29702.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29703If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29704nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
297053ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29706.code
297071.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29708 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29709.endd
29710(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29711lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29712IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29713.code
29714*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29715.endd
29716is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29717Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29718
29719You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29720&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29721.code
29722deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29723 dnslists = some.list.example
29724.endd
29725
29726If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29727address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29728(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29729.code
29730 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29731.endd
29732
29733.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29734.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29735.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29736.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29737The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29738which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29739&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29740commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29741works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29742host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29743.display
29744&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29745.endd
29746If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29747period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29748
29749As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29750&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29751configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29752of &'p'&.
29753
29754The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29755time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29756means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29757parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29758send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29759in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29760constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29761changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29762both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29763
29764There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29765log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29766when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29767instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29768
29769The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29770sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29771retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29772which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29773By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29774of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29775user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29776&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29777example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29778authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29779
29780The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29781rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29782&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29783ACL.
29784
29785Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29786specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29787or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29788&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29789using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29790separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29791
29792Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29793any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29794stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29795remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29796remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29797behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29798the &%count=%& option.
29799
29800
29801.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29802.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29803The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29804normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29805&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29806
29807The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29808the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29809&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29810&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29811
29812The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29813the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29814in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29815used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29816in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29817follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29818in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29819
29820The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29821accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29822&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29823&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29824ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
29825in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29826recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29827
29828The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29829number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29830last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29831recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29832&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
29833
29834The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29835condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29836command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29837multiple different commands.
29838
29839The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29840measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29841&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29842increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29843other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29844
29845The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29846
29847
29848.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29849.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29850You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29851control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29852mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29853
29854If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29855previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29856
29857For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29858it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29859can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29860in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29861new rate.
29862.code
29863acl_check_connect:
29864 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29865 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29866 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29867# ...
29868acl_check_mail:
29869 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29870 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29871 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29872.endd
29873
29874If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29875processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29876it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29877in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29878same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29879multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29880checks.
29881
29882The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29883use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29884update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29885&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29886next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29887
29888
29889.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29890.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29891If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29892engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29893&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29894counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29895rest of the ACL.
29896
29897The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29898updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29899client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29900the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29901counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29902email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29903is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29904For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29905from getting any email through.
29906
29907The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29908updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29909of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29910actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29911counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29912pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29913again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29914attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29915.code
29916 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29917.endd
29918
29919
29920.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29921.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29922The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29923rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29924mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29925sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29926&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29927measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29928options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29929
29930For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29931has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29932rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29933per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29934go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29935recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29936
29937When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29938&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29939rate.
29940
29941The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29942other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29943unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29944required increases with larger limits.
29945
29946The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29947will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29948the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29949the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29950events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29951times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29952throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29953limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29954are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29955as intended.
29956
29957
29958.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29959Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29960when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29961(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29962policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29963message. For example:
29964.code
29965# Log all senders' rates
29966warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29967 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29968
29969# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29970# at the decimal point.
29971warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29972 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29973 $sender_rate_limit }s
29974
29975# Keep authenticated users under control
29976deny authenticated = *
29977 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29978
29979# System-wide rate limit
29980defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29981 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29982
29983# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29984# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29985defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29986 messages per $sender_rate_period
29987 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29988 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29989 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29990.endd
29991&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29992especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29993bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29994making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29995RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29996this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
29997hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
29998
29999
30000
30001.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
30002.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
30003.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
30004Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30005&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30006&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30007The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30008verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30009other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30010.code
30011verify = sender/callout
30012verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30013.endd
30014The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30015address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30016difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30017be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30018(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30019The available options are as follows:
30020
30021.ilist
30022If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30023remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30024check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30025.next
30026If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30027normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30028options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30029verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30030.next
30031The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30032discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30033.next
30034The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30035immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30036generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30037discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30038.endlist
30039
30040.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30041.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30042.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30043.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30044After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30045error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30046coding like this:
30047.code
30048warn !verify = sender
30049 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30050.endd
30051If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30052denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30053verification failure.
30054
30055In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30056appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30057
30058.ilist
30059&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30060was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30061.next
30062&%route%&: Routing failed.
30063.next
30064&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30065occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30066connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30067.next
30068&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30069.next
30070&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30071.endlist
30072
30073The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30074rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30075
30076
30077
30078
30079.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30080.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30081.cindex "callout" "verification"
30082.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30083For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30084checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30085the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30086&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30087a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30088address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30089sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30090deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30091sender's domain.
30092
30093Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30094request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30095described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30096lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30097cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30098caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30099
30100Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30101the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30102callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30103callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30104on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30105
30106If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30107second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30108one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30109&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30110router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30111&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30112&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30113supplies a host list.
30114Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30115
30116The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30117remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30118specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30119specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30120specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30121the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30122&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30123
30124For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30125test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30126following SMTP commands are sent:
30127.display
30128&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30129&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30130&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30131&`QUIT`&
30132.endd
30133LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30134set to &"lmtp"&.
30135
30136The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30137settings.
30138
30139A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30140for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30141the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30142that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30143do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30144&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30145
30146If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30147succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30148Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30149hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30150&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30151
30152.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30153A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30154output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30155clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30156disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30157
30158
30159
30160
30161.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30162.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30163The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30164optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30165.code
30166verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30167.endd
30168The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30169separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30170deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30171
30172
30173.vlist
30174.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30175.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30176This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30177For example:
30178.code
30179verify = sender/callout=5s
30180.endd
30181The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30182remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30183the &%connect%& parameter.
30184
30185
30186.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30187.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30188This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30189for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30190.code
30191verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30192.endd
30193If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30194
30195.vitem &*defer_ok*&
30196.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30197When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30198of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30199updated in this circumstance.
30200
30201.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30202.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30203This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30204&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30205accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30206unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30207
30208
30209.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30210.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30211When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30212verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30213sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30214whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30215MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30216as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30217(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30218address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30219.code
30220require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30221.endd
30222This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30223
30224
30225.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30226.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30227This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30228For example:
30229.code
30230verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30231.endd
30232This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30233commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30234be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30235very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30236(for example, when network connections are timing out).
30237
30238
30239.vitem &*no_cache*&
30240.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30241.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30242When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30243
30244.vitem &*postmaster*&
30245.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30246When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30247check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30248rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30249the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30250used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30251made, until the cache record expires.
30252
30253.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30254The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30255You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30256For example:
30257.code
30258require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30259.endd
30260If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30261one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30262.code
30263require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30264.endd
30265&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30266account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30267a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30268postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30269
30270
30271.vitem &*random*&
30272.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30273When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30274check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30275really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30276&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30277.code
30278$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30279.endd
30280The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30281parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30282specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30283a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30284succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30285
30286.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30287.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30288This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30289.code
30290deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30291.endd
30292.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30293It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30294performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30295that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30296domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30297
30298.vitem &*use_sender*&
30299This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30300.code
30301require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30302.endd
30303It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30304command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30305need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30306sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30307usefulness of callout caching.
30308.endlist
30309
30310If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30311command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30312&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30313usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30314that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30315Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30316these circumstances.
30317
30318However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30319host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30320callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30321sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30322callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30323own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30324is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30325
30326Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30327caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30328by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30329actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30330
30331
30332
30333
30334.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30335.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30336.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30337.cindex "caching" "callout"
30338Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30339used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30340option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30341different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30342a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30343entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30344
30345When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30346the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30347is not available.
30348
30349The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30350independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30351(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30352
30353If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30354commands up to and including
30355.code
30356MAIL FROM:<>
30357.endd
30358(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30359any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30360domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30361making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30362separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30363&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30364&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30365
30366Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30367cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30368Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30369ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30370will eventually be noticed.
30371
30372The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30373being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30374behaviour will be the same.
30375
30376
30377
30378.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30379.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30380See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30381verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30382failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30383relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30384you might see:
30385.code
30386MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30387250 OK
30388RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30389550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30390550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30391550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30392550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30393550 Sender verification failed
30394.endd
30395If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30396only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30397out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30398&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30399example:
30400.code
30401verify = sender/no_details
30402.endd
30403
30404.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30405.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30406.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30407A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30408during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30409or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30410it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30411
30412.ilist
30413When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30414continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30415verification also fails.
30416.next
30417When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30418verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30419.endlist
30420
30421This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30422way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30423example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30424.code
30425A.Wol: aw123
30426aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30427.endd
30428work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30429redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30430mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30431verification to succeed.
30432
30433It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30434redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30435generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30436option. For example:
30437.code
30438require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30439.endd
30440In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30441the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30442
30443When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30444redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30445also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30446address and a report is output for each of them.
30447
30448
30449
30450.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30451.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30452Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30453which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30454special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30455domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30456Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30457.code
30458verify = csa
30459.endd
30460This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30461valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30462succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30463&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30464&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30465be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30466
30467The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30468detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30469looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30470address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30471
30472.ilist
30473The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30474.next
30475The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30476.next
30477The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30478(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30479.next
30480The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30481that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30482.endlist
30483
30484The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30485use for the DNS query. The default is:
30486.code
30487verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30488.endd
30489This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30490is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30491address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30492the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30493meaningful to say:
30494.code
30495verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30496.endd
30497In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30498This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30499&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30500
30501If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30502is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30503making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30504using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30505default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30506default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30507(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30508of legitimate HELO domains.
30509
30510The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30511direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30512search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30513addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30514lookup such as:
30515.code
30516${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30517.endd
30518has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30519The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30520authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30521
30522
30523
30524
30525.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30526.cindex "BATV, verifying"
30527Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30528of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30529Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30530recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30531bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30532spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30533
30534There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30535&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30536the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30537address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30538item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30539The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30540&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30541
30542As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30543database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30544like this:
30545.code
30546PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30547 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30548 }{$value}}
30549.endd
30550Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30551list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30552use this:
30553.code
30554# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30555deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30556 senders = :
30557 recipients = +batv_senders
30558
30559# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30560deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30561 senders = :
30562 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30563 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30564 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30565.endd
30566The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30567to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30568send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30569recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30570the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30571
30572A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30573&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30574prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30575the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30576the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30577timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30578of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30579
30580There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30581you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30582deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30583router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30584.code
30585batv_redirect:
30586 driver = redirect
30587 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30588.endd
30589This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30590of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30591address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30592local addresses.
30593
30594To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30595can be used:
30596.code
30597external_smtp_batv:
30598 driver = smtp
30599 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30600 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30601 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30602 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30603 {$value}fail}}}
30604.endd
30605If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30606
30607
30608
30609.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30610.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30611.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30612.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30613An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30614delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30615within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30616passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30617.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30618but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30619
30620Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30621A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30622relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30623a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30624with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30625same host is fulfilling both functions,
30626. ///
30627. as illustrated in the diagram below,
30628. ///
30629but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30630not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30631system to arbitrary domains.
30632
30633
30634You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30635runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30636Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30637example, suppose you want to do the following:
30638
30639.ilist
30640Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30641locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30642&'my.dom2.example'&.
30643.next
30644Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30645These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30646.next
30647Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30648Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30649.endlist
30650
30651
30652In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30653.code
30654domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30655domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30656hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30657.endd
30658Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30659command:
30660.code
30661acl_check_rcpt:
30662 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30663 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30664.endd
30665The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30666the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30667statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30668hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30669than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30670default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30671in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30672
30673
30674
30675.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30676.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30677You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30678that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30679the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30680
30681For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30682&'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30683host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30684will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30685patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30686trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30687results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30688.ecindex IIDacl
30689
30690
30691
30692. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30693. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30694
30695.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30696.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30697The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30698as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30699was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30700maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30701specification.
30702
30703It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30704&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30705scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30706messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30707chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30708
30709If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30710Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30711&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30712
30713.ilist
30714Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30715for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30716.next
30717Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30718&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30719run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30720.next
30721An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30722of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30723.next
30724Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30725conditions.
30726.next
30727Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30728.endlist
30729
30730There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30731called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30732condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30733
30734Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30735added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30736changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30737EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30738this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30739&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30740
30741All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30742temporarily created in a file called:
30743.display
30744<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30745.endd
30746The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30747expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30748first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30749scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30750removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30751.code
30752control = no_mbox_unspool
30753.endd
30754has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30755same directory by default.
30756
30757
30758
30759.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30760.cindex "virus scanning"
30761.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30762.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30763The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30764It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30765specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30766in memory and thus are much faster.
30767
30768.new
30769A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
30770if it expires then a defer action is taken.
30771.wen
30772
30773.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30774You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
30775to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30776are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30777.display
30778&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30779.endd
30780If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30781.code
30782av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30783.endd
30784If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30785before use.
30786The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30787The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30788
30789.vlist
30790.new
30791.vitem &%avast%&
30792.cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
30793This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
30794Security (currenty at version 1.1.7).
30795You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
30796at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
30797This scanner type takes one option,
30798which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30799or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30800The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30801single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30802Any further options are given, on separate lines,
30803to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
30804For example:
30805.code
30806av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
30807av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
30808.endd
30809If you omit the argument, the default path
30810&_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
30811is used.
30812If you use a remote host,
30813you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
30814as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
30815For information about available commands and their options you may use
30816.code
30817$ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
30818 FLAGS
30819 SENSITIVITY
30820 PACK
30821.endd
30822.wen
30823
30824
30825.vitem &%aveserver%&
30826.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30827This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30828at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30829which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30830example:
30831.code
30832av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30833.endd
30834
30835
30836.vitem &%clamd%&
30837.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30838This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30839&url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30840unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30841in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
30842
30843The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
30844a UNIX socket specification,
30845a TCP socket specification,
30846or a (global) option.
30847
30848A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
30849For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
30850for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
30851and the second a port number,
30852Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
30853These per-server options are supported:
30854.code
30855retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
30856.endd
30857
30858The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
30859a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
30860
30861If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
30862
30863Examples:
30864.code
30865av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30866av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30867av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30868av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
30869av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30870.endd
30871If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
30872&`local`&
30873option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30874to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30875more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30876Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30877There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30878you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30879
30880The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30881randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30882that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30883socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30884unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30885When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30886not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30887selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30888email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30889.code
308902013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30891 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30892 (Connection refused)
30893.endd
30894
30895If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30896contributing the code for this scanner.
30897
30898.vitem &%cmdline%&
30899.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30900This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30901used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30902type takes 3 mandatory options:
30903
30904.olist
30905The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30906and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30907
30908.next
30909A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30910virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30911absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30912the &"trigger"& expression.
30913
30914.next
30915Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30916match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30917&"name"& expression.
30918.endlist olist
30919
30920For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30921.code
30922Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30923.endd
30924For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30925name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30926for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30927configuration setting:
30928.code
30929av_scanner = cmdline:\
30930 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30931 found in file:'(.+)'
30932.endd
30933.vitem &%drweb%&
30934.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30935The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
30936takes one option,
30937either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30938or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30939The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30940single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30941For example:
30942.code
30943av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30944av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30945.endd
30946If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30947is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30948
30949.vitem &%f-protd%&
30950.cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
30951The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
30952One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
30953(or port-range).
30954For example:
30955.code
30956av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
30957.endd
30958If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
30959
30960.vitem &%fsecure%&
30961.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30962The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30963argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30964.code
30965av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30966.endd
30967If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30968Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30969
30970.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30971.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30972This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30973Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30974scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30975For example:
30976.code
30977av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30978.endd
30979The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30980
30981.vitem &%mksd%&
30982.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30983This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30984parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30985&url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30986the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30987provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30988been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30989.code
30990av_scanner = mksd:2
30991.endd
30992You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30993
30994.vitem &%sock%&
30995.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30996This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30997running on the local machine.
30998There are four options:
30999an address (which may be an IP addres and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
31000a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
31001the path to the mail file to be scanned),
31002an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
31003an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
31004For example:
31005.code
31006av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
31007.endd
31008Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
31009Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
31010Both regular-expressions are required.
31011
31012.vitem &%sophie%&
31013.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31014Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31015You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31016for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31017client communication. For example:
31018.code
31019av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31020.endd
31021The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31022the option.
31023.endlist
31024
31025When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31026the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31027ACL.
31028
31029The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31030makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31031The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31032for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31033However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31034which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31035message.
31036
31037The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31038.new
31039use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31040.wen
31041The first element can then be one of
31042
31043.ilist
31044&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31045The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31046recommended usage.
31047.next
31048&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31049the condition fails immediately.
31050.next
31051A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31052condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31053expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31054.new
31055Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31056unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31057.wen
31058.endlist
31059
31060You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31061messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31062Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31063
31064.new
31065You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31066specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31067For example:
31068.code
31069malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31070.endd
31071A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31072.wen
31073
31074.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31075When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31076&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31077&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31078logging data.
31079
31080If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
31081use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
31082&%malware%& condition.
31083
31084Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31085imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31086
31087Here is a very simple scanning example:
31088.code
31089deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31090 demime = *
31091 malware = *
31092.endd
31093The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31094.code
31095deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31096 demime = *
31097 malware = */defer_ok
31098.endd
31099The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31100aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31101.code
31102av_scanner = $acl_m0
31103.endd
31104in the main Exim configuration.
31105.code
31106deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31107 set acl_m0 = sophie
31108 malware = *
31109
31110deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31111 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31112 malware = *
31113.endd
31114
31115
31116.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31117.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31118.cindex "spam scanning"
31119.cindex "SpamAssassin"
31120.cindex "Rspamd"
31121The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31122score and a report for the message.
31123.new
31124Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31125
31126For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31127Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31128&url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31129.wen
31130
31131SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31132.code
31133perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31134.endd
31135SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31136documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31137nicely, however.
31138
31139.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31140By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31141intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31142&%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31143you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31144configuration as follows (example):
31145.code
31146spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31147.endd
31148
31149.new
31150To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31151on TCP port 11333)
31152you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31153.code
31154spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31155.endd
31156.wen
31157
31158As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31159sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31160file name instead of an address/port pair:
31161.code
31162spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31163.endd
31164You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31165reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31166&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31167option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31168.code
31169spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31170 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31171 192.168.2.12 783
31172.endd
31173Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31174When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31175servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31176condition defers.
31177
31178.new
31179Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31180Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31181and changeable in the usual way.
31182
31183For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31184subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31185and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31186In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31187
31188Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31189are options.
31190The supported option are:
31191.code
31192pri=<priority> Selection priority
31193weight=<value> Selection bias
31194time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31195retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31196tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31197variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31198.endd
31199
31200The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31201higher values being tried first.
31202The deafult priority is 1.
31203
31204The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31205Within a priority set
31206servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31207The default value for selection bias is 1.
31208
31209Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31210in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31211Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31212characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31213
31214Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31215are the usual Exim time interval standard, eg. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31216
31217The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31218The default value is two minutes.
31219
31220The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31221a failed connect is made.
31222The default is to not retry.
31223.wen
31224
31225The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31226a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31227used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31228expansion.
31229
31230.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31231Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31232.code
31233deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31234 spam = joe
31235.endd
31236The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31237relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31238to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31239default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31240.new
31241Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31242right-hand side.
31243.wen
31244
31245The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31246principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31247have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31248&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31249read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31250are not set.
31251.new
31252Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31253(eg. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31254after the first),
31255or the use of PRDR,
31256.cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31257are needed to use this feature.
31258.wen
31259
31260The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31261you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31262&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31263
31264
31265Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31266large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31267are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31268example:
31269.code
31270deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31271 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31272 spam = nobody
31273.endd
31274
31275The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31276SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31277&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31278it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31279
31280.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31281When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31282variables.
31283.new
31284Except for &$spam_report$&,
31285.wen
31286these variables are saved with the received message so are
31287available for use at delivery time.
31288
31289.vlist
31290.vitem &$spam_score$&
31291The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31292for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31293
31294.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31295The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31296example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31297because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31298The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31299
31300.vitem &$spam_bar$&
31301A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31302integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31303&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31304headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
31305
31306.vitem &$spam_report$&
31307A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31308message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31309.new
31310This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31311.wen
31312
31313.new
31314.vitem &$spam_action$&
31315For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31316spam score versus threshold.
31317For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31318.wen
31319
31320.endlist
31321
31322The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31323spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31324does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31325
31326The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31327the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31328failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31329statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31330spam condition, like this:
31331.code
31332deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31333 spam = joe/defer_ok
31334.endd
31335This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31336
31337Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31338condition:
31339.code
31340# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31341warn spam = nobody:true
31342 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31343 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31344
31345# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31346# is over threshold
31347warn spam = nobody
31348 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31349
31350# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31351deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31352 spam = nobody:true
31353 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31354.endd
31355
31356
31357
31358.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31359.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31360.cindex "MIME content scanning"
31361.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31362.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31363The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31364each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31365of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31366specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31367options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31368cases.
31369
31370These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31371ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31372the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31373message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31374ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31375result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31376&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31377
31378You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31379only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31380condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31381&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31382&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31383
31384At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31385information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31386of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31387parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31388part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31389syntax is:
31390.display
31391&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31392.endd
31393The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31394the value can be:
31395
31396.olist
31397&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31398.next
31399The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31400&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31401a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31402full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31403.next
31404A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31405directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31406is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31407the full path and file name.
31408.next
31409If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31410filename, and the default path is then used.
31411.endlist
31412The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31413errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31414a file with its original, proposed filename using
31415.code
31416decode = $mime_filename
31417.endd
31418However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31419anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31420automatically unlinked.
31421
31422For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31423content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31424as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31425variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31426before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31427
31428The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31429used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31430respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31431
31432.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31433The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31434available in the MIME ACL:
31435
31436.vlist
31437.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31438If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31439have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31440has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31441contains the empty string.
31442
31443.vitem &$mime_charset$&
31444This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31445&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31446.code
31447us-ascii
31448gb2312 (Chinese)
31449iso-8859-1
31450.endd
31451Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31452case-insensitively.
31453
31454.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31455This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31456header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31457implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31458only used for display purposes.
31459
31460.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31461This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31462header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31463
31464.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31465This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31466This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31467
31468.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31469This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31470successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31471size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31472has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31473
31474.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31475This variable contains the normalized content of the
31476&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31477type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31478
31479.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31480If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31481value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31482are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31483.code
31484text/plain
31485text/html
31486application/octet-stream
31487image/jpeg
31488audio/midi
31489.endd
31490If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31491empty string.
31492
31493.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31494This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31495successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31496containing the decoded data.
31497.endlist
31498
31499.cindex "RFC 2047"
31500.vlist
31501.vitem &$mime_filename$&
31502This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31503proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31504&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31505RFC2047
31506.new
31507or RFC2231
31508.wen
31509decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31510 If no filename was
31511found, this variable contains the empty string.
31512
31513.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31514This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31515attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31516content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31517
31518The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31519cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31520follows:
31521
31522.olist
31523The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31524
31525.next
31526If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31527so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31528
31529.next
31530If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31531and the rest are attachments.
31532
31533.next
31534All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31535.endlist olist
31536
31537As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31538alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31539coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31540.code
31541deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31542!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31543condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31544condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31545.endd
31546.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31547This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31548&"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31549Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31550want to carry out specific actions on them.
31551
31552.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31553This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31554checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31555decoding is fully recursive.
31556
31557.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31558This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31559starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31560counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31561&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31562complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31563parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31564.endlist
31565
31566
31567
31568.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31569.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31570.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31571You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31572the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31573
31574The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31575matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31576MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31577linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31578have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31579
31580The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31581to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31582part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31583is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31584and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3158532K characters are checked.
31586
31587The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31588literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31589expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31590with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31591Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31592.code
31593deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31594 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31595.endd
31596The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31597&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31598matching regular expression.
31599
31600&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31601CPU-intensive.
31602
31603
31604
31605
31606.section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31607.cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31608.cindex "MIME content scanning"
31609The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31610extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31611&%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31612ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31613condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31614the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31615use the &%demime%& condition.
31616
31617The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31618errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31619against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31620parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31621scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31622antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31623
31624On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31625colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31626example:
31627.code
31628deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31629 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31630.endd
31631If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31632false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31633full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31634the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31635
31636The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31637conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31638zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31639
31640The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31641
31642.vlist
31643.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31644.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31645When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31646severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31647severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31648zero, no error occurred.
31649
31650.vitem &$demime_reason$&
31651.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31652When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31653human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31654.endlist
31655
31656.vlist
31657.vitem &$found_extension$&
31658.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31659When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31660extension it found.
31661.endlist
31662
31663Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31664the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31665
31666If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31667condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31668right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31669facility:
31670.code
31671# Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31672deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31673 demime = *
31674 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31675
31676# Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31677# Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31678deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31679 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31680
31681# Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31682# examine them and eventually thaw them.
31683deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31684 demime = exe:doc
31685 control = freeze
31686.endd
31687.ecindex IIDcosca
31688
31689
31690
31691
31692. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31693. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31694
31695.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31696 "Local scan function"
31697.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31698.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31699.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31700In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31701want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31702
31703The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31704passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31705a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31706condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31707non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31708
31709To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31710possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31711in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31712can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31713
31714The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31715when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31716It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31717well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31718
31719Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31720option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31721Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31722Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31723before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31724are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31725incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31726For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31727code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31728
31729
31730
31731.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31732.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31733To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31734function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31735&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31736directory, so you might set
31737.code
31738LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31739.endd
31740for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31741Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31742be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31743function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31744commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31745_src/local_scan.c_.
31746
31747If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31748for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31749.code
31750LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31751.endd
31752in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31753
31754
31755
31756
31757.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31758.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31759You must include this line near the start of your code:
31760.code
31761#include "local_scan.h"
31762.endd
31763This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31764prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31765almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31766for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31767It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31768strings and pointers to character strings:
31769.code
31770#define CS (char *)
31771#define CCS (const char *)
31772#define CSS (char **)
31773#define US (unsigned char *)
31774#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31775#define USS (unsigned char **)
31776.endd
31777The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31778.code
31779extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31780.endd
31781The arguments are as follows:
31782
31783.ilist
31784&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31785(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31786recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31787
31788The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31789character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31790id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31791macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31792case this changes in some future version.
31793.next
31794&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31795string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31796.endlist
31797
31798The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31799
31800.vlist
31801.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31802.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31803The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31804the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31805newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31806maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31807
31808.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31809This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31810queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31811
31812.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31813This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31814queued without immediate delivery.
31815
31816.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31817The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31818passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31819they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31820&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31821used.
31822
31823.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31824The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31825message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31826problem"& is used.
31827
31828.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31829This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31830message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31831&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31832&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31833&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31834same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31835
31836.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31837This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31838LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31839.endlist
31840
31841If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31842reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31843&%-oe%& command line options.
31844
31845
31846
31847.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31848.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31849It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31850that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31851want to do this, you must have the line
31852.code
31853LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31854.endd
31855in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31856&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31857file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31858to define them.
31859
31860The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31861&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31862and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31863alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31864variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31865entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31866.code
31867static int my_integer_option = 42;
31868static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31869
31870optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31871 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31872 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31873};
31874
31875int local_scan_options_count =
31876 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31877.endd
31878The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31879configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31880.code
31881begin local_scan
31882my_integer = 99
31883my_string = some string of text...
31884.endd
31885The available types of option data are as follows:
31886
31887.vlist
31888.vitem &*opt_bool*&
31889This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31890variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31891that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31892whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31893TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31894values.)
31895
31896.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31897This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31898The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31899multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31900
31901.vitem &*opt_int*&
31902This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31903&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31904Exim.
31905
31906.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31907This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31908&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31909printed with the suffix K or M.
31910
31911.vitem &*opt_octint*&
31912This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31913octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31914always output in octal.
31915
31916.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31917This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31918variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31919
31920.vitem &*opt_time*&
31921This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31922type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31923.endlist
31924
31925If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31926out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31927
31928
31929
31930.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31931.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31932The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31933are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31934Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31935including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31936C variables are as follows:
31937
31938.vlist
31939.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31940This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31941
31942.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31943This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31944
31945.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31946This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31947is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31948&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31949
31950.ilist
31951The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31952testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31953other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31954
31955.next
31956The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31957by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31958of debugging bits.
31959.endlist ilist
31960
31961Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31962selected, you should use code like this:
31963.code
31964if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31965 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31966.endd
31967.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31968After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31969variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31970
31971.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31972A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31973discussed below.
31974
31975.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31976A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31977
31978.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31979The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31980
31981.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31982This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31983&%-bh%& command line option.
31984
31985.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31986The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31987is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31988
31989.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31990The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31991command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31992specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31993
31994.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31995This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31996&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31997
31998.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31999The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32000
32001.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32002The number of accepted recipients.
32003
32004.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32005.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32006.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32007The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32008&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32009can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32010below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32011adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32012&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32013value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32014blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32015and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32016
32017.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32018The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32019
32020.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32021The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32022locally-submitted messages.
32023
32024.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32025The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32026was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32027
32028.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32029The name of the sending host, if known.
32030
32031.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32032The port on the sending host.
32033
32034.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32035This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32036
32037.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32038This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32039
32040.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32041The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32042requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32043.endlist
32044
32045
32046.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32047The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32048You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32049(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32050their type to *.
32051
32052
32053.vlist
32054.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32055A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32056
32057.vitem &*int&~type*&
32058A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32059characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32060Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32061with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32062rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32063lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32064
32065.vitem &*int&~slen*&
32066The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32067internal newlines.
32068
32069.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32070A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32071a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32072.endlist
32073
32074
32075
32076.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32077The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32078
32079.vlist
32080.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32081This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32082
32083.vitem &*int&~pno*&
32084This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32085the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32086and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32087
32088.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32089If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32090recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32091envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32092router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32093an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32094&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32095is NULL for all recipients.
32096.endlist
32097
32098
32099
32100.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32101.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32102The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32103These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32104release:
32105
32106.vlist
32107.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32108 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32109
32110This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32111&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32112be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32113for the process in &%newumask%&.
32114
32115Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32116and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32117standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32118descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32119argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32120
32121The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32122
32123.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32124This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32125seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32126return value is as follows:
32127
32128.ilist
32129>= 0
32130
32131The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32132ending status.
32133
32134.next
32135< 0 and > &--256
32136
32137The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32138signal number.
32139
32140.next
32141&--256
32142
32143The process timed out.
32144.next
32145&--257
32146
32147The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32148.endlist
32149
32150.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32151This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32152Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32153want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32154forks a subprocess that is running
32155.code
32156exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32157.endd
32158and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32159that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32160of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32161recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32162
32163When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32164finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32165fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32166addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32167
32168
32169.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32170 *sender_authentication)*&
32171This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32172that it runs is:
32173.display
32174&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32175.endd
32176The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32177
32178
32179.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32180This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32181output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32182calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32183conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32184.code
32185if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32186 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32187.endd
32188
32189.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32190This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32191expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32192The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32193expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32194the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32195block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32196&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32197
32198.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32199This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32200existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32201character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32202substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32203if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32204
32205.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32206 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32207This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32208chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32209
32210If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32211&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32212NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32213matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32214&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32215found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32216marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32217option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32218top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32219headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32220.code
32221header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32222 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32223.endd
32224Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32225there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32226
32227
32228.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32229This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32230occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32231particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32232match the specification, the function does nothing.
32233
32234
32235.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32236 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32237This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32238a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32239colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32240&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32241.code
32242if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32243.endd
32244.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32245.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32246This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32247The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32248back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32249zero-terminated.
32250
32251.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32252This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32253zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32254to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32255string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32256yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32257easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32258added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32259
32260.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32261This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32262matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32263.display
32264&`OK `& match succeeded
32265&`FAIL `& match failed
32266&`DEFER `& match deferred
32267.endd
32268DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32269inability to contact a database.
32270
32271.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32272 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32273This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32274controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32275&'lss_match_domain()'&.
32276
32277.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32278 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32279This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32280controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32281matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32282
32283.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32284 uschar&~*list)*&"
32285This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32286expected to be
32287.code
32288lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32289.endd
32290.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32291An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32292is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32293looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32294values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32295returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32296failed.
32297
32298.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32299 *format,&~...)*&"
32300This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32301is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32302&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32303them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32304arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32305contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32306
32307
32308.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32309This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32310is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32311with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32312
32313This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32314described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32315the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32316value afterwards. For example:
32317.code
32318 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32319 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32320 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32321.endd
32322
32323.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32324This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32325recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32326matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32327address.
32328.endlist
32329
32330
32331.cindex "RFC 2047"
32332.vlist
32333.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32334 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32335This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32336these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32337from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32338a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32339made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32340binary string is returned with an error message.
32341
32342The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32343maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32344encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32345
32346.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32347.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32348If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32349contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32350not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32351
32352The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32353&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32354which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32355
32356If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32357argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32358set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32359returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32360with translation.
32361
32362
32363.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32364This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32365below.
32366
32367.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32368The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32369output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32370stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32371SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32372is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32373opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32374test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32375is involved.
32376
32377If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32378output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32379
32380Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32381must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32382LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32383LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32384initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32385to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32386that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32387.code
32388smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32389return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32390.endd
32391Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32392the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32393&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32394multiple output lines.
32395
32396The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32397does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32398the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32399detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32400you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32401dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32402arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32403is an error.
32404
32405.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32406This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32407chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32408runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32409
32410.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32411This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32412permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32413
32414.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32415See below.
32416
32417.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32418See below.
32419
32420.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32421These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32422The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32423number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32424and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32425pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32426more discussion.
32427.endlist
32428
32429
32430
32431.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32432.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32433No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32434The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32435recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32436to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32437message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32438terminates.
32439
32440Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32441data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32442connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32443one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32444
32445If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32446in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32447.code
32448store_pool = POOL_PERM
32449.endd
32450before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32451restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32452the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32453set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32454
32455The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32456&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32457There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32458block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32459&%store_pool%&.
32460.ecindex IIDlosca
32461
32462
32463
32464
32465. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32466. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32467
32468.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32469.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32470.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32471.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32472The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32473that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32474also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32475they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32476
32477The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32478is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32479It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32480commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32481The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32482
32483The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32484is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32485the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32486If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32487of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32488prevent it happening on retries.
32489
32490.vindex "&$domain$&"
32491.vindex "&$local_part$&"
32492&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32493specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32494&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32495you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32496independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32497described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32498
32499
32500.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32501.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32502.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32503The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32504setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32505other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32506&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32507.code
32508system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32509system_filter_user = exim
32510.endd
32511If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32512&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32513specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32514&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32515&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32516by the &%reply%& command.
32517
32518
32519.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32520You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32521filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32522are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32523
32524If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32525you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32526
32527
32528
32529.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32530The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32531files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32532mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32533available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32534If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32535they cause errors.
32536
32537.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32538There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32539files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32540is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32541&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32542subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32543manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32544
32545&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32546specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32547succeed, it will not be tried again.
32548If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32549arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32550
32551When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32552&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32553users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32554to which users' filter files can refer.
32555
32556
32557
32558.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32559.vindex "&$recipients$&"
32560The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32561of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32562filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32563
32564
32565
32566.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32567.cindex "freezing messages"
32568.cindex "message" "freezing"
32569.cindex "message" "forced failure"
32570.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32571.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32572.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32573There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32574always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32575filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32576for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32577word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32578.code
32579fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32580.endd
32581The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32582
32583The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32584message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32585and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32586delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32587that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32588run.
32589
32590The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32591not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32592filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32593is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32594
32595.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32596.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32597The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32598well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32599up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32600log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32601two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32602strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32603message. For example:
32604.code
32605fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32606 because it contains attachments that we are \
32607 not prepared to receive."
32608.endd
32609
32610.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32611Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32612the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32613the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32614command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32615Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32616use, for example
32617.code
32618if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32619then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32620.endd
32621though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32622alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32623generated by the filter.
32624
32625The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32626&%defer%&,
32627&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32628set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32629as
32630.code
32631mail ...
32632freeze
32633.endd
32634to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32635failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32636take place.
32637
32638
32639
32640.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32641.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32642.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32643.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32644Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32645.code
32646headers add <string>
32647headers remove <string>
32648.endd
32649The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32650added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32651filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32652space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32653forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32654
32655You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32656continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32657including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32658example:
32659.code
32660headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32661 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32662 X-header-2: ...."
32663.endd
32664Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32665be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32666space after input continuations is ignored.
32667
32668The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32669This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32670those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32671&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32672header with the same name, they are all removed.
32673
32674The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32675of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32676from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32677modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32678Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32679used for all recipients of the message.
32680
32681During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32682header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32683that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32684routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32685routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32686until the message is actually being written (see section
32687&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32688
32689If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32690added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32691present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32692present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32693message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32694conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32695modified more than once.
32696
32697Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32698use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32699For example:
32700.code
32701headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32702headers remove "Subject"
32703headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32704headers remove "Old-Subject"
32705.endd
32706
32707
32708
32709.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32710.cindex "envelope sender"
32711In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32712.code
32713errors_to <some address>
32714.endd
32715in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32716delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32717user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32718might use
32719.code
32720unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32721.endd
32722to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32723address if its delivery failed.
32724
32725
32726
32727.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32728.vindex "&$domain$&"
32729.vindex "&$local_part$&"
32730In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32731delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32732operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32733such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32734filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32735which implements such a filter:
32736.code
32737central_filter:
32738 check_local_user
32739 driver = redirect
32740 domains = +local_domains
32741 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32742 no_verify
32743 allow_filter
32744 allow_freeze
32745.endd
32746The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32747&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32748the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32749use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32750
32751Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32752specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32753its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32754address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32755normal way.
32756.ecindex IIDsysfil1
32757.ecindex IIDsysfil2
32758.ecindex IIDsysfil3
32759
32760
32761
32762
32763
32764
32765. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32766. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32767
32768.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32769.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32770Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32771all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32772these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32773this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32774removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32775before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32776
32777Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32778&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32779that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32780its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32781set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32782
32783&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32784or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32785loopback interface specially in any way.
32786
32787If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32788that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32789
32790
32791
32792
32793.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32794.cindex "message" "submission"
32795.cindex "submission mode"
32796Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32797&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32798received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32799state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32800.code
32801control = submission
32802.endd
32803in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32804&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32805a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32806known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32807example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32808interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32809.code
32810warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32811 control = submission
32812.endd
32813.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32814There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32815is used to separate options. For example:
32816.code
32817control = submission/sender_retain
32818.endd
32819Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32820true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32821of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32822the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32823authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32824&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32825attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32826
32827When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32828domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32829example:
32830.code
32831control = submission/domain=some.domain
32832.endd
32833The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32834&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32835that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32836&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32837.code
32838accept authenticated = *
32839 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32840 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32841 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32842.endd
32843Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32844option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32845the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32846.code
32847bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32848.endd
32849then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32850line would be:
32851.code
32852Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32853.endd
32854.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32855By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32856used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32857specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32858
32859&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32860ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32861untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32862specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32863does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32864spoof another's address.
32865
32866.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32867.cindex "line endings"
32868.cindex "carriage return"
32869.cindex "linefeed"
32870RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32871linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32872SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32873conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32874use CRLF or just CR.
32875
32876Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32877using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32878receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32879Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32880MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32881has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32882that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32883other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32884follows:
32885
32886.ilist
32887LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32888.next
32889CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32890is ignored.
32891.next
32892The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32893nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32894terminator.
32895.next
32896If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32897the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32898is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32899people trying to play silly games.
32900.next
32901If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32902bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32903line.
32904.endlist
32905
32906
32907
32908
32909
32910.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32911.cindex "unqualified addresses"
32912.cindex "address" "qualification"
32913By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32914host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32915SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32916messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32917requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32918
32919Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32920sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32921&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32922cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32923value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32924
32925.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32926.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32927Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32928that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32929line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32930are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32931other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32932&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32933
32934
32935
32936
32937.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32938.cindex "&""From""& line"
32939.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32940.cindex "sender" "address"
32941.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32942.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32943.cindex "envelope sender"
32944.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32945Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32946with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32947&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32948.code
32949From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32950From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32951.endd
32952This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32953Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32954via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32955such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32956&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32957and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32958regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32959default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32960that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32961
32962.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32963When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32964a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32965contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32966then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32967qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32968the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32969
32970If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32971sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32972that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32973
32974Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32975treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32976as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32977incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32978
32979
32980
32981.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32982.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32983RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32984&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32985recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32986&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32987&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32988
32989.blockquote
32990&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32991processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32992.endblockquote
32993
32994This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32995address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32996follows:
32997
32998.ilist
32999A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33000is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33001.next
33002If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33003&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33004&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33005.next
33006For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33007also removed.
33008.next
33009For a locally-submitted message,
33010if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33011&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33012the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33013included in log lines in this case.
33014.next
33015The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33016&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33017.endlist
33018
33019
33020
33021
33022.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33023Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33024includes the header line:
33025.code
33026Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33027.endd
33028
33029.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33030.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33031If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33032message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33033extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33034existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33035
33036
33037.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33038.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33039If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33040Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33041&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33042
33043.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33044.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33045.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33046&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33047set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33048the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33049in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33050set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33051messages.
33052
33053
33054.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33055.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33056.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33057&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33058Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33059generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33060messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33061(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33062messages.
33063
33064
33065.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33066.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33067.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33068.cindex "message" "submission"
33069.cindex "submission mode"
33070If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33071adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33072
33073.ilist
33074The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33075message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33076.next
33077.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33078The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33079.olist
33080.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33081If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33082&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33083.next
33084If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33085part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33086.next
33087If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33088&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33089.endlist
33090.endlist
33091
33092A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33093
33094If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33095line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33096containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33097are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33098They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33099&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33100&%qualify_domain%&.
33101
33102For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33103&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33104user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33105name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33106
33107
33108.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33109.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33110.cindex "message" "submission"
33111.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33112If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33113&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33114&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33115to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33116creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33117message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33118followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33119in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33120&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33121
33122
33123.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33124.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33125A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33126contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33127Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33128
33129The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33130have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33131line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33132that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33133
33134Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33135changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33136-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33137
33138
33139.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33140.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33141Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33142header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33143section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33144header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33145responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33146processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33147than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33148incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3314911 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33150
33151
33152
33153.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33154.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33155.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33156&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33157it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33158transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33159transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33160default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33161
33162
33163
33164.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33165.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33166.cindex "message" "submission"
33167For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33168existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33169these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33170&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33171control setting.
33172
33173When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33174&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33175control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33176&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33177that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33178&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33179be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33180appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33181line is added to the message.
33182
33183If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33184the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33185&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33186options true at the same time.
33187
33188.cindex "submission mode"
33189By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33190received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33191a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33192not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33193
33194.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33195First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33196authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33197created as follows:
33198
33199.ilist
33200.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33201If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33202&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33203.next
33204If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33205is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33206.next
33207If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33208&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33209.endlist
33210
33211This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33212are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33213added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33214by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33215
33216.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33217&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33218the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33219except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33220
33221
33222
33223.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33224 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33225.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33226.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33227When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33228specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33229process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33230modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33231as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33232
33233In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33234specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33235addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33236changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33237transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33238they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33239
33240&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33241the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33242expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33243
33244For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33245option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33246newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33247.code
33248headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33249 X-added-second: another added header line
33250.endd
33251Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33252
33253Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33254specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33255Each header-line is separately expanded.
33256
33257The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33258list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33259often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33260not part of the names. For example:
33261.code
33262headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33263.endd
33264
33265Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33266specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33267Each item is separately expanded.
33268Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33269form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33270will act as list separators.
33271
33272When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33273items are expanded at routing time,
33274and then associated with all addresses that are
33275accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33276an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33277forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33278
33279.oindex "&%unseen%&"
33280However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33281the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33282&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33283
33284Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33285settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33286dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33287requirements.
33288
33289The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33290with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33291these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33292recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33293consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33294names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33295instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33296
33297After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33298lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33299the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33300header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33301
33302This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33303the following consequences:
33304
33305.ilist
33306The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33307remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33308to it, at all times.
33309.next
33310Header lines that are added by a router's
33311&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33312expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33313.next
33314Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33315in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33316.next
33317Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33318a later router or by a transport.
33319.next
33320An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33321removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33322.code
33323headers_remove = subject
33324headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33325.endd
33326.endlist
33327
33328&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33329for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33330
33331
33332
33333
33334
33335.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33336.cindex "address" "constructed"
33337.cindex "constructed address"
33338When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33339the form
33340.display
33341<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33342.endd
33343For example:
33344.code
33345Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33346.endd
33347The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33348otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33349&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33350ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33351upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33352&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33353The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33354there is no password file entry.
33355
33356.cindex "RFC 2047"
33357In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33358parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33359characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33360including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33361&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33362characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33363&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33364is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33365
33366
33367
33368.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33369.cindex "case of local parts"
33370.cindex "local part" "case of"
33371RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33372be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33373addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33374because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33375routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33376original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33377router option.
33378
33379.cindex "mixed-case login names"
33380If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33381assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33382your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33383correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33384.code
33385correct_case:
33386 driver = redirect
33387 domains = +local_domains
33388 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33389 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33390 @$domain
33391.endd
33392For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33393(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33394up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33395on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33396local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33397
33398
33399
33400.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33401.cindex "dot" "in local part"
33402.cindex "local part" "dots in"
33403RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33404part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33405middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33406empty components for compatibility.
33407
33408
33409
33410.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33411.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33412Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33413happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33414in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33415&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33416
33417Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33418in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33419routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33420example, a header such as
33421.code
33422To: hare@teaparty
33423.endd
33424might get rewritten as
33425.code
33426To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33427.endd
33428Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33429does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33430been routed.
33431
33432Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33433addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33434result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33435deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33436immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33437routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33438.ecindex IIDmesproc
33439
33440
33441
33442. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33443. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33444
33445.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33446.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33447.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33448Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33449LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33450closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33451processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33452
33453.ilist
33454SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33455.next
33456SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33457.next
33458Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33459.endlist
33460
33461For mail delivery, the following are available:
33462
33463.ilist
33464SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33465.next
33466LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33467&"lmtp"&);
33468.next
33469LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33470transport);
33471.next
33472Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33473the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33474.endlist
33475
33476&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33477stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33478used to contain the envelope information.
33479
33480
33481
33482.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33483.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33484.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33485.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33486.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33487.cindex "EHLO"
33488.cindex "HELO"
33489.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33490Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33491The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33492processing is the same in both cases.
33493
33494If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33495parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33496command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33497&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33498such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33499.cindex "transport" "filter"
33500.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33501transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33502suppressed.
33503
33504If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33505pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33506required for the transaction.
33507
33508If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33509was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33510server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33511Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33512is called for verification.
33513
33514If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33515the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33516in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33517
33518.cindex "carriage return"
33519.cindex "linefeed"
33520Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33521LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33522order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33523line terminator.
33524
33525If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33526characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33527same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33528even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33529of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33530they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33531each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33532in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33533significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33534
33535When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33536message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33537records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33538particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33539
33540.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33541Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33542a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33543See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33544
33545.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33546.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33547When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33548looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33549messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33550creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33551a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33552so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33553does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33554turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33555
33556The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33557limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33558
33559.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33560The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33561identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33562square bracket of the IP address.
33563
33564
33565
33566
33567.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33568.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33569.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33570.cindex "host" "error"
33571Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33572message errors, and recipient errors.
33573
33574.vlist
33575.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33576A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33577particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33578
33579.ilist
33580Connection refused or timed out,
33581.next
33582Any error response code on connection,
33583.next
33584Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33585.next
33586Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33587.next
33588I/O errors at any time,
33589.next
33590Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33591the &"."& at the end of the data.
33592.endlist ilist
33593
33594For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33595EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33596error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33597host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33598the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33599alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33600host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33601made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33602
33603.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33604.cindex "message" "error"
33605A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33606particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33607message errors are:
33608
33609.ilist
33610Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33611the data,
33612.next
33613Timeout after MAIL,
33614.next
33615Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33616timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33617connection at any other time.
33618.endlist ilist
33619
33620For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33621to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33622temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33623addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33624a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33625message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33626that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33627time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33628affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33629it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33630
33631If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33632to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33633over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33634response to MAIL.
33635
33636.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33637.cindex "recipient" "error"
33638A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33639recipient errors are:
33640
33641.ilist
33642Any error response to RCPT,
33643.next
33644Timeout after RCPT.
33645.endlist
33646
33647For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33648recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33649sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33650address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33651used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33652routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33653operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33654to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33655if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33656(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33657have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33658the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33659the retry clock is reset.
33660
33661The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33662host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33663other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33664in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33665proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33666than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33667if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33668through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33669recipient's retry time.
33670.endlist
33671
33672In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33673current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33674tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33675own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33676until the next delivery attempt.
33677
33678Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33679MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33680would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33681host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33682What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33683is created.
33684
33685The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33686these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33687procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33688response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33689it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33690message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33691helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33692
33693Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33694host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33695or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33696the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33697then to be treated as a host error.
33698
33699There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33700terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33701reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33702should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33703host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33704
33705
33706
33707
33708.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33709.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33710.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33711.cindex "inetd"
33712.cindex "daemon"
33713Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33714listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33715&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33716.code
33717smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33718.endd
33719Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33720agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33721a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33722the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33723with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33724stream and exits with an error code.
33725
33726By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33727disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33728unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33729&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33730
33731.cindex "carriage return"
33732.cindex "linefeed"
33733Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33734LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33735order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33736line terminator.
33737Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33738sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33739sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33740
33741.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33742.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33743One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33744HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33745commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33746the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33747Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33748match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33749
33750.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33751.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33752The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33753a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33754&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33755false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33756&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33757value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33758message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33759
33760When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33761its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33762logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33763
33764The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33765prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33766number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33767&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33768rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33769
33770The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33771subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33772for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33773things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33774processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33775sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33776it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33777
33778When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33779and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33780high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33781&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33782applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33783
33784Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33785can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33786&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33787number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33788SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33789&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33790subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33791a delivery process.
33792
33793The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33794&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33795started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33796handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33797however, available with &'inetd'&.
33798
33799Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33800are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33801to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33802section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33803
33804Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33805MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33806&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33807
33808
33809
33810.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33811.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33812If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33813commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33814the error response to the last command. The default value for
33815&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33816abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33817circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33818
33819
33820.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33821.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33822.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33823A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33824something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33825address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33826sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33827&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33828drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33829default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33830broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33831
33832
33833
33834.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33835.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33836The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33837DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33838many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33839denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33840client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33841defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33842
33843When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33844allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33845but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33846or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33847starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33848counted.
33849
33850The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33851STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33852RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33853
33854You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33855&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33856&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33857the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33858specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33859
33860
33861
33862
33863.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33864When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33865runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33866appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33867If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33868
33869.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33870When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33871called with the &%-bv%& option.
33872
33873.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33874When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33875EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33876than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33877as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33878of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33879VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33880RCPT failures.
33881
33882
33883
33884.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33885.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33886RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33887overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33888disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33889the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33890should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33891
33892The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33893delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33894the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33895text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33896specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33897the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33898argument. For example,
33899.code
33900ETRN #brigadoon
33901.endd
33902runs the command
33903.code
33904exim -R brigadoon
33905.endd
33906which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33907containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33908default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33909for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33910a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33911
33912.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33913Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33914record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33915the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33916the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33917a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33918left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33919Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33920
33921.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33922For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33923used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33924whatever the form of its argument. For
33925example:
33926.code
33927smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33928 $sender_host_address
33929.endd
33930.vindex "&$domain$&"
33931The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33932expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33933and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33934wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33935under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33936for it to change them before running the command.
33937
33938
33939
33940.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33941.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33942Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33943standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33944line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33945&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33946messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33947sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33948an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33949identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33950runs for RCPT commands:
33951.code
33952accept hosts = :
33953.endd
33954This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33955
33956
33957
33958.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33959.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33960.cindex "batched SMTP output"
33961Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33962batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33963be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33964delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33965envelope along with the message.
33966
33967The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33968MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33969the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33970HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33971can be used to specify it.
33972
33973Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33974one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33975to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33976this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33977chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33978
33979.vindex "&$host$&"
33980When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33981sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33982transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33983router:
33984.code
33985begin routers
33986route_append:
33987 driver = manualroute
33988 transport = smtp_appendfile
33989 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33990
33991begin transports
33992smtp_appendfile:
33993 driver = appendfile
33994 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33995 batch_max = 1000
33996 use_bsmtp
33997 user = exim
33998.endd
33999This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34000format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34001message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34002
34003
34004
34005.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34006.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34007.cindex "batched SMTP input"
34008The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34009reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34010is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34011sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34012rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34013and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34014as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34015
34016Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34017ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34018
34019If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34020the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34021standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34022make some use of automatically, for example:
34023.code
34024554 Unexpected end of file
34025Transaction started in line 10
34026Error detected in line 14
34027.endd
34028It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34029file, for example:
34030.code
34031An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34032The error message was:
34033
34034501 '>' missing at end of address
34035
34036The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34037The error was detected in line 12.
34038The SMTP command at fault was:
34039
34040rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34041
340421 previous message was successfully processed.
34043The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34044.endd
34045The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34046messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34047accepted.
34048.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34049.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34050
34051
34052
34053. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34054. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34055
34056.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34057 "Customizing messages"
34058When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34059configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34060to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34061the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34062string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34063
34064The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34065cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34066option. Exim also adds the line
34067.code
34068Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34069.endd
34070to all warning and bounce messages,
34071
34072
34073.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34074.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34075.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34076If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34077message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34078delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34079&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34080
34081When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34082constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34083separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34084opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34085logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34086item.
34087
34088.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34089.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34090Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34091expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34092the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34093&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34094option, rounded to a whole number.
34095
34096The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34097
34098.ilist
34099The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34100&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34101.next
34102The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34103failing addresses with their error messages.
34104.next
34105The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34106returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34107.next
34108.new
34109The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34110The fields exist for back-compatibility
34111.wen
34112.endlist
34113
34114The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34115following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34116other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34117.code
34118Subject: Mail delivery failed
34119 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34120 {: returning message to sender}}
34121****
34122This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34123
34124A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34125 {that you sent }{sent by
34126
34127<$sender_address>
34128
34129}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34130This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34131****
34132The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34133****
34134------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34135 ------
34136****
34137------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34138 only the first
34139------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34140****
34141.endd
34142.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34143.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34144.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34145The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34146warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34147text sections:
34148
34149.ilist
34150The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34151&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34152.next
34153The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34154the delayed addresses.
34155.next
34156The third item then ends the message.
34157.endlist
34158
34159The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34160have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34161.code
34162Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34163 $warn_message_delay
34164****
34165This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34166
34167A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34168{that you sent }{sent by
34169
34170<$sender_address>
34171
34172}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34173more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34174
34175The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34176The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34177The date of the message is: $h_date
34178
34179The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34180****
34181No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34182continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34183intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34184mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34185the message will be returned to you.
34186.endd
34187.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34188.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34189However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34190appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34191&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34192minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34193of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34194multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34195handled them.
34196
34197
34198
34199
34200. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34201. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34202
34203.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34204This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34205common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34206
34207
34208
34209.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34210.cindex "smart host" "example router"
34211If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34212should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34213routing explicitly:
34214.code
34215send_to_smart_host:
34216 driver = manualroute
34217 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34218 transport = remote_smtp
34219.endd
34220You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34221If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34222receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34223synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34224&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34225
34226
34227
34228
34229.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34230.cindex "mailing lists"
34231Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34232requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34233Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34234
34235The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34236is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34237independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34238lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34239.code
34240lists:
34241 driver = redirect
34242 domains = lists.example
34243 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34244 forbid_pipe
34245 forbid_file
34246 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34247 no_more
34248.endd
34249This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34250in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34251such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34252routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34253
34254The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34255expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34256a mailing list.
34257
34258.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34259The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34260taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34261original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34262the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34263
34264For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34265&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34266&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34267&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34268There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34269the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34270such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34271or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34272&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34273
34274
34275
34276.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34277.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34278If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34279delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34280list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34281list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34282addresses are not rigorously checked.
34283
34284If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34285entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34286&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34287whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34288&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34289
34290
34291
34292.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34293.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34294Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34295in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34296recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34297cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34298delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34299account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34300the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34301message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34302
34303If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34304on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34305router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34306&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34307&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34308subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34309failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34310pre-existing messages.
34311
34312The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34313addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34314addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34315&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34316one level of expansion anyway.
34317
34318
34319
34320.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34321.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34322The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34323send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34324from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34325&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34326
34327The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34328of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34329.code
34330lists_request:
34331 driver = redirect
34332 domains = lists.example
34333 local_part_suffix = -request
34334 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34335 no_more
34336
34337lists_post:
34338 driver = redirect
34339 domains = lists.example
34340 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34341 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34342 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34343 forbid_pipe
34344 forbid_file
34345 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34346 no_more
34347
34348lists_closed:
34349 driver = redirect
34350 domains = lists.example
34351 allow_fail
34352 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34353.endd
34354All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34355they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34356&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34357mailing list.
34358
34359The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34360checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34361checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34362necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34363because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34364not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34365means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34366&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34367&"unrouteable address"& error.
34368
34369The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34370a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34371the address, giving a suitable error message.
34372
34373
34374
34375
34376.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34377.cindex "VERP"
34378.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34379.cindex "envelope sender"
34380Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34381are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34382address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34383the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34384if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34385original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34386
34387.oindex &%errors_to%&
34388.oindex &%return_path%&
34389Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34390facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34391list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34392these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34393host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34394of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34395of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34396.code
34397verp_smtp:
34398 driver = smtp
34399 max_rcpt = 1
34400 return_path = \
34401 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34402 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34403.endd
34404This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34405SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34406&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34407local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34408example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34409&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34410&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34411rewritten as
34412.code
34413somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34414.endd
34415.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34416For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34417have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34418achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34419might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34420&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34421
34422Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34423probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34424extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34425can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34426.code
34427dnslookup:
34428 driver = dnslookup
34429 domains = ! +local_domains
34430 transport = \
34431 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34432 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34433 no_more
34434.endd
34435If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34436of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34437routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34438errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34439address.
34440
34441On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34442&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34443SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34444and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34445of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34446.code
34447verp_dnslookup:
34448 driver = dnslookup
34449 domains = ! +local_domains
34450 transport = remote_smtp
34451 errors_to = \
34452 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34453 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34454 no_more
34455.endd
34456Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34457configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34458Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34459router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34460them.
34461
34462The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34463message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34464host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34465a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34466a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34467than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34468used).
34469
34470
34471
34472
34473
34474
34475.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34476.cindex "virtual domains"
34477.cindex "domain" "virtual"
34478The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34479meanings:
34480
34481.ilist
34482A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34483aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34484top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34485.next
34486One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34487with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34488have login accounts on that host.
34489.endlist
34490
34491The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34492the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34493aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34494virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34495whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34496to a router of this form:
34497.code
34498virtual:
34499 driver = redirect
34500 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34501 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34502 no_more
34503.endd
34504The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34505is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34506domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34507part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34508setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34509string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34510
34511This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34512follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34513can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34514a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34515
34516The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34517way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34518valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34519.code
34520my_domains:
34521 driver = accept
34522 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34523 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34524 transport = my_mailboxes
34525.endd
34526The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34527can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34528file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34529option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34530because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34531follows:
34532.code
34533my_mailboxes:
34534 driver = appendfile
34535 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34536 user = mail
34537.endd
34538This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34539required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34540
34541The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34542requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34543up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34544information about the domains.
34545
34546
34547
34548.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34549.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34550.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34551.cindex "local part" "prefix"
34552.cindex "local part" "suffix"
34553Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34554incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34555allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34556identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34557parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34558&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34559example, consider this router:
34560.code
34561userforward:
34562 driver = redirect
34563 check_local_user
34564 file = $home/.forward
34565 local_part_suffix = -*
34566 local_part_suffix_optional
34567 allow_filter
34568.endd
34569.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34570It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34571&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34572cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34573.code
34574if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34575save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34576endif
34577.endd
34578If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34579fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34580&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34581control over which suffixes are valid.
34582
34583Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34584&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34585another MTA:
34586.code
34587userforward:
34588 driver = redirect
34589 check_local_user
34590 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34591 local_part_suffix = -*
34592 local_part_suffix_optional
34593 allow_filter
34594.endd
34595If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34596example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34597does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34598subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34599&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34600
34601
34602
34603.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34604.cindex "vacation processing"
34605The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34606a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34607(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34608This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34609that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34610
34611.ilist
34612A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34613can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34614alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34615&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34616.code
34617spqr, vacation-spqr
34618.endd
34619.next
34620The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34621vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34622user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34623ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34624to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34625message.
34626.endlist
34627
34628Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34629use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34630
34631
34632
34633.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34634.cindex "message" "copying every"
34635Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34636be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34637command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34638each day's messages.
34639
34640There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34641messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34642delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34643notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34644
34645
34646
34647.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34648.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34649It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34650Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34651arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34652permanently connected.
34653
34654Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34655particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34656Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34657
34658
34659.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34660It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34661host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34662approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34663being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34664some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34665to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34666resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34667
34668A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34669intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34670into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34671format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34672destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34673in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34674if required.
34675
34676On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34677you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34678intermittent host. For example:
34679.code
34680cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34681.endd
34682This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34683which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34684online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34685options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34686causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34687connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34688immediately.
34689
34690If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34691issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34692mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34693used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34694avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34695Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34696arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34697
34698
34699
34700.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34701The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34702increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34703connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34704delivered immediately.
34705
34706.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34707.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34708.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34709Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34710not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34711possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34712each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34713avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34714&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34715first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34716normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34717destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34718single SMTP connection.
34719
34720
34721
34722. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34723. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34724
34725.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34726 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34727.cindex "client, non-queueing"
34728.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34729On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34730email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34731configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34732However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34733configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34734&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34735messages this way.
34736
34737If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34738run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34739any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34740continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34741email is not desirable.
34742
34743There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34744&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34745any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34746host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34747informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34748to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34749to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34750
34751There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34752that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34753ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34754before sending a message to the smart host.
34755
34756Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34757tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34758overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34759
34760.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34761There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34762Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34763assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34764just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34765compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34766router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34767
34768When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34769following ways:
34770
34771.ilist
34772A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34773In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34774.next
34775Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34776assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34777&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34778does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34779successful, a zero return code is given.
34780.next
34781Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34782be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34783the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34784must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34785deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34786are.
34787.next
34788If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34789failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34790successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34791.next
34792Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34793is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34794smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34795the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34796there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34797.next
34798If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34799connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34800failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34801.next
34802When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34803(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34804value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34805are ever generated.
34806.next
34807No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34808.next
34809A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34810true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34811&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34812.endlist
34813
34814The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34815the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34816deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34817privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34818to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34819the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34820
34821
34822
34823
34824. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34825. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34826
34827.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34828.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34829.cindex "log" "types of"
34830Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34831and the panic log:
34832
34833.ilist
34834.cindex "main log"
34835The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34836line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34837down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34838out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34839them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34840they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34841analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34842&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34843.next
34844.cindex "reject log"
34845The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34846of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34847The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34848the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34849is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34850lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34851reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34852host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34853can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34854false.
34855.next
34856.cindex "panic log"
34857.cindex "system log"
34858When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34859error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34860are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34861other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34862therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34863regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34864panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34865is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34866message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34867.endlist
34868
34869Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34870example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34871In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34872.code
348732001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34874 by QUIT
34875.endd
34876By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34877ways of changing this:
34878
34879.ilist
34880You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34881you set
34882.code
34883timezone = UTC
34884.endd
34885the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34886.next
34887If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34888example:
34889.code
348902003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34891.endd
34892.endlist
34893
34894.cindex "log" "process ids in"
34895.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34896Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34897request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34898&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34899brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34900
34901
34902
34903
34904.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34905.cindex "log" "destination"
34906.cindex "log" "to file"
34907.cindex "log" "to syslog"
34908.cindex "syslog"
34909The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34910should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34911are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34912arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34913It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34914need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34915Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34916
34917The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34918&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34919configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34920references to the host name:
34921.code
34922log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34923.endd
34924It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34925rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34926start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34927before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34928configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34929log at all.
34930
34931The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34932list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34933facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34934colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34935otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34936point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34937implying the use of a default path.
34938
34939When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34940LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34941&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34942mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34943files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34944equivalent to the setting:
34945.code
34946log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34947.endd
34948If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
34949or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
34950that is where the logs are written.
34951
34952A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34953are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34954
34955Here are some examples of possible settings:
34956.display
34957&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34958&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34959&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34960&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34961.endd
34962If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34963error is logged.
34964
34965
34966
34967.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34968.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34969.cindex "cycling logs"
34970.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34971.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34972Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34973log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34974provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34975main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34976keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34977
34978An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34979and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34980example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34981message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34982that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34983something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34984ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34985&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34986does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34987tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34988for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34989renamed.
34990
34991
34992
34993.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34994.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34995Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34996periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34997for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34998&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34999the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35000point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35001.code
35002log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35003log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35004log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35005log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35006.endd
35007As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35008examples of names generated by the above examples:
35009.code
35010/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35011/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35012/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35013/var/log/exim/main.200212
35014.endd
35015When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35016files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35017will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35018run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35019
35020The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35021is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35022When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35023the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35024non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35025character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35026log names:
35027.code
35028/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35029/var/log/exim-panic.log
35030/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35031/var/log/exim/panic
35032.endd
35033
35034
35035.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35036.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35037The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35038except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35039Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35040that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35041&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35042by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35043&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35044SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35045&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35046LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35047the time and host name to each line.
35048The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35049
35050.ilist
35051&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35052.next
35053&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35054.next
35055&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35056.endlist
35057
35058Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35059written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35060these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35061by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35062
35063Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35064entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35065these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35066calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35067870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35068additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35069replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35070RFC 3164, you should set
35071.code
35072SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35073.endd
35074in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35075lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35076
35077To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35078entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35079where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35080components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35081because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35082delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35083870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35084&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35085name, and pid as added by syslog:
35086.code
35087[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35088[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35089[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35090[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35091[5/5] mple>)
35092.endd
35093The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35094(LOG_NOTICE):
35095.code
35096[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35097[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35098[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35099[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35100[5\18] .example>)
35101[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35102[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35103[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35104[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35105[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35106[11\18] 09:43 +0100
35107[12\18] F From: <>
35108[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35109[18\18] X-something: this is another header
35110[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35111[16\18] le>
35112[17\18] B Bcc:
35113[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35114.endd
35115Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35116without modification.
35117
35118If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35119display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35120the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35121where it is.
35122
35123
35124
35125.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35126One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35127successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35128picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35129timestamp. The flags are:
35130.display
35131&`<=`& message arrival
35132&`=>`& normal message delivery
35133&`->`& additional address in same delivery
35134&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35135&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35136&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35137&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35138.endd
35139
35140
35141.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35142.cindex "log" "reception line"
35143The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35144message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35145several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35146.code
351472002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35148 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35149 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35150.endd
35151The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35152bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35153generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35154.code
35155R=<message id>
35156.endd
35157which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35158
35159.cindex "HELO"
35160.cindex "EHLO"
35161For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35162record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35163received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35164host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35165above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35166&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35167by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35168verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35169EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35170name in parentheses.
35171
35172Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35173without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35174the log containing text like these examples:
35175.code
35176H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35177H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35178.endd
35179This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35180on.
35181
35182For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35183the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35184of Exim.
35185
35186.cindex "authentication" "logging"
35187.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35188For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35189message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35190of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35191extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35192session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35193suite that was used.
35194
35195The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35196hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35197value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35198there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35199was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35200&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35201authenticator name.
35202
35203.cindex "size" "of message"
35204The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35205received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35206headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35207message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35208other).
35209
35210The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35211data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35212
35213
35214
35215.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35216.cindex "log" "delivery line"
35217The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35218delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35219deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
35220to fit it on the page:
35221.code
352222002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35223 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
352242002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35225 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35226 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35227.endd
35228For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35229after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35230intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35231last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35232fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35233
35234If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35235followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35236If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35237option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35238
35239If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35240for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35241.display
35242&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35243.endd
35244If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35245parentheses afterwards.
35246
35247.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35248When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35249SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35250flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35251down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35252lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35253
35254.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35255.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35256When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35257line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35258rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35259
35260The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35261&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35262
35263The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35264data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35265
35266
35267.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35268.cindex "discarded messages"
35269.cindex "message" "discarded"
35270.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35271When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35272obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35273.code
352742002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35275 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35276.endd
35277is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35278because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35279.code
352801999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35281 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35282.endd
35283
35284
35285.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35286When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35287.code
352882002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35289 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35290.endd
35291In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35292last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35293written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35294.code
352952002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35296 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35297.endd
35298When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35299a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35300appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35301
35302
35303
35304.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35305.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35306If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35307following form is logged:
35308.code
353091995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35310 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35311.endd
35312If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35313the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35314.code
353152002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35316 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35317 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35318 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35319 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35320.endd
35321The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35322used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35323disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35324flagged with &`**`&.
35325
35326
35327
35328.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35329.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35330If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35331used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35332&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35333
35334
35335
35336.section "Completion" "SECID257"
35337A line of the form
35338.code
353392002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35340.endd
35341is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35342at the end of its processing.
35343
35344
35345
35346
35347.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35348.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35349A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35350the following table:
35351.display
35352&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35353&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35354&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35355&`CV `& certificate verification status
35356&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35357&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35358&`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35359&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35360&`H `& host name and IP address
35361&`I `& local interface used
35362&`id `& message id for incoming message
35363&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35364&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35365&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35366&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35367&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35368&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35369&`S `& size of message
35370&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35371&`ST `& shadow transport name
35372&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35373&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35374&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35375&`X `& TLS cipher suite
35376.endd
35377
35378
35379.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35380Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35381self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35382
35383.ilist
35384.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35385&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35386during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35387This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35388during the first delivery attempt.
35389.next
35390&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35391temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35392for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35393.next
35394.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35395&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35396some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35397common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35398&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35399doing.
35400.next
35401.cindex "error" "ignored"
35402&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35403message:
35404.olist
35405Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35406&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35407.next
35408A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35409failed. The delivery was discarded.
35410.next
35411A delivery set up by a router configured with
35412. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35413. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35414.code
35415 errors_to = <>
35416.endd
35417failed. The delivery was discarded.
35418.endlist olist
35419.endlist ilist
35420
35421
35422
35423
35424
35425.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35426.cindex "log" "selectors"
35427By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35428default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35429&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35430example:
35431.code
35432log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35433.endd
35434The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35435selection marked by asterisks:
35436.display
35437&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35438&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35439&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35440&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35441&` arguments `& command line arguments
35442&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35443&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35444&` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35445&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35446&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35447&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35448&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35449&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35450.new
35451&` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35452.wen
35453&` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35454&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35455&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35456&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35457&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35458&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35459&` pid `& Exim process id
35460&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35461&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35462&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35463&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35464&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35465&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35466&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35467&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35468&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35469&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35470&` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
35471&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35472&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35473&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35474&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35475&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35476&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35477.new
35478&`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35479.wen
35480&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35481&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35482&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35483&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35484
35485&` all `& all of the above
35486.endd
35487More details on each of these items follows:
35488
35489.ilist
35490.cindex "8BITMIME"
35491.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35492&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35493which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35494that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35495&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35496&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35497.next
35498.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35499&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35500its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35501this log selector is set.
35502.next
35503.cindex "log" "rewriting"
35504.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35505&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35506rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35507such users cannot access the log).
35508.next
35509.cindex "log" "full parentage"
35510&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35511delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35512parentheses between them.
35513.next
35514.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35515.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35516&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35517to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35518feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35519&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35520privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35521that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35522are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35523because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35524only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35525between the caller and Exim.
35526.next
35527.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35528&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35529connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35530.next
35531.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35532.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35533&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35534started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35535messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35536process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35537.next
35538.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35539&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35540perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35541.next
35542.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35543.cindex "size" "of message"
35544&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35545the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35546.next
35547.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35548.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35549.cindex "black list (DNS)"
35550&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35551DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35552.next
35553.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35554.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35555&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35556is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35557command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35558selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35559.next
35560.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35561&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35562any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35563log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35564routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35565.next
35566.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35567.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35568&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35569client's ident port times out.
35570.next
35571.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35572.cindex "log" "local interface"
35573.cindex "log" "local address and port"
35574.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35575.cindex "interface" "logging"
35576&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35577to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35578followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35579added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"& and to
35580rejection lines
35581.new
35582and (despite the name) the local interface is added to &"=>"& lines..
35583.wen
35584.next
35585.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35586.cindex "port" "logging remote"
35587.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35588.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35589.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35590&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35591added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35592in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35593changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35594&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35595important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35596.next
35597.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35598&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35599connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35600.next
35601.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35602.cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35603.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35604&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35605containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
35606the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
35607number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
35608.next
35609.cindex "log" "process ids in"
35610.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35611&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35612immediately after the time and date.
35613.next
35614.cindex "log" "queue run"
35615.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35616&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35617.next
35618.cindex "log" "queue time"
35619&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35620local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35621&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35622includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35623This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35624delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35625message has been successfully received.
35626.next
35627&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35628the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35629example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35630message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35631.next
35632.cindex "log" "recipients"
35633&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35634as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35635that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35636addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35637has taken place.
35638Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35639in the list.
35640.next
35641.cindex "log" "sender reception"
35642&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35643the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35644&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35645.next
35646.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35647&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35648rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35649log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35650rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35651.next
35652.cindex "log" "retry defer"
35653&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35654retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35655message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35656attempt.
35657.next
35658.cindex "log" "return path"
35659&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35660the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35661This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35662or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35663.next
35664.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35665&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35666and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35667This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35668necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35669.next
35670.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35671&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35672gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35673the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35674detail is lost.
35675.next
35676.cindex "log" "size rejection"
35677&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35678it is too big.
35679.next
35680.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35681.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35682&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35683queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35684it.
35685.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35686The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35687.next
35688.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35689.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35690.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35691&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35692outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35693A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35694response.
35695.next
35696.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35697.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35698&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
35699established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35700&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35701only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35702processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35703dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35704not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
35705of connections unless this selector is enabled.
35706
35707For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
35708included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35709reset if the daemon is restarted.
35710Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35711subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35712whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35713match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35714logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35715.next
35716.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35717.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35718&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35719RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35720and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35721line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35722.next
35723.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35724.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35725&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35726connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35727the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35728does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35729an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35730already have their own log lines.
35731
35732The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35733way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35734If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35735an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35736DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35737the same logging options.
35738
35739Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35740is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35741.code
35742C=EHLO,QUIT
35743.endd
35744shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35745than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35746the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35747setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35748have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35749.next
35750&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35751colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35752log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35753was accepted or used.
35754.next
35755.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35756.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35757&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35758encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35759because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35760been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35761it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35762received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35763.next
35764.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35765.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35766.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35767.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35768.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35769&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35770encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35771external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35772using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35773.next
35774.cindex "log" "subject"
35775.cindex "subject, logging"
35776&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35777preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35778Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35779specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35780unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35781.next
35782.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35783&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35784when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35785verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35786.next
35787.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35788.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35789&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35790connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35791.next
35792.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35793.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35794&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35795connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35796added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35797.next
35798.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35799.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35800&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35801the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35802added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35803.next
35804.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35805&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35806result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35807.endlist
35808
35809
35810.section "Message log" "SECID260"
35811.cindex "message" "log file for"
35812.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35813.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35814.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35815In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35816that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35817they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35818message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35819makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35820to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35821is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35822only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35823
35824On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35825per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35826&%message_logs%& option false.
35827.ecindex IIDloggen
35828
35829
35830
35831
35832. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35833. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35834
35835.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35836.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35837A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35838described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35839the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35840
35841.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35842.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35843 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35844.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35845.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35846.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35847.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35848 various criteria"
35849.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35850.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35851 "extract statistics from the log"
35852.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35853 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35854.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35855.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35856.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35857.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35858.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35859.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35860.endtable
35861
35862Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35863&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35864&url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35865
35866
35867
35868
35869.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35870.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35871.cindex "process, querying"
35872.cindex "SIGUSR1"
35873On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35874(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35875a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35876Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35877processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35878second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35879order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35880send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35881
35882&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35883use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35884script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35885
35886
35887Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35888varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35889but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35890system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35891it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35892options:
35893.display
35894&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35895&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35896&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35897&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35898.endd
35899An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35900.code
35901164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3590210483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3590310492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35904 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3590510592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3590610628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35907.endd
35908The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35909been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35910
35911
35912
35913.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35914.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35915.cindex "queue" "grepping"
35916This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35917.code
35918exim -bpu
35919.endd
35920or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35921.code
35922exim -bp
35923.endd
35924The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35925contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35926
35927to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35928that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35929
35930.vlist
35931.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35932Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35933tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35934.code
35935exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
35936.endd
35937.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35938Match a recipient address using a case-insensitve search. The field that is
35939tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35940
35941.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35942Match against the size field.
35943
35944.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35945Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35946
35947.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35948Match messages that are older than the given time.
35949
35950.vitem &*-z*&
35951Match only frozen messages.
35952
35953.vitem &*-x*&
35954Match only non-frozen messages.
35955.endlist
35956
35957The following options control the format of the output:
35958
35959.vlist
35960.vitem &*-c*&
35961Display only the count of matching messages.
35962
35963.vitem &*-l*&
35964Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35965the default.
35966
35967.vitem &*-i*&
35968Display message ids only.
35969
35970.vitem &*-b*&
35971Brief format &-- one line per message.
35972
35973.vitem &*-R*&
35974Display messages in reverse order.
35975
35976.vitem &*-a*&
35977Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35978.endlist
35979
35980There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35981
35982
35983
35984.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35985.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35986.cindex "queue" "summary"
35987The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35988-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35989running a command such as
35990.code
35991exim -bp | exiqsumm
35992.endd
35993The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35994it, as in the following example:
35995.code
359963 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
35997.endd
35998Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
35999volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
36000been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
36001number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
36002
36003A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
36004domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36005the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36006respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36007domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36008separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36009sender.
36010
36011The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36012this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36013generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36014option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36015level"& addresses).
36016
36017
36018
36019
36020.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36021 "SECTextspeinf"
36022.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36023.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36024The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36025files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36026extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36027match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36028given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36029The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36030If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36031included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36032.display
36033&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36034.endd
36035If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36036
36037The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36038condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36039they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36040
36041By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36042makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36043large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36044option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36045case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36046
36047The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36048pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36049regular expression.
36050
36051The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36052if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36053
36054The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36055that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36056normally.
36057
36058Example of &%-M%&:
36059user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36060&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36061displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36062the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36063when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36064&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36065search term.
36066
36067If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36068ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36069whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36070If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36071autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36072
36073
36074.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36075.cindex "&'exipick'&"
36076John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36077lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36078of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
36079&url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
36080the &%--help%& option.
36081
36082
36083.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36084.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36085.cindex "cycling logs"
36086.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36087The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36088&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36089you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36090&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36091for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36092There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36093.ilist
36094&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36095default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36096.next
36097&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36098&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36099overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36100configuration.
36101.endlist
36102
36103Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36104the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36105run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36106&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36107&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36108logs are handled similarly.
36109
36110If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36111&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36112to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36113any existing log files.
36114
36115If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36116the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36117using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36118setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36119root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36120.code
361211 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36122.endd
36123assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36124&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36125
36126
36127
36128.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36129.cindex "statistics"
36130.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36131A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36132information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36133Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36134LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36135
36136The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36137latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36138lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36139various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36140list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36141.code
36142eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36143.endd
36144By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36145messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36146both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36147are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36148addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36149options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36150also produced per user.
36151
36152The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36153histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36154hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36155example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36156as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36157
36158Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36159have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36160messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36161and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36162recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36163an entirely separate message.
36164
36165&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36166of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36167each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36168not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36169least one address that failed.
36170
36171The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36172or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36173transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36174(default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36175a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36176senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36177and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36178
36179The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36180came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36181without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36182
36183There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36184outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36185by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36186.code
36187perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36188.endd
36189
36190.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36191.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36192.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36193.cindex "checking access"
36194The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36195debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36196policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36197familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36198sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36199access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36200
36201The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36202two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36203.code
36204exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36205.endd
36206The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36207given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36208connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36209is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36210.code
36211Rejected:
36212550 Relay not permitted
36213.endd
36214When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36215for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36216options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36217that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36218you can use:
36219.code
36220exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36221 -f himself@there.example
36222.endd
36223Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36224mandatory arguments.
36225
36226Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36227while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36228&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36229
36230
36231
36232.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36233.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36234.cindex "building DBM files"
36235.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36236.cindex "lower casing"
36237.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36238The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36239the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36240&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36241names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36242can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36243
36244A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36245the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36246&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36247strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36248files.
36249
36250The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36251single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36252It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36253well.
36254
36255.cindex "USE_DB"
36256If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36257configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36258names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36259a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36260.code
36261exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36262.endd
36263reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36264&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36265
36266In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36267Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36268environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36269&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36270when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36271recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36272
36273If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36274finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36275option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36276this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36277&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36278There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36279&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36280return code is 2.
36281
36282
36283
36284
36285.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36286.cindex "retry" "times"
36287.cindex "&'exinext'&"
36288A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36289fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36290complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36291information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36292is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36293output. For example:
36294.code
36295$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36296kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36297 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36298 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36299 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36300roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36301 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36302 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36303 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36304 past final cutoff time
36305.endd
36306You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36307will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36308A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36309message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36310suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36311&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36312run very often.
36313
36314The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36315of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36316passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36317configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36318file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36319environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36320
36321
36322
36323.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36324.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36325.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36326Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36327uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36328arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36329second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36330
36331.ilist
36332&'retry'&: the database of retry information
36333.next
36334&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36335for remote hosts
36336.next
36337&'callout'&: the callout cache
36338.next
36339&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36340.next
36341&'misc'&: other hints data
36342.endlist
36343
36344The &'misc'& database is used for
36345
36346.ilist
36347Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36348.next
36349Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36350&(smtp)& transport)
36351.endlist
36352
36353
36354
36355.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36356.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36357The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36358&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36359spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36360.code
36361exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36362.endd
36363Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36364.code
36365T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3636631-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36367.endd
36368The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36369of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36370transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36371a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36372address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36373transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36374to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36375and a textual description of the error.
36376
36377The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36378the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36379ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36380exceeded.
36381
36382Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36383consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36384waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36385one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36386may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36387may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36388cross-references.
36389
36390
36391
36392.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36393.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36394The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36395database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36396days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36397updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36398since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36399for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36400updated sufficiently often.
36401
36402The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36403followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36404the retry database:
36405.code
36406exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36407.endd
36408Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36409message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36410they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36411are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36412types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36413message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36414queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36415&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36416For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36417removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36418whenever it removes information from the database.
36419
36420Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36421needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36422down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36423first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36424records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36425
36426It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36427hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36428a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36429work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36430but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36431After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36432point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36433tidied.
36434
36435&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36436databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36437
36438
36439
36440
36441.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36442.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36443The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36444Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36445getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36446is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36447key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36448displayed.
36449
36450If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36451except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36452out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36453data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36454by new data, for example:
36455.code
36456> 4 951102:1000
36457.endd
36458resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36459sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36460used as optional separators.
36461
36462
36463
36464
36465.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36466.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36467.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36468.cindex "locking mailboxes"
36469The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36470Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36471&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36472a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36473the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36474argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36475second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36476is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36477is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36478
36479.vlist
36480.vitem &%-fcntl%&
36481Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36482
36483.vitem &%-flock%&
36484Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36485supports it.
36486
36487.vitem &%-interval%&
36488This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36489interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36490
36491.vitem &%-lockfile%&
36492Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36493
36494.vitem &%-mbx%&
36495Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36496
36497.vitem &%-q%&
36498Suppress verification output.
36499
36500.vitem &%-retries%&
36501This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36502the lock (default 10).
36503
36504.vitem &%-restore_time%&
36505This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36506locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36507example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36508subsequently sees.
36509
36510.vitem &%-timeout%&
36511This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36512timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36513default), a non-blocking call is used.
36514
36515.vitem &%-v%&
36516Generate verbose output.
36517.endlist
36518
36519If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36520default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36521mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36522&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36523requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36524file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36525more than 30 minutes old.
36526
36527The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36528&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36529to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36530&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36531number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36532can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36533
36534The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36535&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36536suppresses all output except error messages.
36537
36538A command such as
36539.code
36540exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36541.endd
36542runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36543.display
36544&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36545<&'some commands'&>
36546&`End`&
36547.endd
36548runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36549suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36550such as
36551.code
36552exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36553 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36554.endd
36555Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36556second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36557.ecindex IIDutils
36558
36559
36560. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36561. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36562
36563.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36564.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36565.cindex "X-windows"
36566.cindex "&'eximon'&"
36567.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36568.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36569The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36570about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36571perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36572such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36573monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36574
36575
36576
36577.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36578The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36579script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36580binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36581be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36582&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36583parameters are for.
36584
36585The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36586a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36587preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36588.code
36589EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36590.endd
36591(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36592the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36593overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36594&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36595syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36596
36597X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36598way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36599.code
36600Eximon*background: gray94
36601.endd
36602changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36603stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36604black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36605data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36606&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36607For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36608reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36609.code
36610xrdb -merge <<End
36611Eximon*highlight: gray
36612End
36613.endd
36614.cindex "admin user"
36615In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36616&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36617
36618The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36619contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36620if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36621binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36622versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36623
36624The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36625more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36626main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36627delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36628different parts of the display.
36629
36630
36631
36632
36633.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36634.cindex "stripchart"
36635The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36636be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36637&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36638configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36639it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36640hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36641received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36642period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36643parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36644
36645The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36646displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36647title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36648For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36649
36650It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36651a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36652to a single partition.
36653
36654.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36655This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36656the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36657this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36658100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36659SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36660&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36661
36662
36663
36664
36665.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36666.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36667.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36668.cindex "window size"
36669Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36670to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36671shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36672stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36673the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36674in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36675
36676When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36677currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36678size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36679remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36680
36681The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36682stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36683the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36684The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36685&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36686the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36687
36688Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36689built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36690START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36691
36692
36693
36694.section "The log display" "SECID267"
36695.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36696The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36697the main log is maintained.
36698To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36699removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36700The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36701syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
36702to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
36703
36704The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
36705move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
36706scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36707LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36708to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36709much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36710a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36711only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36712available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36713normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36714configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36715
36716Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36717and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36718respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36719It cannot go further back up the log.
36720
36721The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36722normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36723by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36724by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36725back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36726the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36727
36728Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36729There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36730the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36731happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36732&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36733^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36734
36735The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36736widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36737&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36738eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36739However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36740provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36741come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36742unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36743on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36744window.
36745
36746
36747
36748.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36749.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36750The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36751are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36752as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36753parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36754at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36755the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36756there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36757to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36758
36759When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36760and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36761with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36762pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36763type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36764such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36765of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36766
36767If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36768are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36769example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36770&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36771has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36772cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36773a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36774
36775While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36776else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36777queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36778pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36779
36780The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36781time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36782message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36783a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36784recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36785listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36786an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36787not shown.
36788
36789.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36790If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36791
36792The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36793of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36794The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36795available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36796display is updated.
36797
36798
36799
36800.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36801.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36802If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36803pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36804line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36805any selected text.
36806
36807If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36808MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36809set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36810value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36811run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36812.code
36813EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36814.endd
36815The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36816follows:
36817
36818.ilist
36819&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36820in a new text window.
36821.next
36822&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36823information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36824&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36825.next
36826&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36827displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36828amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36829option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36830.next
36831&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36832delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36833frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36834a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36835up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36836.next
36837&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36838that the message be frozen.
36839.next
36840.cindex "thawing messages"
36841.cindex "unfreezing messages"
36842.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36843&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36844that the message be thawed.
36845.next
36846.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36847&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36848that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36849for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36850.next
36851&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36852that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36853message.
36854.next
36855&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36856be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36857is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36858Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36859causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36860additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36861which case no action is taken.
36862.next
36863&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36864can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36865is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36866Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36867causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36868recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36869case no action is taken.
36870.next
36871&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36872mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36873.next
36874&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36875sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36876&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36877in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36878bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36879not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36880the address is qualified with that domain.
36881.endlist
36882
36883When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36884other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36885particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36886output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36887from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36888&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36889if no output is generated.
36890
36891The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36892thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36893&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36894force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36895
36896In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36897cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36898and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36899.ecindex IIDeximon
36900
36901
36902
36903
36904
36905. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36906. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36907
36908.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36909.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36910This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36911which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36912
36913For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36914Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36915existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36916chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36917security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36918its security as compared with other MTAs.
36919
36920What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36921have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36922absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36923as soon as possible.
36924
36925
36926.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36927.cindex "security" "build-time features"
36928There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36929to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36930Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36931penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36932
36933.ilist
36934ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36935start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36936names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36937value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36938&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36939default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36940
36941If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36942which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36943into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36944configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36945.next
36946
36947If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36948or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36949file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36950the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36951root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36952right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36953reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36954it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36955privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36956separate commands.
36957
36958.next
36959The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36960with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36961CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36962requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36963the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36964but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36965previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36966.next
36967If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36968is disabled.
36969.next
36970FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36971never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36972option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36973to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36974is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36975.endlist
36976
36977
36978
36979.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36980.cindex "setuid"
36981.cindex "root privilege"
36982The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36983privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36984example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36985may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36986discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36987is required for two things:
36988
36989.ilist
36990To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36991the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36992not required.
36993.next
36994To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
36995perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
36996configuration.
36997.endlist
36998
36999It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
37000receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
37001obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
37002For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37003&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37004group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37005is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37006&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37007
37008Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37009abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37010&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37011
37012After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37013uid and gid in the following cases:
37014
37015.ilist
37016.oindex "&%-C%&"
37017.oindex "&%-D%&"
37018If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37019the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37020calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37021the calling process.
37022However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37023option may not be used at all.
37024If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37025can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37026user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37027.next
37028.oindex "&%-be%&"
37029.oindex "&%-bf%&"
37030.oindex "&%-bF%&"
37031If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37032(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37033calling process.
37034.next
37035If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37036process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37037uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37038runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37039testing address verification
37040.oindex "&%-bv%&"
37041.oindex "&%-bh%&"
37042(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37043option).
37044.next
37045For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37046remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37047.endlist
37048
37049The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37050
37051.ilist
37052A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37053user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37054function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37055will be used during message reception.
37056.next
37057A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37058job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37059.next
37060A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37061but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37062subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37063deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37064remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37065subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37066while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37067generating bounce and warning messages.
37068
37069While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37070process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37071this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37072gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37073.next
37074A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37075the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37076.endlist
37077
37078
37079
37080
37081.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37082.cindex "privilege, running without"
37083.cindex "unprivileged running"
37084.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37085Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37086operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37087by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37088gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37089(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37090routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37091to any other uid.
37092
37093.cindex SIGHUP
37094.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37095Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37096that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37097correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37098
37099An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37100to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37101process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37102when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37103SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37104
37105It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37106stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37107been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37108effect.
37109
37110If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37111set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37112to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37113
37114In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37115those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37116Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37117that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37118discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37119have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37120number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37121address this problem at this time.
37122
37123For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37124is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37125&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37126be used in the most straightforward way.
37127
37128If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37129number of restrictions on what you can do:
37130
37131.ilist
37132You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37133&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37134normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37135work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37136explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37137.next
37138Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37139not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37140.next
37141Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37142the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37143and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37144enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37145.next
37146Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37147some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37148
37149.olist
37150They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37151implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37152mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37153.next
37154You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37155owned by the Exim user.
37156.next
37157You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37158on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37159mailboxes need to be created manually.
37160.endlist olist
37161.endlist ilist
37162
37163
37164These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37165However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37166gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37167gives more security at essentially no cost.
37168
37169If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37170&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37171
37172
37173
37174
37175.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37176Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37177are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37178
37179
37180
37181.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37182.cindex "security" "local commands"
37183.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37184There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37185commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37186configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37187run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37188
37189.ilist
37190Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37191injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37192be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37193allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37194has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37195.next
37196A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37197&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37198&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37199hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37200NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37201forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37202need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37203.next
37204The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37205administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37206Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37207.next
37208Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37209taint checking might apply to their usage.
37210.next
37211Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analagous to shell's eval builtin and
37212administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37213instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37214.next
37215Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37216Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37217each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37218of opaque strings.
37219The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37220real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37221injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37222Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37223.endlist
37224
37225
37226
37227
37228.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37229.cindex "security" "data sources"
37230.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37231.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37232.cindex "PCRE" "security"
37233If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37234are some issues to be aware of:
37235
37236.ilist
37237Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37238.next
37239Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37240.next
37241Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37242data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37243"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37244expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37245when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37246possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37247data.
37248.next
37249It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37250&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37251items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37252.next
37253Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37254expected to yield one result.
37255.endlist
37256
37257
37258
37259
37260.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37261.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37262.cindex "IP source routing"
37263Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37264some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37265IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37266IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37267
37268
37269
37270.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37271Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37272be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37273
37274
37275
37276
37277.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37278.cindex "trusted users"
37279.cindex "admin user"
37280.cindex "privileged user"
37281.cindex "user" "trusted"
37282.cindex "user" "admin"
37283Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37284able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37285addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37286local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37287permit a remote host to be specified.
37288
37289.oindex "&%-f%&"
37290However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37291in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37292message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37293but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37294permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37295the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37296
37297Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37298other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37299the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37300as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37301group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37302
37303Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37304can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37305them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37306the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37307includes the contents of files on the spool.
37308
37309.oindex "&%-M%&"
37310.oindex "&%-q%&"
37311By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37312delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37313restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37314Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37315queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37316setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37317
37318Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37319the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37320the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37321group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37322the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37323unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37324files.
37325
37326
37327
37328.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37329.cindex "spool directory" "files"
37330Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37331set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37332&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37333any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37334
37335
37336
37337.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37338Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37339of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37340with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37341to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37342this.
37343
37344
37345
37346.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37347The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37348are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37349Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37350converted output.
37351
37352
37353
37354.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37355Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37356to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37357does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37358arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37359
37360
37361
37362.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37363Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37364defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37365loading it.
37366
37367
37368.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37369.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37370A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37371&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37372The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37373that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37374conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37375
37376The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37377the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37378string.
37379
37380
37381
37382.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37383Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37384formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37385the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37386
37387
37388
37389.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37390These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37391enough to hold the result.
37392.ecindex IIDsecurcon
37393
37394
37395
37396
37397. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37398. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37399
37400.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37401.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37402.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37403.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37404.cindex "spool files" "editing"
37405A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37406followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37407the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37408kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37409two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37410is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37411themselves are recoverable.
37412
37413Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37414need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37415on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37416
37417.ilist
37418You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37419fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37420which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37421place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37422lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37423.next
37424.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37425If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37426&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37427present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37428will always be the case.
37429.next
37430If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37431.next
37432If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37433signature.
37434.endlist
37435All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37436
37437Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37438its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37439files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37440the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37441the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37442is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37443file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37444-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37445attempt.
37446
37447.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37448.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37449.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37450The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37451process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37452gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37453message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37454normally the Exim user.
37455
37456The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37457transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37458empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37459in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37460created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37461&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37462leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37463&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37464
37465The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37466was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37467start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37468warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37469
37470There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37471order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37472
37473.vlist
37474.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37475This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37476&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37477recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37478this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37479identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37480the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37481the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37482the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37483newlines.
37484
37485.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37486A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37487defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37488The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37489starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37490character. It may contain internal newlines.
37491
37492.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37493A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37494Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37495length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37496starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37497character. It may contain internal newlines.
37498
37499.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37500This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37501&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37502
37503.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37504This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37505lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37506transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37507messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37508
37509.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37510This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37511(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37512time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37513hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37514
37515.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37516The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37517&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37518
37519.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37520The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37521&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37522
37523.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37524This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37525present.
37526
37527.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37528This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37529present if the number is greater than zero.
37530
37531.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37532This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37533file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37534
37535.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37536.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37537The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37538
37539.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37540This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37541command.
37542
37543.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37544This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37545the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37546messages.
37547
37548.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37549If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37550the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37551&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37552
37553.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37554This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37555address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37556
37557.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37558.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37559.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37560This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37561if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37562received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37563
37564.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37565For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37566unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37567ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37568supplied by the remote host, if any.
37569
37570.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37571This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37572which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37573generated messages.
37574
37575.vitem &%-local%&
37576The message is from a local sender.
37577
37578.vitem &%-localerror%&
37579The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37580
37581.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37582This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37583when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37584variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37585
37586.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37587The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37588Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37589
37590.vitem &%-N%&
37591A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37592actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37593&%-N%& is assumed.
37594
37595.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37596This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37597the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37598
37599.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37600The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37601to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37602
37603.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37604If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37605of &$spam_score_int$&.
37606
37607.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37608A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37609certificate was verified by the server.
37610
37611.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37612When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37613name of the cipher suite that was used.
37614
37615.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37616When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37617was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37618certificate.
37619.endlist
37620
37621Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37622is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37623line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37624is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37625the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37626balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37627to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37628original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37629addresses are complete.
37630
37631If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37632the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37633Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37634tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37635right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37636follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37637.code
37638YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37639NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37640NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37641.endd
37642After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37643This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37644recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37645delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37646example:
37647.code
376484
37649editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37650darcy@austen.fict.example
37651rdo@foundation
37652alice@wonderland.fict.example
37653.endd
37654However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37655result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37656line is of the following form:
37657.display
37658<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37659 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37660.endd
37661The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37662the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37663fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37664original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37665envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37666length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37667characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37668that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37669
37670
37671A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37672which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37673when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37674character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37675embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37676following:
37677
37678.table2 50pt
37679.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37680.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37681.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37682.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37683.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37684.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37685.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37686.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37687.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37688.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37689.endtable
37690
37691Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37692purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37693typical set of headers:
37694.code
37695111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37696id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37697049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37698038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37699042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37700049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37701099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
37702darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37703104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
37704darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37705038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37706.endd
37707The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37708&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37709unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37710.ecindex IIDforspo1
37711.ecindex IIDforspo2
37712.ecindex IIDforspo3
37713
37714. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37715. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37716
37717.chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37718 "DKIM Support"
37719.cindex "DKIM"
37720
37721DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37722linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37723be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37724DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37725
37726Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
37727disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
37728
37729Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37730.olist
37731Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37732It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37733(including transport filters)
37734except cutthrough delivery.
37735.next
37736Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37737ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37738different signature contexts.
37739.endlist
37740
37741In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37742default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37743Exim's standard controls.
37744
37745Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37746on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37747exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37748signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37749.code
377502009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37751 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37752 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37753 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37754.endd
37755You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37756or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37757control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37758where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37759senders).
37760
37761
37762.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37763.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37764
37765Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37766These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37767
37768.option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37769MANDATORY:
37770The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37771option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37772
37773.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37774MANDATORY:
37775This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37776variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37777variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37778option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37779
37780.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37781MANDATORY:
37782This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37783&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37784The result can either
37785.ilist
37786be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37787.next
37788start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37789the private key.
37790.next
37791be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37792be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37793is set.
37794.endlist
37795
37796.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37797OPTIONAL:
37798This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37799The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37800The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37801only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37802
37803.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37804OPTIONAL:
37805This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37806should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37807either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37808unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37809variables here.
37810
37811.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37812OPTIONAL:
37813When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37814list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37815signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37816used.
37817
37818
37819.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37820.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37821
37822Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37823&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37824syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37825A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37826If any ACL call does not acccept, the message is not accepted.
37827If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37828summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37829
37830To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37831containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37832runtime of the ACL.
37833
37834Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37835more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37836&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37837&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37838
37839The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37840list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37841called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37842the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37843list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37844&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37845it defaults as:
37846.code
37847dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37848.endd
37849This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37850DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37851call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37852.code
37853dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37854.endd
37855This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37856and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37857You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37858.code
37859dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37860.endd
37861
37862If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37863&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37864
37865
37866Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37867available (from most to least important):
37868
37869
37870.vlist
37871.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37872The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37873an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37874&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37875.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37876A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37877.ilist
37878&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37879identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37880.next
37881&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37882More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37883.next
37884&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37885available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37886.next
37887&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37888.endlist
37889.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37890A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37891"fail" or "invalid". One of
37892.ilist
37893&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37894key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37895.next
37896&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37897record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37898.next
37899&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37900body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37901means that the message body was modified in transit.
37902.next
37903&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37904could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37905re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37906DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37907.endlist
37908.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37909The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37910an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37911reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37912.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37913The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37914if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37915identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37916.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37917The key record selector string.
37918.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37919The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37920.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37921The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37922.vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37923The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37924.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37925A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37926(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37927.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37928The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37929limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37930that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37931.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37932UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37933When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37934.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37935UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37936signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37937signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37938integer size comparisons against this value.
37939.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37940A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37941.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37942"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37943.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37944"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37945.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37946Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37947in the key record.
37948.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37949Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37950in the key record.
37951.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37952Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37953.endlist
37954
37955In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37956
37957.vlist
37958.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37959ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37960for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37961(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37962verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37963
37964.code
37965# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37966warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37967 sender_domains = gmail.com
37968 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37969 dkim_status = none
37970.endd
37971
37972.vitem &%dkim_status%&
37973ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37974results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37975to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37976
37977.code
37978deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37979 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37980 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37981 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37982.endd
37983
37984The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37985see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37986for more information of what they mean.
37987.endlist
37988
37989. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37990. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37991
37992.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37993 "Adding drivers or lookups"
37994.cindex "adding drivers"
37995.cindex "new drivers, adding"
37996.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
37997The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
37998authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
37999
38000.olist
38001Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
38002existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
38003.next
38004Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
38005.display
38006<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
38007.endd
38008where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
38009code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
38010should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
38011.next
38012Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
38013.code
38014#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
38015.endd
38016.next
38017Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
38018and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
38019.next
38020Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
38021near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
38022Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
38023As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
38024simple form that most lookups have.
38025.next
38026Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
38027&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
38028driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
38029.next
38030Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
38031&_src_&.
38032.next
38033Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
38034as for other drivers and lookups.
38035.endlist
38036
38037Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
38038proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
38039occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
38040options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
38041searched using a binary chop procedure.
38042
38043There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
38044the interface that is expected.
38045
38046
38047
38048
38049. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38050. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38051
38052. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38053. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
38054. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
38055. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
38056. processors.
38057. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38058
38059.literal xml
38060<?sdop
38061 format="newpage"
38062 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
38063 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
38064?>
38065.literal off
38066
38067.makeindex "Options index" "option"
38068.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
38069.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
38070
38071
38072. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38073. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////